Docs: add explicit warnings for some variables likely tainted
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.93"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2019
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "website"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455 .cindex "wiki"
456 .cindex "FAQ"
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506 .cindex "FTP site"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511 .display
512 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513 .endd
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
525
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 .display
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537 .endd
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
542
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 .endd
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 .display
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 .endd
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .ilist
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .next
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 arrival.
601 .next
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 .next
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 other means.
615 .next
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
621 .endlist
622
623
624 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
658
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
667
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 otherwise.
672
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 until a later time.
677
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 line.
698
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 message's envelope.
715
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 .cindex "PCRE"
747 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750 .ilist
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .next
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
764
765 .blockquote
766 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 version.
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
777 .endblockquote
778 .next
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785 under the Gnu GPL.
786 .next
787 .cindex "Cyrus"
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
794
795 .blockquote
796 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800 are met:
801
802 .olist
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 .next
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 distribution.
810 .next
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
815 .display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 .endd
823 .next
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 acknowledgment:
826
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837 .endlist
838 .endblockquote
839
840 .next
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 .cindex "X-windows"
843 .cindex "Athena"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849 .blockquote
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853 All Rights Reserved
854
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869 SOFTWARE.
870 .endblockquote
871
872 .next
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878 source code.
879
880 .next
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884 .endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915 .ilist
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 error code.
926 .next
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 .next
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 .next
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 .next
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 .next
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
948 .endlist
949
950
951
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
961
962 .ilist
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 by RFC 3028.
965 .next
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 .endlist
969
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
978 .cindex "base62"
979 .cindex "base36"
980 .cindex "Darwin"
981 .cindex "Cygwin"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
990
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997 somewhat eccentric:
998
999 .ilist
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 .next
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1007 .next
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .olist
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 .next
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1019 .endlist
1020 .endlist
1021
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1036
1037 .ilist
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 .next
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 .next
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 .next
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059 .endlist
1060
1061
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1114
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 to be sent.
1152
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 systems.
1170
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1209
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 to be bounced.
1215
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 configuration.
1234
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1244
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290 the following:
1291
1292 .ilist
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 end of routing.
1302
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 .next
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 .next
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 .next
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 .next
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 .next
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 .endlist
1333
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366 .ilist
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1374 .next
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378 address.
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384 .next
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390 .next
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394 .next
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397 .next
1398 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399 of domains that it defines.
1400 .next
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1405 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1412 .next
1413 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1415 .vindex "&$home$&"
1416 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420 remaining preconditions.
1421 .next
1422 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426 could lead to confusion.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429 set of addresses that it defines.
1430 .next
1431 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432 specified files is tested.
1433 .next
1434 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 .endlist
1439
1440
1441 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448
1449
1450
1451 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454
1455 .ilist
1456 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1461 filtering'&.
1462 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1464
1465 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 filter.
1472 .next
1473 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1474 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477 processed entirely independently of each other.
1478 .next
1479 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1488 .next
1489 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496 addresses to the same domain.
1497 .next
1498 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1506 .next
1507 .cindex "queue runner"
1508 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1517 .next
1518 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1524 .next
1525 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528 messages to other addresses.
1529 .next
1530 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 &'deferred'&.
1534 .next
1535 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1538 .endlist
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546 .cindex "queue runner"
1547 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1553 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554 passed its retry time.
1555 You can run several queue runners at once.
1556
1557 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562 as permanent.
1563
1564
1565
1566 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 also apply.
1576
1577 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1580 deferred,
1581 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586 one connection.
1587
1588
1589
1590 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1601
1602 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 automatically.
1606
1607 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614 of the list.
1615
1616
1617
1618 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1622 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633
1634 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1636
1637 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641
1642 .table2 140pt
1643 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1645 documented"
1646 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 instructions"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654 following subdirectories are created:
1655
1656 .table2 140pt
1657 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 .endtable
1665
1666 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1667 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668 that may be useful to some sites.
1669
1670
1671 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1677 system.
1678 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682 overridden if necessary.
1683 .cindex compiler requirements
1684 .cindex compiler version
1685 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686
1687
1688 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689 .cindex "PCRE library"
1690 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1692 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1693 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698 If your operating system has no
1699 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1702
1703 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1710
1711 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1719
1720 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727 Berkeley DB library.
1728
1729 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1731 possibilities:
1732
1733 .olist
1734 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741 filename is used unmodified.
1742 .next
1743 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1747 .next
1748 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1751 .next
1752 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1754 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758 page with far newer versions listed.
1759 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761 suited to Exim's usage model.
1762 .next
1763 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766 operates on a single file.
1767 .endlist
1768
1769 .cindex "USE_DB"
1770 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1775 .code
1776 USE_DB=yes
1777 .endd
1778 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1780
1781 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1787
1788 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790 in one of these lines:
1791 .code
1792 DBMLIB = -ldb
1793 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1794 .endd
1795 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 this example:
1800 .code
1801 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1803 .endd
1804 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1806
1807
1808
1809 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1821
1822 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1824 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1828
1829 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1834 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 be logged.
1836
1837 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840 facilities, you need to set
1841 .code
1842 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1843 .endd
1844 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846
1847
1848 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1855
1856 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1860 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1861 do this.
1862
1863
1864
1865 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1867 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1868 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1875
1876 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1881 .code
1882 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1883 .endd
1884 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1885
1886
1887
1888 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1892 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1893 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1894 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1895 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1896 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1897 line option).
1898
1899 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1900 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1901 implementing SSL.
1902
1903 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1904 .code
1905 DISABLE_TLS=yes
1906 .endd
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1908
1909 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1910 .code
1911 USE_OPENSL=yes
1912 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1913 .endd
1914 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1916 .code
1917 USE_OPENSSL=yes
1918 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1920 .endd
1921 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1923 .code
1924 USE_OPENSSL=yes
1925 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1929 .code
1930 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1931 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1932 .endd
1933 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934 library and include files. For example:
1935 .code
1936 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1937 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1939 .endd
1940 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942 .code
1943 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1944 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945 .endd
1946
1947 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1955
1956 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968 you might have
1969 .code
1970 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1973 .endd
1974 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1976 .code
1977 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1978 .endd
1979 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1985 further details.
1986
1987
1988 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994 library files.
1995
1996 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2001 Exim used to
2002 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 withdrawn.
2004
2005
2006
2007 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008 .cindex "lookup modules"
2009 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2010 .cindex ".so building"
2011 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2013 on demand.
2014 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2016 dependencies.
2017 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2018
2019 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2025
2026 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029 on demand:
2030 .code
2031 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2032 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2033 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2034 .endd
2035
2036
2037 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038 .cindex "build directory"
2039 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2046
2047 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2055
2056 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2059
2060
2061
2062 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2069 .code
2070 FULLECHO='' make -e
2071 .endd
2072 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074 given in addition to the short output.
2075
2076
2077
2078 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085 order:
2086 .display
2087 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089 &_Local/Makefile_&
2090 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2094 .endd
2095 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101 and are often not needed.
2102
2103 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112
2113
2114 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2118 default values are.
2119
2120
2121 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133 containing the lines
2134 .code
2135 CC=cc
2136 CFLAGS=-std1
2137 .endd
2138 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2140
2141 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144
2145
2146 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2156 .code
2157 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2158 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2159 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2160 .endd
2161 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2169 errors.
2170
2171 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181 syntax. For instance:
2182 .code
2183 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2184 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2185 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2186 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189 .endd
2190
2191 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2194 .code
2195 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2196 .endd
2197 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2199
2200 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206 .code
2207 X11=/usr/X11R6
2208 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2210 .endd
2211 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213 .code
2214 X11=/usr/openwin
2215 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2217 .endd
2218 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219 definition of all three of these variables into your
2220 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221
2222 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2223 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2227
2228 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233 libraries.
2234
2235 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240
2241
2242 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2243 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2244 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2250
2251
2252
2253 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254 .cindex "building Eximon"
2255 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256 where the files that are involved are
2257 .display
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2264 .endd
2265 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2272 .ecindex IIDbuex
2273
2274
2275 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276 .cindex "installing Exim"
2277 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2289
2290 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296 alternative files, no default is installed.
2297
2298 .cindex "system aliases file"
2299 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305 and outputs a comment to the user.
2306
2307 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2312
2313 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318 over SMTP.
2319
2320 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322 command such as
2323 .code
2324 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2325 .endd
2326 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330 but this usage is deprecated.
2331
2332 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2338
2339 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2346
2347 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350 command:
2351 .code
2352 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2353 .endd
2354 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358 command:
2359 .code
2360 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2361 .endd
2362 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364
2365 .ilist
2366 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2368 .next
2369 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2370 installed binary.
2371 .endlist
2372
2373 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2374 .code
2375 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2376 .endd
2377 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2380 .code
2381 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .endd
2383
2384
2385
2386 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2391 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2392
2393 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2396
2397
2398
2399 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2404 necessary.
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2411 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2414 .code
2415 exim -bV
2416 .endd
2417 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422 example,
2423 .display
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2425 .endd
2426 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2427 .display
2428 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2429 .endd
2430 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432 user agent. For example:
2433 .code
2434 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435 From: user@your.domain.example
2436 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437 Subject: Testing Exim
2438
2439 This is a test message.
2440 ^D
2441 .endd
2442 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2445
2446 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2452 .display
2453 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2454 .endd
2455 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2460
2461 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462 .cindex "lock files"
2463 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2475
2476 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481 incoming SMTP mail.
2482
2483 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2487 production version.
2488
2489
2490 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2503
2504 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510 as follows:
2511 .code
2512 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2516 .endd
2517 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519 favourite user agent.
2520
2521 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2527
2528
2529
2530 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2540 configuration file.
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2548 .code
2549 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2550 .endd
2551 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2556 .code
2557 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2558 .endd
2559 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2560
2561 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2570
2571 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2580
2581
2582 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2583 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585 were present before any other options.
2586 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2587 standard output.
2588 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2596 format.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2602
2603 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2604 .cindex "queue runner"
2605 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2608
2609 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2617
2618
2619 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2625
2626 .ilist
2627 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2633
2634 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2635 .cindex "envelope from"
2636 .cindex "envelope sender"
2637 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641 users to set envelope senders.
2642
2643 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2650
2651 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656 that are available to trusted users.
2657 .next
2658 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2663
2664 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2668
2669 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2673
2674 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676 false.
2677 .endlist
2678
2679
2680 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2696
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700 . creates a man page for the options.
2701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2702
2703 .literal xml
2704 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705 .literal off
2706
2707
2708 .vlist
2709 .vitem &%--%&
2710 .oindex "--"
2711 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2715
2716 .vitem &%--help%&
2717 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2718 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2720 no arguments.
2721
2722 .vitem &%--version%&
2723 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2724 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725 displayed.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2728 &%-Am%&
2729 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2730 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2731 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2732 ignored by Exim.
2733
2734 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2735 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2736 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739 clean; it ignores this option.
2740
2741 .vitem &%-bd%&
2742 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2743 .cindex "daemon"
2744 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745 .cindex "queue runner"
2746 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2749
2750 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2754
2755 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2759
2760 When a listening daemon
2761 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2767 running as root.
2768
2769 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2772
2773 The SIGHUP signal
2774 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2775 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780 .cindex reload configuration
2781 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786 because these are reread each time they are used.
2787
2788 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2789 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2790 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2792
2793 .vitem &%-be%&
2794 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2795 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2801
2802 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806 test data. A line history is supported.
2807
2808 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2815
2816 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2820
2821 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822 defined and macros will be expanded.
2823 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824 available to admin users.
2825
2826 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2828 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831 of a file. For example:
2832 .code
2833 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2834 .endd
2835 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2842 &%-be%&).
2843
2844 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2846 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850 system filters are recognized.
2851
2852 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2854 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2855 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2862 supplied.
2863
2864 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2867 .code
2868 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2869 .endd
2870 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871 variables that are used by the user filter.
2872
2873 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874 .code
2875 # Exim filter
2876 # Sieve filter
2877 .endd
2878 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2881 redirection lists.
2882
2883 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2887
2888 When testing a filter file,
2889 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2890 .cindex "envelope from"
2891 .cindex "envelope sender"
2892 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2897 options).
2898
2899 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2900 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2901 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2904 &$qualify_domain$&.
2905
2906 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2907 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2908 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912 actually being delivered.
2913
2914 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2915 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2916 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2917 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919 prefix.
2920
2921 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2922 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2923 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2924 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926 suffix.
2927
2928 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2929 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2930 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938 after a full stop. For example:
2939 .code
2940 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2942 .endd
2943 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945 conversion to the canonical form is
2946 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2947
2948 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2953
2954 &*Warning 1*&:
2955 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2956 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2959 connection.
2960
2961 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2964
2965 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970 session were authenticated.
2971
2972 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2975
2976 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978 specialized SMTP test program such as
2979 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2980
2981 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2982 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2983 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985 updating the callout cache database.
2986
2987 .vitem &%-bi%&
2988 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2989 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2990 .cindex "building alias file"
2991 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2996 recognized.
2997
2998 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3004 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
3005
3006 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3007 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
3008 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009 .cindex "querying exim information"
3010 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3015
3016 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3017 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020 recognised DSCP names.
3021
3022 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030 way to guarantee a correct response.
3031
3032 .vitem &%-bm%&
3033 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3034 .cindex "local message reception"
3035 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040 if no other conflicting option is present.
3041
3042 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045 suppressing this for special cases.
3046
3047 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3049
3050 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3053
3054 The format
3055 .cindex "message" "format"
3056 .cindex "format" "message"
3057 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3058 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3062 .code
3063 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3065 .endd
3066 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3071
3072 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3077
3078 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3081 .cindex "malware scan test"
3082 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3084 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3089
3090 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093 This option requires admin privileges.
3094
3095 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3098
3099 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3100 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3101 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3108
3109 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3114
3115 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119
3120
3121 .vitem &%-bP%&
3122 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3123 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128 arguments, for example:
3129 .code
3130 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3131 .endd
3132 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137 users, the output is as in this example:
3138 .code
3139 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3140 .endd
3141 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3143
3144 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146 backward compatibility.)
3147 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152 name will not be output.
3153
3154 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160 written directly into the spool directory.
3161
3162 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3163 .code
3164 exim -bP +local_domains
3165 .endd
3166 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3168
3169 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174 that driver are output. For example:
3175 .code
3176 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3177 .endd
3178 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3183 &%authenticators%&.
3184
3185 .cindex "environment"
3186 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3188 variables.
3189
3190 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194 The output format is one item per line.
3195 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196 the exit status will be nonzero.
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bp%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3200 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206 to allow any user to see the queue.
3207
3208 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3209 .code
3210 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3212 <other addresses>
3213 .endd
3214 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215 .cindex "size" "of message"
3216 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222 before the sender address.
3223
3224 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3227
3228 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3233 complete.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3237 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3238 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3241 of just &"D"&.
3242
3243
3244 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3245 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3246 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250
3251
3252 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3253 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3254 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3258
3259 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3260 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3262
3263 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3264 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3265 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266
3267
3268 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3269 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3270 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274
3275
3276 .vitem &%-brt%&
3277 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3278 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3283 .code
3284 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3286 .endd
3287 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3296 .code
3297 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299 .endd
3300
3301 .vitem &%-brw%&
3302 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3303 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3310
3311 .vitem &%-bS%&
3312 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3313 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3322
3323 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3326
3327 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3335
3336 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3341
3342 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3344
3345 .vitem &%-bs%&
3346 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3347 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3349 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353 messages to the MTA.
3354
3355 In
3356 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3357 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3363
3364 .cindex "inetd"
3365 The
3366 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372 the listening daemon.
3373
3374 .vitem &%-bt%&
3375 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3376 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377 .cindex "address" "testing"
3378 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3383
3384 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3386
3387 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3389 security issues.
3390
3391 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3396 program.
3397
3398 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3402
3403 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3407 always shown.
3408
3409 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3411 message,
3412 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418 doing such tests.
3419
3420 .vitem &%-bV%&
3421 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3422 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3423 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428
3429 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435 dynamic testing facilities.
3436
3437 .vitem &%-bv%&
3438 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3439 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440 .cindex "address" "verification"
3441 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3447
3448 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3451
3452 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3454
3455 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457 security issues.
3458
3459 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3464
3465 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471 to succeed.
3472
3473 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476
3477 The
3478 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482
3483 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487
3488 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3489 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3490 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3492 might happen.
3493
3494 .vitem &%-bw%&
3495 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3496 .cindex "daemon"
3497 .cindex "inetd"
3498 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3502
3503 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506 each port only when the first connection is received.
3507
3508 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3510
3511 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3512 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3513 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3522
3523 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3532
3533 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3540
3541 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3548
3549 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3552 configuration file.
3553
3554 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558 specified by this option.
3559
3560
3561 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3562 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3563 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3569
3570 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3577
3578 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581 synonymous:
3582 .code
3583 exim -DABC ...
3584 exim -DABC= ...
3585 .endd
3586 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3588 example:
3589 .code
3590 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3591 .endd
3592 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3594
3595
3596 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3597 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3598 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3605 return code.
3606
3607 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3614 are:
3615 .display
3616 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617 &`auth `& authenticators
3618 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623 &`filter `& filter handling
3624 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626 &`ident `& ident lookup
3627 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3629 &`load `& system load checks
3630 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633 &`memory `& memory handling
3634 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3638 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3639 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640 &`retry `& retry handling
3641 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642 &`route `& address routing
3643 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3644 &`tls `& TLS logic
3645 &`transport `& transports
3646 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647 &`verify `& address verification logic
3648 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3649 .endd
3650 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655 turn everything off.
3656
3657 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3662 rather than stderr.
3663
3664 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3669 run in parallel.
3670
3671 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3673 in processing.
3674
3675 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3681
3682 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3684
3685 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3686 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3687 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3691
3692 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3693 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3697
3698 .vitem &%-E%&
3699 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3700 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3708
3709 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3710 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3715
3716 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3717 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3718 .cindex "sender" "name"
3719 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3720 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3727 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3728 .cindex "sender" "address"
3729 .cindex "address" "sender"
3730 .cindex "trusted users"
3731 .cindex "envelope from"
3732 .cindex "envelope sender"
3733 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3734 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3737 users to use it.
3738
3739 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3743 domain.
3744
3745 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749 examples of shell commands:
3750 .code
3751 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752 exim -f "" user@domain
3753 .endd
3754 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3756 &%-bv%& options.
3757
3758 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3762
3763 White
3764 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3765 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3770
3771 .vitem &%-G%&
3772 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3773 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3775 .code
3776 control = suppress_local_fixups
3777 .endd
3778 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3780 in future.
3781
3782 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3783 this option.
3784
3785 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3786 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3787 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790 headers.)
3791
3792 .vitem &%-i%&
3793 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3794 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3800
3801 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3802 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3803 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3809
3810 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3811
3812 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3813 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3814 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3815 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3821
3822 Retry
3823 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3829
3830 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3834
3835 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3836 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3837 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843 can be used only by an admin user.
3844
3845 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3847 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3848 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3856
3857 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3858 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3859 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3862
3863 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3864 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3865 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3870 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3871 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3876 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3880
3881 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3882 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3883 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3886
3887 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3888 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3889 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3895
3896 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3897 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3898 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901 connection.
3902
3903 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3904 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3905 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3908
3909 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3910 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3911 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3915
3916 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3918 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3931
3932 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3933 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3934 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3936 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3942
3943 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3945 .cindex "freezing messages"
3946 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3952 user.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3955 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3956 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3957 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3964 user.
3965
3966 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967 .oindex "&%-MG%&"
3968 .cindex queue named
3969 .cindex "named queues"
3970 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3971 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3972 queue to the given named queue.
3973 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3974 string to define the default queue.
3975 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3976 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3977
3978 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3980 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3981 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3982 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3983 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3984 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3987 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3988 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3989 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3990 .cindex "removing recipients"
3991 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3992 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3993 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3994 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3995 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3996 can be used only by an admin user.
3997
3998 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4000 .cindex "removing messages"
4001 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4002 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4003 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4004 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4005 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4006 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4007 placed in the queue.
4008
4009 . .new
4010 . .vitem &%-MS%&
4011 . .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4012 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4013 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4014 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4015 . a bounce message.
4016 . .wen
4017
4018 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4019 .oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4020 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4021 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4022 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4023 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4024 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4025 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4026 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4027 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4028 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4029
4030 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4031 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4032 .cindex "thawing messages"
4033 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4034 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4035 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4036 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4037 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4038 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4039 by an admin user.
4040
4041 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4043 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4044 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4045 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4046 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4050 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4051 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4052 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4053 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4054 only by an admin user.
4055
4056 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4057 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4058 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4059 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4060 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4061 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4062 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4063
4064 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4065 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4066 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4067 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4068 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4069 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4070
4071 .vitem &%-m%&
4072 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4073 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4074 treats it that way too.
4075
4076 .vitem &%-N%&
4077 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4078 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4079 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4080 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4081 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4082 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4083 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4084 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4085 than &"=>"&.
4086
4087 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4088 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4089 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4090 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4091 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4092 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4093 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4094 for that message.
4095
4096 .vitem &%-n%&
4097 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4098 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4099 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4100 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4101 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4102
4103 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4104 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4105 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4106 Exim.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4109 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4110 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4111 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4112 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4113 description above.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4116 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4117 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4118 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4119 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4120 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4121 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4122 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4123
4124 .vitem &%-odb%&
4125 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4126 .cindex "background delivery"
4127 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4128 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4129 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4130 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4131 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4132 processes to finish.
4133
4134 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4135 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4136 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4137 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4138
4139 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4140 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4141 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4142 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-odf%&
4145 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4146 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4147 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4148 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4149 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4150 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4151 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4152
4153 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4154 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4155 during deliveries.
4156
4157 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4158 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4159
4160 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4161 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4162 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4163 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4164
4165
4166 .vitem &%-odi%&
4167 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4168 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4169 Sendmail.
4170
4171 .vitem &%-odq%&
4172 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4173 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4174 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4175 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4176 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4177 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4178 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4179 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4180 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4181 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4182 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4183 forces queueing.
4184
4185 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4186 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4187 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4188 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4189 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4190 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4191 configuration file is in effect.
4192
4193 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4194 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4195 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4196 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4197 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4198 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4199 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4200 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4201 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4202 &%-qq%& option.
4203
4204 .vitem &%-oee%&
4205 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4206 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4207 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4208 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4209 message.
4210
4211 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4212 Provided
4213 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4214 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4215 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4216 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4217
4218 .vitem &%-oem%&
4219 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4222 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4223 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4224 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-oep%&
4227 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4228 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4229 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4230 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4231 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4232 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4235 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4236 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4237 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4238 effect as &%-oep%&.
4239
4240 .vitem &%-oew%&
4241 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4242 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4243 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4244 effect as &%-oem%&.
4245
4246 .vitem &%-oi%&
4247 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4248 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4249 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4250 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4251 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4252 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4253 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4254
4255 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4256 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4257 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4258
4259 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4260 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4261 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4262 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4263 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4264 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4265 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4266 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4267
4268 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4269 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4270 .code
4271 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4272 .endd
4273 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4274 followed by a colon and the port number:
4275 .code
4276 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4277 .endd
4278 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4279 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4280 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4281 whichever one is last.
4282
4283 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4284 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4285 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4286 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4287 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4288 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4289 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4290 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4291
4292 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4293 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4294 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4295 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4296 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4297 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4298 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4299 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4302 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4303 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4304 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4305 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4306 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4307 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4308 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4309 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4310 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4311
4312 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4313 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4314 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4315 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4316 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4317 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4318 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4319
4320 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4321 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4322 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4323 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4324 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4325 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4326 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4327 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4328 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4329
4330 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4331 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4332 is sending the bounce.
4333
4334 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4335 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4336 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4337 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4338 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4339 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4340 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4341 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4342 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4343 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4344 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4345 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4346
4347 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4348 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4349 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4350 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4351 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4352 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4353 uses the name it is given.
4354
4355 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4356 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4357 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4358 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4359 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4360 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4361 used, when there is no default.
4362
4363 .vitem &%-om%&
4364 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4365 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4366 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4367 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4368 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4369
4370 .vitem &%-oo%&
4371 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4372 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4373 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4374 whatever that means.
4375
4376 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4377 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4378 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4379 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4380 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4381 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4382 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4383 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4384 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4385
4386 .new
4387 .vitem &%-oPX%&
4388 .oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4389 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4390 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4391 This option is not intended for general use.
4392 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4393 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4394 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4395 .wen
4396
4397 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4398 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4399 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4400 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4401 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4402 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4403 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4404
4405 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4406 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4407 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4408 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4409 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4410 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4411 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4412 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4413
4414 .vitem &%-ov%&
4415 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4416 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4419 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4420 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4421 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4422 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4423 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4424 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4425 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4426 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4427 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4428
4429 .vitem &%-pd%&
4430 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4431 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4432 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4433 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4434 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4435 needed.
4436
4437 .vitem &%-ps%&
4438 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4439 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4440 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4441 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4442 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4443 started.
4444
4445 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4446 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4447 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4448 .display
4449 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4450 .endd
4451 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4452 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4453 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4454 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4455 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4456 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4457
4458 .vitem &%-q%&
4459 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4460 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4461 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4462 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4463 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4464 and &%-S%& options).
4465
4466 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4467 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4468 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4469 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4470 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4471 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4472 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4473
4474 If
4475 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4476 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4477 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4478 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4479 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4480 proceeding.
4481
4482 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4483 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4484 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4485 this to be repeated periodically.
4486
4487 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4488 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4489 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4490 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4491
4492 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4493 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4494 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4495
4496 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4497 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4498 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4499 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4500
4501 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4502 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4503 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4504 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4505 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4506 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4507 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4508 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4509 transports are run.
4510
4511 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4512 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4513 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4514 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4515 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4516 delivered down a single SMTP
4517 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4518 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4519 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4520 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4521 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4522 intermittently.
4523
4524 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4525 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4526 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4527 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4528 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4529 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4530 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4531
4532 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4533 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4534 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4535 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4536 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4537 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4538 their retry times are tried.
4539
4540 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4541 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4542 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4543 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4544 frozen or not.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4547 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4548 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4549 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4550 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4551 for later delivery.
4552
4553 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4554 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4555 .cindex queue named
4556 .cindex "named queues"
4557 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4558 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4559 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4560 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4561 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4562 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4563
4564 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4565 will specify a queue to operate on.
4566 For example:
4567 .code
4568 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4569 mailq -qGquarantine
4570 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4571 .endd
4572
4573 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4574 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4575 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4576 starting message id. For example:
4577 .code
4578 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4579 .endd
4580 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4581 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4582 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4583 .code
4584 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4585 .endd
4586 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4587 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4588 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4589 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4590 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4591 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4592
4593 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4594 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4595 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4596 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4597 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4598 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4599 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4600 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4601 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4602 .code
4603 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4604 .endd
4605 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4606 process every 30 minutes.
4607
4608 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4609 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4613 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4614 compatibility.
4615
4616 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4617 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4618 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4619
4620 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4621 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4622 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4623 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4624 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4625 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4626 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4627 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4628 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4629
4630 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4631 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4632 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4633 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4634 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4635 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4636
4637 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4638 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4639 .code
4640 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4641 .endd
4642 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4643 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4644 applied to each queue run.
4645
4646 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4647 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4648 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4649 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4650 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4651 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4652 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4653 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4654 address will be skipped.
4655
4656 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4657 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4658 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4659 &'ff'& is present.
4660
4661 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4662 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4663 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4664 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4665 an arbitrary command instead.
4666
4667 .vitem &%-r%&
4668 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4669 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4670
4671 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4672 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4673 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4674 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4675 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4676 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4677 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4678 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4679
4680 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4681 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4682 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4683 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4684 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4685
4686 .vitem &%-t%&
4687 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4688 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4689 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4690 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4691 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4692 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4693 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4694 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4695 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4696 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4697
4698 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4699 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4700 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4701 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4702 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4703 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4704 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4705 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4706 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4707 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4708 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4709
4710 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4711 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4712 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4713 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4714 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4715 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4716
4717 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4718 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4719 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4720 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4721 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4722 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4723 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4724 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4725 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4726
4727 .vitem &%-ti%&
4728 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4729 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4730 compatibility with Sendmail.
4731
4732 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4733 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4734 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4735 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4736 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4737 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4738 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4739 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4740
4741
4742 .vitem &%-U%&
4743 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4744 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4745 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4746 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4747 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4748 set. Exim ignores this option.
4749
4750 .vitem &%-v%&
4751 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4752 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4753 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4754 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4755 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4756 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4757 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4758 unconditional.
4759
4760 .vitem &%-x%&
4761 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4762 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4763 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4764 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4765 this option.
4766
4767 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4768 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4769 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4770 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4771
4772 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4773 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4774 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4775 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4776 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4777 under most shells.
4778 .endlist
4779
4780 .ecindex IIDclo1
4781 .ecindex IIDclo2
4782
4783
4784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4785 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4786 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4787 . creates a man page for the options.
4788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4789
4790 .literal xml
4791 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4792 .literal off
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4800
4801
4802 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4803 "The runtime configuration file"
4804
4805 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4806 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4807 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4808 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4809 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4810 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4811 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4812 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4813 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4814 control.
4815
4816 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4817 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4818 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4819 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4820 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4821 actually alter the string.
4822
4823 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4824 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4825 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4826 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4827 existing file in the list.
4828
4829 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4830 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4831 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4832 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4833 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4834 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4835 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4836 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4837 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4838 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4839 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4840
4841 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4842 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4843 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4844 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4845 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4846
4847 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4848 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4849 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4850 compromise the Exim user account.
4851
4852 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4853 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4854 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4855 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4856 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4857 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4858 configuration.
4859
4860
4861
4862 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4863 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4864 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4865 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4866 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4867 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4868 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4869 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4870 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4871 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4872 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4873
4874 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4875 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4876 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4877 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4878 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4879 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4880 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4881 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4882 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4883 &%-M%&).
4884
4885 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4886 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4887 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4888 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4889 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4890
4891 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4892 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4893 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4894 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4895 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4896 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4897
4898 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4899 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4900 necessarily be discarded.
4901 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4902 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4903 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4904 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4905 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4906 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4907
4908 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4909 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4910 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4911 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4912 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4913 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4914 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4915
4916 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4917 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4918 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4919
4920
4921
4922 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4923 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4924 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4925 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4926 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4927 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4928 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4929 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4930
4931 .ilist
4932 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4933 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4934 .next
4935 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4936 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4937 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4938 .next
4939 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4940 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4941 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4942 .next
4943 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4944 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4945 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4946 .next
4947 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4948 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4949 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4950 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4951 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4952 .next
4953 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4954 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4955 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4956 .next
4957 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4958 want to use this feature, you must set
4959 .code
4960 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4961 .endd
4962 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4963 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4964 .endlist
4965
4966 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4967 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4968 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4969 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4970
4971 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4972 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4973 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4974 and does not introduce a comment.
4975
4976 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4977 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4978 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4979 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4980 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4981
4982 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4983 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4984 change settings as required.
4985
4986 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4987 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4988 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4989 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4990 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4991 described.
4992
4993
4994
4995 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4996 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4997 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4998 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4999 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5000 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5001 using this syntax:
5002 .display
5003 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5004 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5005 .endd
5006 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5007 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5008 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5009 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5010 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5011 is required.
5012
5013 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5014 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5015 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5016 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5017
5018 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5019 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5020 for example:
5021 .code
5022 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5023 .include /some/file
5024 .endd
5025 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5026 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5027 inclusion appears.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5032 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5033 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5034 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5035 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5036 definition, and must be of the form
5037 .display
5038 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5039 .endd
5040 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5041 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5042 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5043 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5044 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5045
5046 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5047 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5048 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5049
5050 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5051 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5052 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5053 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5054 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5055 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5056 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5057 define
5058 .display
5059 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5060 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5061 .endd
5062 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5063 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5064 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5065 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5066 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5067 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5068
5069
5070 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5071 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5072 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5073 &'='&. For example:
5074 .code
5075 MAC = initial value
5076 ...
5077 MAC == updated value
5078 .endd
5079 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5080 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5081 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5082 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5083 .code
5084 MAC = initial value
5085 ...
5086 MAC == MAC and something added
5087 .endd
5088 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5089 from a number of other files.
5090
5091 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5092 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5093 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5094 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5095 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5096 file to be ignored.
5097
5098
5099
5100 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5101 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5102 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5103 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5104 .code
5105 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5106 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5107 .endd
5108 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5109 .code
5110 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5111 .endd
5112 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5113 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5114 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5115
5116
5117 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5118 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5119 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5120 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5121 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5122 (see below).
5123
5124 The following classes of macros are defined:
5125 .display
5126 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5127 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5128 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5129 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5130 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5131 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5132 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5133 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5134 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5135 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5136 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5137 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5138 .endd
5139
5140 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5141
5142
5143 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5144 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5145 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5146 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5147 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5148 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5149 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5150
5151 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5152 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5153 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5154 line. Thus:
5155 .code
5156 .ifdef AAA
5157 message_size_limit = 50M
5158 .else
5159 message_size_limit = 100M
5160 .endif
5161 .endd
5162 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5163 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5164 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5165 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5166 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5167
5168 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5169 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5170 in this line"& will always be true.
5171
5172 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5173 to clarify complicated nestings.
5174
5175
5176
5177 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5178 .cindex "common option syntax"
5179 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5180 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5181 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5182 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5183 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5184 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5185 space) and then the value. For example:
5186 .code
5187 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5188 .endd
5189 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5190 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5191 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5192 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5193 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5194 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5195 word &"hide"&. For example:
5196 .code
5197 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5198 .endd
5199 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5200 .code
5201 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5202 .endd
5203 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5204 all instances of the same driver.
5205
5206 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5207 that are found in option settings.
5208
5209
5210 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5211 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5212 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5213 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5214 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5215 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5216 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5217 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5218 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5219 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5220 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5221 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5222 .code
5223 queue_only
5224 queue_only = true
5225 .endd
5226 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5227 .code
5228 no_queue_only
5229 queue_only = false
5230 .endd
5231 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5232
5233
5234
5235
5236 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5237 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5238 .cindex "format" "integer"
5239 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5240 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5241 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5242 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5243 hexadecimal number.
5244
5245 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5246 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5247 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5248 When the values
5249 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5250 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5251 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5252 used.
5253
5254
5255 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5256 .cindex "integer format"
5257 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5258 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5259 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5260 Such options are always output in octal.
5261
5262
5263 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5264 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5265 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5266 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5267 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5268
5269
5270
5271 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5272 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5273 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5274 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5275 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5276
5277 .table2 30pt
5278 .irow &%s%& seconds
5279 .irow &%m%& minutes
5280 .irow &%h%& hours
5281 .irow &%d%& days
5282 .irow &%w%& weeks
5283 .endtable
5284
5285 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5286 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5287 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5288
5289
5290
5291 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5292 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5293 .cindex "format" "string"
5294 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5295 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5296 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5297 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5298 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5299 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5300 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5301 therefore equivalent:
5302 .code
5303 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5304 trusted_users = uucp:\
5305 # This comment line is ignored
5306 mail
5307 .endd
5308 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5309 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5310 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5311 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5312 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5313
5314 .table2 100pt
5315 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5316 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5317 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5318 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5319 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5320 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5321 character"
5322 .endtable
5323
5324 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5325 character, that character replaces the pair.
5326
5327 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5328 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5329 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5330 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5331 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5332 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5333
5334
5335 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5336 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5337 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5338 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5339 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5340 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5341 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5342 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5343 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5344 within a quoted configuration string.
5345
5346
5347 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5348 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5349 .cindex "format" "user name"
5350 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5351 .cindex "format" "group name"
5352 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5353 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5354 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5355 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5356
5357
5358 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5359 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5360 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5361 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5362 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5363 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5364 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5365 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5366 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5367 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5368 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5369
5370 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5371 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5372 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5373 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5374 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5375 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5376 example, the list
5377 .code
5378 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5379 .endd
5380 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5381
5382 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5383 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5384 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5385 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5386
5387 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5388 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5389 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5390 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5391 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5392 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5393 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5394 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5395 .code
5396 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5397 .endd
5398 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5399 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5400 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5401
5402 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5403 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5404 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5405 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5406 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5407 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5408 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5409 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5410 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5411 .code
5412 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5413 .endd
5414 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5415 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5416 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5417 the value in quotes. For example:
5418 .code
5419 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5420 .endd
5421 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5422 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5423 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5424 enclosing an empty list item.
5425
5426
5427
5428 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5429 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5430 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5431 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5432 .code
5433 senders = user@domain :
5434 .endd
5435 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5436 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5437 items, the second of which is empty:
5438 .code
5439 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5440 .endd
5441 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5442 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5443 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5444 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5445 .code
5446 senders = :
5447 .endd
5448 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5449 is at the end of the list.
5450
5451
5452
5453
5454 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5455 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5456 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5457 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5458 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5459 a sequence of lines like this:
5460 .display
5461 <&'instance name'&>:
5462 <&'option'&>
5463 ...
5464 <&'option'&>
5465 .endd
5466 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5467 followed by three options settings:
5468 .code
5469 localuser:
5470 driver = accept
5471 check_local_user
5472 transport = local_delivery
5473 .endd
5474 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5475 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5476 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5477 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5478 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5479 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5480
5481 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5482 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5483
5484 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5485 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5486 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5487 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5488 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5489 server.
5490
5491 .cindex "generic options"
5492 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5493 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5494 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5495 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5496 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5497 .cindex "private options"
5498 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5499 they all have default values.
5500
5501 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5502 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5503 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5504
5505 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5506 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5507 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5508 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5509 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5510 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5511 configuration lines:
5512 .code
5513 remote_smtp:
5514 driver = smtp
5515 .endd
5516 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5517 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5518 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5519 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5520 thus:
5521 .code
5522 special_smtp:
5523 driver = smtp
5524 port = 1234
5525 command_timeout = 10s
5526 .endd
5527 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5528 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5529 lines.
5530
5531 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5532 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5533 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5534 option.
5535
5536
5537
5538
5539
5540
5541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5543
5544 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5545 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5546 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5547 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5548 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5549 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5550 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5551 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5552 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5553 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5554 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5555
5556
5557
5558 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5559 All macros should be defined before any options.
5560
5561 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5562 .code
5563 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5564 .endd
5565 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5566 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5567 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5568 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5569
5570 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5571 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5572 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5573
5574
5575 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5576 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5577 in the file, after the macros.
5578 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5579 .code
5580 # primary_hostname =
5581 .endd
5582 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5583 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5584 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5585 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5586
5587 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5588 .code
5589 domainlist local_domains = @
5590 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5591 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5592 .endd
5593 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5594 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5595 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5596 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5597
5598 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5599 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5600 on the local host.
5601
5602 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5603 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5604 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5605 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5606 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5607 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5608
5609 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5610 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5611 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5612 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5613 domain is permitted.
5614
5615 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5616 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5617 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5618 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5619 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5620 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5621
5622 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5623 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5624 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5625
5626 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5627 .code
5628 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5629 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5630 .endd
5631 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5632 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5633 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5634 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5635 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5636 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5637 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5638 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5639 contents of a message to be checked.
5640
5641 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5642 .code
5643 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5644 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5645 .endd
5646 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5647 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5648 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5649 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5650
5651 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5652 .code
5653 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5654 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5655 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5656 .endd
5657 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5658 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5659 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5660 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5661 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5662 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5663 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5664
5665 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5666 .code
5667 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5668 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5669 .endd
5670 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5671 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5672 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5673 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5674 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5675 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5676 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5677 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5678 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5679 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5680 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5681 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5682 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5683 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5684 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5685 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5686 consequences).
5687 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5688 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5689 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5690 which should be used in preference to 587.
5691 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5692 these ports.
5693 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5694
5695 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5696 .code
5697 # qualify_domain =
5698 # qualify_recipient =
5699 .endd
5700 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5701 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5702 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5703 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5704 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5705 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5706
5707 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5708 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5709 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5710 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5711 .code
5712 # allow_domain_literals
5713 .endd
5714 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5715 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5716 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5717 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5718 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5719 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5720
5721 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5722 .code
5723 never_users = root
5724 .endd
5725 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5726 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5727 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5728 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5729 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5730 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5731 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5732 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5733
5734 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5735 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5736 line,
5737 .code
5738 host_lookup = *
5739 .endd
5740 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5741 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5742 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5743 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5744 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5745 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5746 unreachable.
5747
5748 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5749 1413 (hence their names):
5750 .code
5751 rfc1413_hosts = *
5752 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5753 .endd
5754 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5755 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5756 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5757 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5758 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5759 information, you can change this.
5760
5761 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5762 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5763 .code
5764 prdr_enable = true
5765 .endd
5766
5767 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5768 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5769 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5770 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5771 .code
5772 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5773 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5774 .endd
5775 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5776 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5777
5778 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5779 over the default:
5780 .code
5781 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5782 +tls_certificate_verified
5783 .endd
5784
5785 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5786 .code
5787 # percent_hack_domains =
5788 .endd
5789 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5790 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5791 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5792
5793 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5794 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5795 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5796 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5797 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5798 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5799 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5800 always bounce messages.
5801 .code
5802 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5803 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5804 .endd
5805 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5806 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5807 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5808 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5809 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5810
5811 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5812 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5813 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5814 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5815 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5816 not often needed).
5817 .code
5818 # split_spool_directory = true
5819 .endd
5820
5821 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5822 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5823 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5824 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5825 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5826 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5827 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5828 .code
5829 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5830 .endd
5831
5832 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5833 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5834 that are not 8-bit clean.
5835 .code
5836 # accept_8bitmime = false
5837 .endd
5838
5839 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5840 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5841 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5842 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5843 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5844 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5845 .code
5846 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5847 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5848 .endd
5849
5850
5851 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5852 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5853 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5854 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5855 It starts with the line
5856 .code
5857 begin acl
5858 .endd
5859 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5860 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5861 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5862
5863 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5864 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5865 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5866 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5867 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5868 result of the ACL processing.
5869 .code
5870 acl_check_rcpt:
5871 .endd
5872 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5873 ACL, and names it.
5874 .code
5875 accept hosts = :
5876 .endd
5877 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5878 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5879 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5880 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5881 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5882 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5883
5884 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5885 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5886 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5887 manner.
5888 .code
5889 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5890 domains = +local_domains
5891 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5892
5893 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5894 domains = !+local_domains
5895 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5896 .endd
5897 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5898 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5899 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5900 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5901 in Internet mail addresses.
5902
5903 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5904 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5905 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5906 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5907 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5908 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5909 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5910 policy of being as safe as possible.
5911
5912 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5913 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5914 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5915 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5916 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5917 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5918
5919 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5920 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5921 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5922 have to modify this rule.
5923
5924 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5925 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5926 common convention of local parts constructed as
5927 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5928 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5929 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5930 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5931 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5932 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5933
5934 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5935 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5936 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5937 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5938 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5939 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5940 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5941 .code
5942 accept local_parts = postmaster
5943 domains = +local_domains
5944 .endd
5945 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5946 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5947 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5948 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5949 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5950
5951 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5952 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5953 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5954 .code
5955 require verify = sender
5956 .endd
5957 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5958 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5959 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5960 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5961 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5962 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5963 discusses the details of address verification.
5964 .code
5965 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5966 control = submission
5967 .endd
5968 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5969 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5970 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5971 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5972 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5973 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5974 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5975 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5976 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5977 .code
5978 accept authenticated = *
5979 control = submission
5980 .endd
5981 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5982 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5983 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5984 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5985 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5986 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5987 .code
5988 require message = relay not permitted
5989 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5990 .endd
5991 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5992 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5993 .code
5994 require verify = recipient
5995 .endd
5996 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5997 fails, the address is rejected.
5998 .code
5999 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6000 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6001 # $dnslist_text
6002 # dnslists = black.list.example
6003 #
6004 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6005 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6006 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6007 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6008 .endd
6009 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6010 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6011 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6012 line.
6013 .code
6014 # require verify = csa
6015 .endd
6016 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6017 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6018 records.
6019 .code
6020 accept
6021 .endd
6022 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6023 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6024 .code
6025 acl_check_data:
6026 .endd
6027 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6028 of this ACL are commented out:
6029 .code
6030 # deny malware = *
6031 # message = This message contains a virus \
6032 # ($malware_name).
6033 .endd
6034 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6035 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6036 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6037 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6038 .code
6039 # warn spam = nobody
6040 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6041 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6042 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6043 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6044 .endd
6045 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6046 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6047 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6048 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6049 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6050 whatever the spam score.
6051 .code
6052 accept
6053 .endd
6054 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6055
6056
6057 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6058 .cindex "default" "routers"
6059 .cindex "routers" "default"
6060 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6061 by the line
6062 .code
6063 begin routers
6064 .endd
6065 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6066 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6067 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6068 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6069 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6070 .code
6071 # domain_literal:
6072 # driver = ipliteral
6073 # domains = !+local_domains
6074 # transport = remote_smtp
6075 .endd
6076 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6077 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6078 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6079 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6080 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6081
6082 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6083 macro has been defined, per
6084 .code
6085 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6086 smarthost:
6087 #...
6088 .else
6089 dnslookup:
6090 #...
6091 .endif
6092 .endd
6093
6094 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6095 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6096 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6097 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6098
6099 .code
6100 smarthost:
6101 driver = manualroute
6102 domains = ! +local_domains
6103 transport = smarthost_smtp
6104 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6105 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6106 no_more
6107 .endd
6108 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6109 specified by the line
6110 .code
6111 domains = ! +local_domains
6112 .endd
6113 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6114 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6115 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6116 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6117 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6118 passed on to the following routers.
6119
6120 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6121 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6122 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6123 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6124
6125 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6126 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6127 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6128 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6129 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6130 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6131 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6132
6133 .code
6134 dnslookup:
6135 driver = dnslookup
6136 domains = ! +local_domains
6137 transport = remote_smtp
6138 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6139 no_more
6140 .endd
6141 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6142
6143 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6144 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6145 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6146 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6147 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6148
6149 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6150 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6151 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6152 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6153 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6154 the address fails and is bounced.
6155
6156 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6157 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6158 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6159 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6160 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6161 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6162 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6163 out.
6164 .code
6165 system_aliases:
6166 driver = redirect
6167 allow_fail
6168 allow_defer
6169 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6170 # user = exim
6171 file_transport = address_file
6172 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6173 .endd
6174 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6175 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6176 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6177 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6178 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6179 the next router.
6180
6181 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6182 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6183 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6184 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6185 .code
6186 userforward:
6187 driver = redirect
6188 check_local_user
6189 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6190 # local_part_suffix_optional
6191 file = $home/.forward
6192 # allow_filter
6193 no_verify
6194 no_expn
6195 check_ancestor
6196 file_transport = address_file
6197 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6198 reply_transport = address_reply
6199 .endd
6200 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6201 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6202 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6203 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6204 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6205 namely:
6206 .code
6207 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6208 # local_part_suffix_optional
6209 .endd
6210 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6211 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6212 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6213 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6214 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6215 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6216 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6217
6218 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6219 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6220 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6221 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6222
6223 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6224 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6225 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6226 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6227 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6228 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6229 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6230
6231 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6232 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6233 There are two reasons for doing this:
6234
6235 .olist
6236 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6237 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6238 unnecessary work.
6239 .next
6240 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6241 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6242 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6243 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6244 this time.
6245 .endlist
6246
6247 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6248 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6249 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6250 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6251
6252 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6253 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6254 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6255 .code
6256 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6257 .endd
6258 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6259 transport.
6260 .code
6261 localuser:
6262 driver = accept
6263 check_local_user
6264 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6265 # local_part_suffix_optional
6266 transport = local_delivery
6267 .endd
6268 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6269 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6270 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6271 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6272 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6273
6274
6275 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6276 .cindex "default" "transports"
6277 .cindex "transports" "default"
6278 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6279 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6280 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6281 .code
6282 begin transports
6283 .endd
6284 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6285 .code
6286 remote_smtp:
6287 driver = smtp
6288 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6289 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6290 hosts_try_prdr = *
6291 .endif
6292 .endd
6293 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6294 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6295 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6296 with over-long lines.
6297
6298 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6299 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6300 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6301 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6302
6303 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6304 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6305 usual federated system.
6306
6307 .code
6308 smarthost_smtp:
6309 driver = smtp
6310 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6311 multi_domain
6312 #
6313 .ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6314 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6315 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6316 hosts_require_tls = *
6317 tls_verify_hosts = *
6318 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6319 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6320 # or not:
6321 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6322 #
6323 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6324 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6325 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6326 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6327 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6328 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6329 #
6330 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6331 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6332 .endif
6333 .ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6334 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6335 .endif
6336 .endif
6337 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6338 hosts_try_prdr = *
6339 .endif
6340 .endd
6341 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6342 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6343 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6344 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6345 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6346 then no other options are defined.
6347 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6348 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6349 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6350 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6351 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6352 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6353 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6354 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6355 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6356 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6357 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6358
6359 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6360
6361 All other options are defaulted.
6362 .code
6363 local_delivery:
6364 driver = appendfile
6365 file = /var/mail/$home
6366 delivery_date_add
6367 envelope_to_add
6368 return_path_add
6369 # group = mail
6370 # mode = 0660
6371 .endd
6372 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6373 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6374 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6375 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6376 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6377 show how this can be done.
6378
6379 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6380 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6381 similarly-named options above.
6382 .code
6383 address_pipe:
6384 driver = pipe
6385 return_output
6386 .endd
6387 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6388 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6389 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6390 be returned to the sender.
6391 .code
6392 address_file:
6393 driver = appendfile
6394 delivery_date_add
6395 envelope_to_add
6396 return_path_add
6397 .endd
6398 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6399 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6400 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6401 .code
6402 address_reply:
6403 driver = autoreply
6404 .endd
6405 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6406 filter files.
6407
6408
6409
6410 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6411 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6412 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6413 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6414 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6415 introduced by the line
6416 .code
6417 begin retry
6418 .endd
6419 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6420 errors:
6421 .code
6422 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6423 .endd
6424 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6425 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6426 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6427 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6428 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6429
6430 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6431 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6432 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6433
6434
6435 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6436 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6437 .code
6438 begin rewrite
6439 .endd
6440 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6441 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6442
6443
6444
6445 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6446 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6447 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6448 .code
6449 begin authenticators
6450 .endd
6451 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6452 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6453 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6454 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6455 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6456 to support most MUA software.
6457
6458 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6459 .code
6460 #PLAIN:
6461 # driver = plaintext
6462 # server_set_id = $auth2
6463 # server_prompts = :
6464 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6465 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6466 .endd
6467 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6468 .code
6469 #LOGIN:
6470 # driver = plaintext
6471 # server_set_id = $auth1
6472 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6473 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6474 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6475 .endd
6476
6477 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6478 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6479 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6480 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6481 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6482 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6483 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6484 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6485
6486 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6487 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6488 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6489 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6490
6491 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6492 usercode and password are in different positions.
6493 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6494
6495 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6496
6497
6498
6499 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6501
6502 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6503
6504 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6505 .cindex "PCRE"
6506 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6507 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6508 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6509 regular expressions is discussed in
6510 online Perl manpages, in
6511 many Perl reference books, and also in
6512 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6513 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6514 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6515 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6516 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6517
6518 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6519 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6520 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6521 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6522 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6523 case-insensitive.
6524
6525 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6526 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6527 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6528 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6529 .code
6530 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6531 .endd
6532 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6533 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6534 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6535 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6536 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6537 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6538 matched.
6539
6540 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6541 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6542 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6543 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6544 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6545 match anywhere in the subject string.
6546
6547 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6548 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6549 .code
6550 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6551 .endd
6552 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6553 You need to use:
6554 .code
6555 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6556 .endd
6557 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6558 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6559
6560
6561
6562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6564
6565 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6566 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6567 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6568 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6569 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6570 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6571
6572 .olist
6573 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6574 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6575 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6576 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6577 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6578 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6579 .next
6580 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6581 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6582 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6583 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6584 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6585 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6586 .endlist
6587
6588 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6589 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6590 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6591 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6592 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6593 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6594
6595 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6596 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6597 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6598 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6599 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6600 .code
6601 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6602 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6603 .endd
6604 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6605 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6606 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6607 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6608 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6609 .code
6610 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6611 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6612 .endd
6613 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6614 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6615
6616 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6617 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6618 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6619 .code
6620 domain1:
6621 domain2:
6622 .endd
6623 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6624 matches the list item.
6625
6626 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6627 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6628 .code
6629 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6630 .endd
6631 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6632 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6633 causes a second lookup to occur.
6634
6635 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6636 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6637 lookup is permitted.
6638
6639
6640 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6641 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6642 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6643 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6644
6645 .ilist
6646 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6647 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6648 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6649 .next
6650 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6651 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6652 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6653 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6654 .endlist
6655
6656 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6657 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6658 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6659 .code
6660 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6661 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6662 .endd
6663 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6664 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6665 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6666
6667
6668
6669
6670 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6671 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6672 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6673 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6674
6675 .ilist
6676 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6677 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6678 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6679 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6680 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6681 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6682 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6683 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6684 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6685 .display
6686 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6687 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6688 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6689 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6690 .endd
6691 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6692 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6693 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6694 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6695 .next
6696 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6697 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6698 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6699 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6700 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6701 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6702 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6703
6704 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6705 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6706 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6707 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6708 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6709 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6710 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6711 .next
6712 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6714 .cindex "sasldb2"
6715 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6716 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6717 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6718 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6719 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6720 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6721 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6722 .next
6723 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6724 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6725 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6726 .cindex "Courier"
6727 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6728 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6729 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6730 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6731 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6732 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6733 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6734 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6735 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6736 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6737 .next
6738 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6739 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6740 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6741 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6742 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6743 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6744 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6745 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6746 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6747 .next
6748 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6749 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6750 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6751 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6752 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6753 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6754 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6755 .code
6756 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6757 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6758 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6759 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6760 .endd
6761 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6762 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6763 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6764 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6765 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6766
6767 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6768 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6769 lookup types support only literal keys.
6770
6771 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6772 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6773 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6774
6775 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6776 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6777 notation before executing the lookup.)
6778 .next
6779 .cindex lookup json
6780 .cindex json "lookup type"
6781 .cindex JSON expansions
6782 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6783 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6784 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6785 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6786 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6787 of the JSON structure.
6788 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6789 nunbered array element is selected.
6790 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6791 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6792 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6793 is returned.
6794 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6795 .next
6796 .cindex "linear search"
6797 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6798 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6799 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6800 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6801 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6802 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6803 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6804 in the file is used.
6805
6806 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6807 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6808 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6809 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6810 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6811 colon, for example:
6812 .code
6813 baduser: :fail:
6814 .endd
6815 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6816 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6817 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6818 wildcarding of any kind.
6819
6820 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6821 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6822 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6823 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6824 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6825 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6826 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6827 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6828 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6829
6830 .next
6831 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6832 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6833 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6834 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6835 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6836 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6837 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6838 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6839
6840 .next
6841 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6842 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6843 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6844 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6845 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6846 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6847 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6848 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6849 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6850
6851 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6852 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6853 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6854 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6855
6856 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6857 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6858
6859 .olist
6860 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6861 .code
6862 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6863 *fish data for anythingfish
6864 .endd
6865 .next
6866 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6867 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6868 .code
6869 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6870 .endd
6871 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6872 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6873 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6874 .code
6875 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6876 .endd
6877 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6878 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6879 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6880 .code
6881 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6882 .endd
6883
6884 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6885 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6886 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6887 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6888 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6889
6890 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6891 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6892 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6893 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6894 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6895
6896 .next
6897 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6898 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6899 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6900 example:
6901 .code
6902 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6903 .endd
6904 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6905 .endlist olist
6906
6907 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6908 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6909 be followed by optional colons.
6910
6911 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6912 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6913 lookup types support only literal keys.
6914
6915 .next
6916 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6917 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6918 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6919 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6920 .endlist ilist
6921
6922
6923 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6924 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6925 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6926 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6927 many of them are given in later sections.
6928
6929 .ilist
6930 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6931 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6932 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6933 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6934 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6935 .next
6936 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6937 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6938 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6939 .next
6940 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6941 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6942 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6943 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6944 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6945 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6946 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6947 .next
6948 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6949 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6950 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6951 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6952 .next
6953 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6954 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6955 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6956 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6957 .next
6958 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6960 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6961 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6962 .next
6963 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6964 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6965 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6966 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6967 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6968 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6969 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6970 password value. For example:
6971 .code
6972 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6973 .endd
6974 .next
6975 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6976 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6977 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6978 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6979
6980 .next
6981 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6982 .cindex lookup Redis
6983 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6984 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6985
6986 .next
6987 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6988 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6989 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6990 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6991
6992 .next
6993 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6994 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6995 .next
6996 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6997 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6998 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6999 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7000 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7001 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7002 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7003 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7004 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7005 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7006 .code
7007 require condition = \
7008 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7009 .endd
7010 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7011 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7012 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7013 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7014 .endlist
7015
7016
7017
7018 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7019 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7020 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7021 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7022 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7023 options such as a list of local domains.
7024
7025 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7026 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7027 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7028 or may give up altogether.
7029
7030
7031
7032 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7033 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7034 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7035 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7036 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7037 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7038 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7039 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7040
7041 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7042 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7043 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7044
7045 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7046 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7047 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7048
7049 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7050 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7051 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7052 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7053 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7054 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7055 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7056 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7057 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7058 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7059 .code
7060 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7061 .endd
7062 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7063 looks up these keys, in this order:
7064 .code
7065 jane@eyre.example
7066 *@eyre.example
7067 *
7068 .endd
7069 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7070 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7071 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7072 Exim move on to try the next key.
7073
7074
7075
7076 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7077 .cindex "partial matching"
7078 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7079 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7080 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7081 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7082 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7083 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7084 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7085 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7086 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7087 a key in a DBM file is
7088 .code
7089 *.dates.fict.example
7090 .endd
7091 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7092 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7093 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7094 file.
7095
7096 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7097 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7098 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7099
7100 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7101 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7102 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7103 partial matching keys
7104 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7105 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7106 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7107
7108 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7109 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7110 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7111 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7112 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7113 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7114 remains.
7115
7116 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7117 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7118 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7119 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7120 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7121 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7122 .code
7123 2250.dates.fict.example
7124 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7125 *.dates.fict.example
7126 *.fict.example
7127 .endd
7128 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7129 finishes.
7130
7131 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7132 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7133 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7134 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7135 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7136 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7137 .code
7138 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7139 .endd
7140 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7141 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7142 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7143 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7144 .code
7145 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7146 .endd
7147 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7148 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7149
7150 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7151 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7152 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7153
7154 .ilist
7155 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7156 .next
7157 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7158 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7159 .next
7160 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7161 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7162 for &"*"& on its own.
7163 .next
7164 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7165 .endlist
7166
7167
7168 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7169 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7170 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7171 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7172 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7173 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7174 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7175
7176 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7177 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7178 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7179 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7180 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7181
7182
7183
7184
7185 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7186 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7187 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7188 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7189 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7190 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7191 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7192
7193 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7194 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7195 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7196 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7197 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7198 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7199
7200 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7201 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7202 complete.
7203
7204
7205
7206
7207 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7208 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7209 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7210 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7211 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7212 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7213 .code
7214 [name=$local_part]
7215 .endd
7216 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7217 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7218 .code
7219 [name="$local_part"]
7220 .endd
7221 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7222 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7223 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7224 of the following form is provided:
7225 .code
7226 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7227 .endd
7228 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7229 .code
7230 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7231 .endd
7232 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7233 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7234 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7235
7236
7237
7238
7239 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7240 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7241 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7242 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7243 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7244 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7245 an expansion string could contain:
7246 .code
7247 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7248 .endd
7249 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7250 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7251 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7252 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7253
7254 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7255 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7256 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7257
7258 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7259 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7260 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7261 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7262 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7263 .code
7264 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7265 .endd
7266 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7267 white space is ignored.
7268 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7269 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7270 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7271
7272 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7273 When the type is PTR,
7274 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7275 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7276 .code
7277 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7278 .endd
7279 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7280 altered and nothing is added.
7281
7282 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7283 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7284 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7285 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7286 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7287 The field separator can be modified as above.
7288
7289 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7290 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7292 unless a field separator is specified.
7293 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7294 For SPF records the
7295 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7296 .code
7297 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7298 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7299 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7300 .endd
7301 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7302 white space is ignored.
7303
7304 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7305 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7306 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7307 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7308 specified.
7309 .code
7310 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7311 .endd
7312
7313 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7314 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7315 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7316 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7317 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7318 each followed by a comma,
7319 that may appear before the record type.
7320
7321 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7322 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7323 a defer-option modifier.
7324 The possible keywords are
7325 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7326 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7327 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7328 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7329 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7330 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7331 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7332 .code
7333 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7334 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7335 .endd
7336 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7337 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7338
7339 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7340 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7341 The possible keywords are
7342 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7343 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7344 with the lookup.
7345 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7346 is not labelled as authenticated data
7347 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7348 The default is &"lax"&.
7349
7350 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7351
7352 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7353 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7354 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7355 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7356 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7357 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7358
7359 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7360 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7361 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7362
7363 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7364 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7365 .cindex DNS TTL
7366 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7367 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7368 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7369
7370
7371 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7372 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7373 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7374 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7375 the pseudo-type MXH:
7376 .code
7377 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7378 .endd
7379 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7380 returned.
7381
7382 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7383 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7384 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7385 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7386 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7387 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7388 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7389 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7390 .code
7391 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7392 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7393 .endd
7394 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7395 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7396 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7397
7398 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7399 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7400 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7401 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7402 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7403 such a list.
7404
7405 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7406 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7407 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7408 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7409 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7410 result of a successful lookup such as:
7411 .code
7412 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7413 .endd
7414 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7415 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7416 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7417
7418 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7419 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7420 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7421 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7422 .code
7423 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7424 .endd
7425
7426
7427 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7428 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7429 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7430 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7431 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7432 .code
7433 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7434 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7435 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7436 .endd
7437 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7438 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7439 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7440 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7441
7442 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7443 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7444 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7445
7446
7447
7448
7449 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7450 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7451 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7452 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7453 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7454 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7455 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7456 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7457 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7458 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7459 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7460 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7461 .code
7462 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7463 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7464 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7465 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7466 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7467 .endd
7468 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7469 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7470
7471 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7472 the way they handle the results of a query:
7473
7474 .ilist
7475 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7476 gives an error.
7477 .next
7478 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7479 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7480 .next
7481 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7482 from all of them are returned.
7483 .endlist
7484
7485
7486 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7487 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7488 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7489 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7490
7491
7492 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7493 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7494 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7495 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7496 .code
7497 data = ${lookup ldap \
7498 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7499 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7500 .endd
7501 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7502 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7503 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7504 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7505
7506 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7507 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7508 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7509
7510 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7511 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7512 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7513 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7514 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7515 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7516 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7517 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7518 &_exim.conf_&.
7519
7520
7521 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7522 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7523 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7524 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7525 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7526 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7527
7528 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7529 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7530 the string:
7531 .code
7532 * => \2A
7533 ( => \28
7534 ) => \29
7535 \ => \5C
7536 .endd
7537 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7538 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7539 .code
7540 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7541 .endd
7542 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7543 .code
7544 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7545 .endd
7546 yields
7547 .code
7548 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7549 .endd
7550 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7551 .code
7552 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7553 .endd
7554 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7555 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7556 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7557 .code
7558 , + " \ < > ;
7559 .endd
7560 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7561 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7562 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7563 .code
7564 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7565 .endd
7566 yields
7567 .code
7568 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7569 .endd
7570 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7571 .code
7572 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7573 .endd
7574 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7575 authentication below.
7576
7577
7578 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7579 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7580 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7581 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7582 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7583 by starting it with
7584 .code
7585 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7586 .endd
7587 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7588 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7589 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7590 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7591 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7592 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7593 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7594 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7595 failures, and timeouts.
7596
7597 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7598 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7599 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7600 doubled. For example
7601 .code
7602 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7603 .endd
7604 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7605 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7606 the local host) is used.
7607
7608 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7609 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7610 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7611 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7612 not available.
7613
7614 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7615 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7616 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7617 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7618 .code
7619 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7620 .endd
7621 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7622 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7623 .code
7624 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7625 .endd
7626 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7627 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7628 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7629 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7630 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7631 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7632 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7633 backup host.
7634
7635 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7636 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7637 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7638
7639 .ilist
7640 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7641 interface.
7642 .next
7643 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7644 .endlist
7645
7646
7647 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7648 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7649
7650
7651
7652 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7653 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7654 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7655 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7656 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7657 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7658 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7659 them. The following names are recognized:
7660 .display
7661 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7662 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7663 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7664 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7665 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7666 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7667 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7668 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7669 .endd
7670 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7671 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7672 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7673 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7674
7675 .cindex LDAP timeout
7676 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7677 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7678 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7679 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7680 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7681 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7682 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7683 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7684 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7685 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7686
7687 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7688 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7689
7690 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7691 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7692 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7693 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7694 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7695 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7696 alternate list (colon-separated).
7697
7698 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7699 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7700 .code
7701 ${lookup ldap
7702 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7703 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7704 {$value}fail}
7705 .endd
7706 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7707 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7708 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7709 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7710
7711 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7712 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7713 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7714
7715 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7716 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7717 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7718 quoting has two advantages:
7719
7720 .ilist
7721 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7722 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7723 .next
7724 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7725 .endlist
7726
7727 For example, a setting such as
7728 .code
7729 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7730 .endd
7731 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7732
7733 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7734 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7735 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7736 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7737 .code
7738 PASS=${quote:$3}
7739 .endd
7740 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7741 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7742 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7743
7744
7745
7746 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7747 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7748 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7749 as a sequence of values, for example
7750 .code
7751 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7752 .endd
7753 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7754 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7755 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7756 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7757 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7758 directory.
7759
7760 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7761 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7762 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7763 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7764
7765 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7766 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7767 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7768 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7769 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7770 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7771 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7772 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7773 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7774
7775 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7776 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7777 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7778 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7779 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7780
7781 .code
7782 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7783 value1.1,value1,,2
7784
7785 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7786 value two
7787
7788 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7789 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7790
7791 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7792 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7793
7794 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7795 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7796 .endd
7797 You can
7798 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7799 results of LDAP lookups.
7800 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7801 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7802 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7803 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7804 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7805 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7806
7807
7808
7809
7810 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7811 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7812 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7813 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7814 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7815 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7816 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7817 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7818 .code
7819 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7820 .endd
7821 might return the string
7822 .code
7823 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7824 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7825 .endd
7826 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7827 .code
7828 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7829 .endd
7830 would just return
7831 .code
7832 Martin Guerre
7833 .endd
7834 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7835 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7836 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7837
7838
7839
7840 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7841 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7842 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7843 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7844 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7845 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7846 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7847 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7848 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7849 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7850 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7851 .cindex lookup Redis
7852 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7853 and SQLite
7854 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7855 might be
7856 .code
7857 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7858 {$value}fail}
7859 .endd
7860 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7861 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7862 .code
7863 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7864 {$value}}
7865 .endd
7866 might be
7867 .code
7868 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7869 .endd
7870 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7871 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7872 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7873 .code
7874 Mister X
7875 .endd
7876 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7877 with a newline between the data for each row.
7878
7879
7880 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7881 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7882 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7883 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7884 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7885 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7886 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7887 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7888 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7889 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7890 .cindex lookup Redis
7891 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7892 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7893 or &%redis_servers%&
7894 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7895 information.
7896 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7897 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7898 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7899 For all but Redis
7900 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7901 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7902 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7903 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7904 .code
7905 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7906 .endd
7907 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7908 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7909 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7910 .code
7911 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7912 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7913 .endd
7914 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7915 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7916 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7917 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7918 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7919 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7920
7921 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7922 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7923 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7924 information.
7925 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7926 host, database number, and password.
7927 .olist
7928 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7929 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7930 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7931 .next
7932 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7933 .next
7934 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7935 .endlist
7936
7937 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7938 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7939 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7940 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7941
7942 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7943 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7944
7945 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7946 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7947 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7948 done by starting the query with
7949 .display
7950 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7951 .endd
7952 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7953 .olist
7954 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7955 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7956 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7957 taken from there.
7958 .next
7959 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7960 .endlist
7961 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7962 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7963 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7964
7965 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7966 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7967 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7968 like this:
7969 .code
7970 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7971 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7972 master/db/name/pw
7973 .endd
7974 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7975 .code
7976 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7977 .endd
7978 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7979 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7980 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7981 .code
7982 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7983 .endd
7984
7985
7986 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7987 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7988 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7989 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7990 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7991 the default value is &"exim"&.
7992 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7993 .display
7994 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7995 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7996 .endd
7997 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7998 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7999
8000 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8001 the queries.
8002
8003 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8004 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8005
8006 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8007 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8008 is zero because no rows are affected.
8009
8010
8011 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8012 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8013 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8014 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8015 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8016 looks like this:
8017 .code
8018 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8019 .endd
8020 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8021 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8022 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8023
8024 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8025 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8026 affected.
8027
8028 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8029 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8030 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8031 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8032 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8033 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8034 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8035 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8036 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8037 .code
8038 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8039 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8040 .endd
8041 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8042 .code
8043 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8044 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8045 .endd
8046 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8047 quote, which it doubles.
8048
8049 .cindex timeout SQLite
8050 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8051 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8052 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8053 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8054 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8055 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8056 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8057 option.
8058
8059 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8060 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8061 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8062 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8063 Examples:
8064 .code
8065 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8066 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8067 .endd
8068
8069 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8070 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8071 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8072 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8073 servers.
8074
8075 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8076 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8077 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8078 reached.
8079
8080 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
8081 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
8082
8083
8084 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8085 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8086
8087 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8088 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8089 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8090 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8091 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8092 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8093 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8094 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8095 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8096
8097 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8098 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8099 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8100 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8101
8102 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8103 support all the complexity available in
8104 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8105
8106
8107
8108 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8109 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8110 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8111
8112 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8113 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8114
8115 The result of
8116 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8117 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8118 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8119 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8120 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8121
8122
8123 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8124 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8125 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8126
8127 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8128 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8129 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8130 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8131 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8132 .code
8133 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8134 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8135 .endd
8136 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8137 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8138 senders based on the receiving domain.
8139
8140
8141
8142
8143 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8144 .cindex "list" "negation"
8145 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8146 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8147 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8148 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8149 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8150 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8151
8152 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8153 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8154 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8155 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8156 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8157 .code
8158 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8159 .endd
8160 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8161 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8162 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8163 .code
8164 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8165 .endd
8166 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8167 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8168 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8169
8170 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8171 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8172 item.
8173
8174
8175
8176 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8177 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8178 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8179 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8180 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8181 filenames are not allowed,
8182 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8183 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8184 lines:
8185
8186 .ilist
8187 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8188 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8189 .next
8190 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8191 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8192 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8193 .code
8194 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8195 .endd
8196 .endlist
8197
8198 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8199 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8200 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8201 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8202
8203 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8204 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8205 .code
8206 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8207 .endd
8208 and the file contains the lines
8209 .code
8210 !a.b.c
8211 *.b.c
8212 .endd
8213 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8214 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8215
8216
8217
8218 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8219 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8220 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8221 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8222 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8223 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8224 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8225 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8226
8227 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8228 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8229 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8230 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8231
8232
8233
8234
8235 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8236 .cindex "named lists"
8237 .cindex "list" "named"
8238 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8239 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8240 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8241 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8242 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8243 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8244 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8245 .code
8246 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8247 .endd
8248 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8249 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8250 configured with the line
8251 .code
8252 domains = +local_domains
8253 .endd
8254 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8255 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8256 .code
8257 dnslookup:
8258 driver = dnslookup
8259 domains = ! +local_domains
8260 transport = remote_smtp
8261 no_more
8262 .endd
8263 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8264 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8265 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8266 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8267 .code
8268 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8269 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8270 .endd
8271 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8272 .code
8273 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8274 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8275 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8276 .endd
8277 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8278 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8279 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8280 .code
8281 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8282 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8283 .endd
8284 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8285 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8286 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8287 .code
8288 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8289 .endd
8290 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8291 referenced lists if you can.
8292
8293 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8294 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8295 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8296 .code
8297 domains = +local_domains
8298 .endd
8299 on several of your routers
8300 or in several ACL statements,
8301 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8302 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8303 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8304 the same each time they are referenced.
8305
8306 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8307 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8308 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8309 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8310
8311
8312
8313 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8314 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8315 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8316 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8317 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8318 write
8319 .code
8320 ALIST = host1 : host2
8321 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8322 .endd
8323 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8324 .code
8325 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8326 .endd
8327 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8328 list, and write
8329 .code
8330 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8331 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8332 .endd
8333 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8334 .code
8335 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8336 .endd
8337
8338
8339 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8340 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8341 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8342 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8343 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8344 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8345 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8346 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8347 message. For example:
8348 .code
8349 domainlist special_domains = \
8350 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8351 .endd
8352 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8353 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8354 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8355 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8356 same list each time.
8357
8358 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8359 cache the result anyway. For example:
8360 .code
8361 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8362 .endd
8363 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8364 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8365
8366
8367
8368 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8369 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8370 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8371 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8372 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8373
8374 .ilist
8375 .cindex "primary host name"
8376 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8377 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8378 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8379 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8380 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8381 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8382 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8383 differ only in their names.
8384 .next
8385 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8386 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8387 .cindex "domain literal"
8388 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8389 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8390 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8391 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8392 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8393 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8394 .next
8395 .cindex "@mx_any"
8396 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8397 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8398 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8399 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8400 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8401 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8402 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8403 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8404 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8405 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8406 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8407
8408 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8409 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8410 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8411 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8412 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8413
8414 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8415 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8416 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8417 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8418 on a router). For example:
8419 .code
8420 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8421 .endd
8422 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8423 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8424
8425 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8426 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8427 contain negative items.
8428
8429 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8430 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8431 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8432 .code
8433 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8434 an.other.domain : ...
8435 .endd
8436 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8437 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8438 .code
8439 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8440 an.other.domain ? ...
8441 .endd
8442 .next
8443 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8444 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8445 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8446 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8447 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8448 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8449 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8450 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8451 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8452 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8453
8454 .next
8455 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8456 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8457 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8458 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8459 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8460 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8461 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8462 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8463 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8464
8465 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8466 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8467 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8468 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8469 expression by expansion, of course).
8470 .next
8471 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8472 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8473 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8474 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8475 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8476 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8477 .code
8478 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8479 .endd
8480 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8481 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8482 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8483 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8484 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8485 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8486 other statements in the same ACL.
8487
8488 .next
8489 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8490 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8491 .code
8492 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8493 .endd
8494 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8495 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8496
8497 .next
8498 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8499 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8500 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8501 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8502 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8503 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8504 expansion variable.
8505 .next
8506 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8507 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8508 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8509 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8510 .code
8511 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8512 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8513 .endd
8514 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8515 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8516 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8517 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8518 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8519 .next
8520 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8521 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8522 between the pattern and the domain.
8523 .endlist
8524
8525 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8526 .code
8527 domainlist funny_domains = \
8528 @ : \
8529 lib.unseen.edu : \
8530 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8531 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8532 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8533 nis;domains.byname : \
8534 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8535 .endd
8536 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8537 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8538 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8539 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8540 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8541 patterns earlier.
8542
8543
8544
8545 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8546 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8547 .cindex "list" "host list"
8548 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8549 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8550 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8551 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8552 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8553 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8554 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8555
8556
8557 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8558 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8559 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8560 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8561 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8562 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8563 not used.
8564
8565 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8566 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8567 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8568
8569
8570
8571 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8572 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8573 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8574 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8575 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8576 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8577 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8578 concerns.)
8579
8580 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8581 inspecting its IP address:
8582
8583 .ilist
8584 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8585 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8586 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8587 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8588 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8589 with the IP address of the subject host.
8590
8591 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8592 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8593 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8594 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8595 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8596
8597 .next
8598 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8599 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8600 domain name, as just described.
8601
8602 .next
8603 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8604 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8605 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8606 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8607 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8608 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8609 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8610 that can never match a client host.
8611
8612 .next
8613 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8614 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8615 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8616 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8617 .code
8618 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8619 accept hosts = @[]
8620 .endd
8621 .next
8622 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8623 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8624 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8625 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8626 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8627 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8628 significant end of the address.
8629
8630 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8631 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8632 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8633 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8634 .code
8635 192.168.23.236/31
8636 .endd
8637 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8638 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8639 matches.
8640
8641 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8642 .code
8643 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8644 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8645 .endd
8646 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8647 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8648 For example:
8649 .code
8650 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8651 .endd
8652 could make use of a file containing
8653 .code
8654 172.16.0.0/12
8655 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8656 .endd
8657 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8658 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8659 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8660 .code
8661 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8662 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8663 .endd
8664 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8665 list.
8666 .endlist
8667
8668
8669
8670 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8671 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8672 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8673 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8674 address, the pattern takes this form:
8675 .display
8676 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8677 .endd
8678 For example:
8679 .code
8680 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8681 .endd
8682 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8683 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8684 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8685 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8686 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8687 returned by the lookup is not used.
8688
8689 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8690 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8691 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8692 patterns of this form:
8693 .display
8694 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8695 .endd
8696 For example:
8697 .code
8698 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8699 .endd
8700 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8701 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8702 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8703 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8704 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8705
8706 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8707 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8708 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8709 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8710 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8711 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8712 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8713 converted using colons and not dots.
8714 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8715 addresses are always used.
8716 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8717
8718 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8719 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8720 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8721 configurations.
8722
8723 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8724 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8725 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8726 case the IP address is used on its own.
8727
8728
8729
8730 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8731 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8732 .cindex "unknown host name"
8733 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8734 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8735 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8736 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8737 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8738 above.)
8739
8740 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8741 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8742 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8743 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8744 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8745 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8746 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8747
8748 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8749 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8750
8751 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8752 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8753 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8754 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8755 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8756 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8757 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8758 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8759 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8760
8761 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8762 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8763
8764 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8765 .cindex "alias for host"
8766 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8767 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8768
8769 .ilist
8770 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8771 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8772 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8773 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8774 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8775 expression.
8776 .next
8777 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8778 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8779 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8780 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8781 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8782 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8783 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8784 example,
8785 .code
8786 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8787 .endd
8788 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8789 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8790 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8791 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8792 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8793 .code
8794 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8795 .endd
8796 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8797 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8798 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8799 required.
8800 .endlist
8801
8802
8803
8804
8805 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8806 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8807 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8808 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8809 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8810 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8811
8812 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8813 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8814
8815 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8816 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8817 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8818 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8819 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8820 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8821 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8822 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8823 not recognized in an indirected file).
8824
8825 .ilist
8826 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8827 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8828 .code
8829 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8830 .endd
8831 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8832 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8833
8834 .next
8835 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8836 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8837 example:
8838 .code
8839 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8840 192.168.4.5
8841 .endd
8842 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8843 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8844 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8845 .endlist
8846
8847 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8848 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8849 list.
8850
8851 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8852 "SECTmixwilhos"
8853 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8854
8855 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8856 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8857 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8858
8859 .ilist
8860 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8861 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8862 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8863 .code
8864 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8865 .endd
8866 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8867 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8868 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8869 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8870 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8871 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8872 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8873
8874 .next
8875 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8876 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8877 .code
8878 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8879 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8880 .endd
8881 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8882 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8883 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8884 this section.
8885 .endlist
8886
8887
8888 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8889 "SECTtemdnserr"
8890 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8891 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8892 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8893 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8894 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8895 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8896 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8897 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8898 host lists such as whitelists.
8899
8900
8901
8902 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8903 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8904 .cindex "unknown host name"
8905 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8906 If a pattern is of the form
8907 .display
8908 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8909 .endd
8910 for example
8911 .code
8912 dbm;/host/accept/list
8913 .endd
8914 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8915 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8916 is not used.
8917
8918 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8919 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8920 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8921 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8922 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8923 lookup, both using the same file.
8924
8925
8926
8927 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8928 If a pattern is of the form
8929 .display
8930 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8931 .endd
8932 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8933 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8934 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8935 .code
8936 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8937 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8938 .endd
8939 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8940 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8941 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8942 operator.
8943
8944 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8945 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8946 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8947
8948 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8949 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8950 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8951 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8952 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8953 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958
8959 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8960 .cindex "list" "address list"
8961 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8962 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8963 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8964 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8965 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8966 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8967 using this option setting:
8968 .code
8969 senders = :
8970 .endd
8971 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8972 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8973 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8974 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8975
8976 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8977 example:
8978 .code
8979 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8980 .endd
8981 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8982 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8983 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8984 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8985 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8986 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8987 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8988 .code
8989 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8990 *@+hostile_domains:\
8991 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8992 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8993 .endd
8994 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8995 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8996 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8997 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8998 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8999
9000 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9001 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9002 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9003 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9004 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9005 .code
9006 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9007 .endd
9008
9009 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9010 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9011 senders:
9012
9013 .ilist
9014 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9015 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9016 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9017 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9018 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9019 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9020 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9021 .code
9022 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9023 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9024 .endd
9025 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9026 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9027
9028 .next
9029 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9030 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9031 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9032 example:
9033 .code
9034 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9035 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9036 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9037 .endd
9038 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9039 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9040 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9041 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9042
9043 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9044 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9045 panic log.
9046 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9047 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9048 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9049 default. For example, with this lookup:
9050 .code
9051 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9052 .endd
9053 the file could contains lines like this:
9054 .code
9055 user1@domain1.example
9056 *@domain2.example
9057 .endd
9058 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9059 that are tried is:
9060 .code
9061 nimrod@jaeger.example
9062 *@jaeger.example
9063 *
9064 .endd
9065 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9066 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9067
9068 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9069 .code
9070 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9071 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9072 .endd
9073 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9074 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9075 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9076 .endlist
9077
9078
9079 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9080 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9081 always fails.
9082
9083
9084 .ilist
9085 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9086 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9087 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9088 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9089 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9090 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9091 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9092 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9093 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9094
9095 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9096 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9097 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9098 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9099 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9100 with
9101 .code
9102 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9103 .endd
9104 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9105 .code
9106 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9107 .endd
9108 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9109
9110 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9111 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9112 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9113 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9114 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9115 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9116 .code
9117 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9118 spammer3 : spammer4
9119 .endd
9120 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9121 doubling.
9122
9123 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9124 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9125 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9126 might have entries like
9127 .code
9128 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9129 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9130 *: ^\d{8}$
9131 .endd
9132 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9133 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9134 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9135 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9136
9137 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9138 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9139 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9140
9141 .next
9142 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9143 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9144 can only return a single list of local parts.
9145 .endlist
9146
9147 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9148 in these two examples:
9149 .code
9150 senders = +my_list
9151 senders = *@+my_list
9152 .endd
9153 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9154 example it is a named domain list.
9155
9156
9157
9158
9159 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9160 .cindex "case of local parts"
9161 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9162 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9163 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9164 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9165 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9166 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9167 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9168 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9169 default.
9170
9171 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9172 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9173 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9174 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9175 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9176 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9177 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9178 case-independent.
9179
9180 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9181 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9182 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9183 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9184 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9185 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9186 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9187 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9188
9189
9190
9191 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9192 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9193 .cindex "local part" "list"
9194 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9195 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9196 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9197 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9198 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9199 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9200 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9201 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9202
9203 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9204 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9205 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9206 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9207 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9208 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9209 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9210 types.
9211 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9212
9213
9214
9215
9216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9218
9219 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9220 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9221 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9222 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9223
9224 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9225 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9226 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9227 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9228 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9229 escape character, as described in the following section.
9230
9231 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9232 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9233 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9234 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9235 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9236 reasons,
9237 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9238 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9239 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9240 is not permitted.
9241
9242
9243
9244 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9245 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9246 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9247 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9248 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9249 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9250 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9251 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9252
9253 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9254 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9255 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9256 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9257 .code
9258 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9259 .endd
9260 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9261 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9262 string.
9263
9264
9265
9266 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9267 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9268 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9269 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9270 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9271 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9272 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9273 encoding.
9274
9275 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9276 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9277 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9278
9279
9280 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9281 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9282 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9283 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9284 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9285 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9286 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9287 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9288 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9289 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9290 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9291 and &%nhash%&.
9292
9293 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9294 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9295 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9296
9297 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9298 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9299 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9300 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9301 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9302 .code
9303 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9304 .endd
9305 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9306 Exim message identifier. For example:
9307 .code
9308 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9309 .endd
9310 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9311 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9312
9313
9314 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9315 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9316 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9317 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9318 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9319 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9320 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9321 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9322 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9323 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9324 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9325 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9326 being expanded.
9327
9328
9329
9330
9331 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9332 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9333 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9334 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9335 white space is significant.
9336
9337 .vlist
9338 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9339 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9340 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9341 .code
9342 $local_part
9343 ${domain}
9344 .endd
9345 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9346 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9347 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9348 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9349 given, the expansion fails.
9350
9351 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9352 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9353 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9354 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9355 .code
9356 ${lc:$local_part}
9357 .endd
9358 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9359 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9360 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9361 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9362 string easier to understand.
9363
9364 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9365 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9366 expansion item below.
9367
9368
9369 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9370 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9371 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9372 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9373 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9374 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9375 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9376 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9377 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9378 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9379 the result of the expansion.
9380 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9381 the expansion result is an empty string.
9382 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9383
9384
9385 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9386 .cindex authentication "results header"
9387 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9388 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9389 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9390 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9391 header line.
9392 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9393 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9394 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9395 .code
9396 none
9397 iprev
9398 auth
9399 spf
9400 dkim
9401 .endd
9402
9403 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9404 .code
9405 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9406 .endd
9407 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9408
9409
9410 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9411 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9412 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9413 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9414 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9415 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9416 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9417 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9418 .display
9419 &`version `&
9420 &`serial_number `&
9421 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9422 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9423 &`notbefore `& time
9424 &`notafter `& time
9425 &`sig_algorithm `&
9426 &`signature `&
9427 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9428 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9429 &`crl_uri `& list
9430 .endd
9431 If the field is found,
9432 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9433 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9434 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9435 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9436
9437 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9438 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9439 extracted is used.
9440
9441 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9442
9443 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9444 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9445 not quite
9446 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9447 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9448 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9449 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9450 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9451 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9452 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9453 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9454
9455 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9456 take an optional modifier of "int"
9457 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9458 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9459 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9460
9461 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9462 newline-separated by default,
9463 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9464 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9465 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9466
9467 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9468 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9469 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9470 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9471 if so the element tags are omitted.
9472
9473 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9474
9475 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9476 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9477 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9478 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9479 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9480 .code
9481 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9482 .endd
9483 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9484 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9485 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9486
9487 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9488
9489 When compiling
9490 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9491 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9492 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9493 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9494 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9495 must have the following type:
9496 .code
9497 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9498 .endd
9499 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9500 function should return one of the following values:
9501
9502 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9503 into the expanded string that is being built.
9504
9505 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9506 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9507
9508 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9509 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9510
9511 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9512
9513 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9514 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9515 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9516
9517
9518 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9519 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9520 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9521 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9522 removed.
9523 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9524 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9525 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9526
9527 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9528 appear, for example:
9529 .code
9530 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9531 .endd
9532 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9533 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9534
9535 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9536 search failure.
9537 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9538 search success.
9539
9540 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9541 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9542
9543
9544 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9545 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9546 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9547 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9548 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9549 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9550 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9551 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9552 .display
9553 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9554 .endd
9555 .vindex "&$value$&"
9556 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9557 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9558 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9559 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9560 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9561 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9562 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9563 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9564 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9565
9566 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9567 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9568 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9569 yield &"2001"&:
9570 .code
9571 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9572 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9573 .endd
9574 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9575 appear, for example:
9576 .code
9577 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9578 .endd
9579 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9580 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9581
9582 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9583 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9584 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9585 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9586 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9587 .cindex JSON expansions
9588 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9589 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9590 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9591 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9592 .display
9593 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9594 .endd
9595 .vindex "&$value$&"
9596 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9597 the spaces are optional.
9598 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9599 For the &"json"& variant,
9600 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9601 trailing quotes.
9602 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9603 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9604 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9605
9606 The results of matching are handled as above.
9607
9608
9609 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9610 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9611 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9612 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9613 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9614 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9615 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9616 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9617 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9618 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9619 <&'string3'&> as before.
9620
9621 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9622 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9623 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9624 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9625 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9626 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9627 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9628 provided. For example:
9629 .code
9630 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9631 .endd
9632 yields &"42"&, and
9633 .code
9634 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9635 .endd
9636 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9637 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9638
9639
9640 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9641 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9642 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9643 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9644 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9645 .cindex JSON expansions
9646 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9647 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9648
9649 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9650 there is no choice of field separator.
9651 For the &"json"& variant,
9652 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9653 trailing quotes.
9654 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9655 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9656
9657
9658 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9659 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9660 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9661 .vindex "&$item$&"
9662 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9663 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9664 For each item
9665 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9666 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9667 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9668 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9669 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9670 .code
9671 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9672 .endd
9673 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9674 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9675
9676
9677 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9678 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9679 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9680 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9681 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9682 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9683
9684 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9685 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9686 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9687 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9688 .code
9689 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9690 .endd
9691 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9692 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9693 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9694 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9695 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9696 .code
9697 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9698 .endd
9699 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9700 letters appear. For example:
9701 .display
9702 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9703 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9704 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9705 .endd
9706
9707 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9708 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9709 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9710 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9711 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9712 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9713 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9714 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9715 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9716 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9717 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9718 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9719 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9720 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9721 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9722 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9723 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9724 .code
9725 $header_reply-to:
9726 .endd
9727 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9728 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9729 lines) may be present.
9730
9731 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9732 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9733
9734 .ilist
9735 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9736 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9737 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9738
9739 .next
9740 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9741 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9742 are multiple headers with a given name.
9743 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9744 list-processing facilities can be used.
9745 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9746 the content is &"raw"&.
9747
9748 .next
9749 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9750 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9751 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9752 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9753 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9754 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9755 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9756 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9757
9758 .next
9759 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9760 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9761 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9762 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9763 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9764 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9765 .endlist ilist
9766
9767 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9768 command of the following form:
9769 .code
9770 headers charset "UTF-8"
9771 .endd
9772 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9773 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9774 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9775 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9776 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9777 ISO-8859-1.
9778
9779 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9780 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9781 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9782 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9783
9784 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9785 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9786 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9787 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9788 router or transport are not accessible.
9789
9790 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9791 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9792 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9793 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9794 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9795 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9796 point they are added.
9797 When any of the above ACLs ar
9798 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9799
9800 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9801 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9802 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9803 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9804 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9805 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9806 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9807 header.)
9808
9809 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9810 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9811 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9812 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9813 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9814 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9815 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9816 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9817
9818 .new
9819 .cindex "tainted data"
9820 When the headers are from an incoming message,
9821 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9822 .wen
9823
9824
9825 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9826 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9827 .cindex &%hmac%&
9828 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9829 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9830 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9831 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9832 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9833 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9834 present. For example:
9835 .code
9836 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9837 .endd
9838 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9839 produces:
9840 .code
9841 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9842 .endd
9843 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9844 an Exim configuration:
9845 .code
9846 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9847 .endd
9848 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9849 .code
9850 headers_add = \
9851 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9852 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9853 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9854 .endd
9855 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9856 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9857 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9858 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9859 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9860 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9861
9862
9863 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9864 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9865 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9866 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9867 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9868 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9869 .code
9870 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9871 .endd
9872 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9873 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9874 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9875 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9876 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9877
9878 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9879 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9880 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9881 .code
9882 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9883 .endd
9884 you can use
9885 .code
9886 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9887 .endd
9888
9889
9890
9891 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9892 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9893 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9894 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9895 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9896 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9897
9898
9899
9900 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9901 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9902 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9903 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9904 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9905 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9906 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9907 some of the braces:
9908 .code
9909 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9910 .endd
9911 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9912 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9913 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9914 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9915
9916
9917 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9918 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9919 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9920 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9921 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9922 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9923 apart from an optional leading minus,
9924 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9925
9926 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9927 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9928
9929 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9930 If the number is negative, the fields are
9931 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9932 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9933 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9934
9935 If the modulus of the
9936 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9937 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9938
9939 For example:
9940 .code
9941 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9942 .endd
9943 yields &"42"&, and
9944 .code
9945 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9946 .endd
9947 yields &"result: 42"&.
9948
9949 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9950 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9951 extracted is used.
9952 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9953
9954
9955 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9956 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9957 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9958 described in the next item.
9959
9960 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9961 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9962 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9963 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9964 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9965 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9966 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9967 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9968 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9969
9970 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9971 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9972 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9973 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9974 out by the system administrator.
9975
9976 .vindex "&$value$&"
9977 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9978 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9979 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9980 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9981 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9982 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9983 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9984 original lookup fails.
9985
9986 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9987 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9988 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9989 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9990 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9991 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9992 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9993 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9994
9995 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9996 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9997 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9998 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9999
10000 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10001 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10002 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10003 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10004
10005 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10006 .code
10007 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10008 .endd
10009 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10010 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10011 .code
10012 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10013 {$value}fail}
10014 .endd
10015
10016
10017 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10018 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10019 .vindex "&$item$&"
10020 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10021 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10022 For each item
10023 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10024 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10025 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10026 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10027 .code
10028 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10029 .endd
10030 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10031 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10032 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10033
10034 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10035 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10036 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10037 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10038 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10039 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10040 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10041 .code
10042 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10043 .endd
10044 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10045 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10046 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10047 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10048 example,
10049 .code
10050 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10051 .endd
10052 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10053
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10057 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10058 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10059 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10060 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10061 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10062 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10063 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10064
10065 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10066 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10067 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10068 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10069 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10070 not its contents.
10071
10072 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10073 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10074 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10075
10076 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10077 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10078
10079
10080 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10081 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10082 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10083 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10084 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10085 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10086 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10087 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10088
10089 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10090 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10091 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10092 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10093 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10094 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10095 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10096 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10097 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10098 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10099
10100 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10101 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10102 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10103 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10104
10105 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10106 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10107 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10108 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10109 is the expansion of the third argument.
10110
10111 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10112 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10113 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10114
10115 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10116 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10117 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10118 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10119 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10120 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10121 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10122 newlines are left in the string.
10123 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10124 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10125 the string expansion fails.
10126
10127 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10128 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10129
10130
10131
10132 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10133 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10134 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10135 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10136 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10137 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10138 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10139 examples:
10140 .code
10141 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10142 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10143 .endd
10144 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10145 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10146 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10147 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10148 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10149 example:
10150 .code
10151 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10152 .endd
10153 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10154 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10155 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10156 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10157 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10158 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10159 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10160 .code
10161 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10162 .endd
10163
10164 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10165 and must be present if the argument is given.
10166 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10167 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10168 The first defines whether (the default)
10169 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10170 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10171 .code
10172 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10173 .endd
10174 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10175 .code
10176 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10177 .endd
10178 The default is to not use TLS.
10179 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10180
10181 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10182 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10183 turns them into spaces:
10184 .code
10185 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10186 .endd
10187 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10188 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10189 addition, the following errors can occur:
10190
10191 .ilist
10192 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10193 .next
10194 Failure to connect the socket;
10195 .next
10196 Failure to write the request string;
10197 .next
10198 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10199 .endlist
10200
10201 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10202 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10203 errors occurs. For example:
10204 .code
10205 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10206 {socket failure}}
10207 .endd
10208 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10209 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10210 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10211 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10212 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10213
10214 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10215 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10216
10217
10218 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10219 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10220 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10221 .vindex "&$value$&"
10222 .vindex "&$item$&"
10223 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10224 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10225 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10226 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10227 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10228 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10229 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10230 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10231 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10232 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10233 .code
10234 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10235 .endd
10236 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10237 can be found:
10238 .code
10239 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10240 .endd
10241 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10242 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10243 expansion items.
10244
10245 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10246 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10247 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10248
10249 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10250 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10251 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10252 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10253 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10254 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10255 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10256 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10257 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10258
10259 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10260 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10261 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10262 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10263 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10264 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10265 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10266 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10267 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10268 character.
10269
10270 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10271 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10272 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10273 .vindex "&$value$&"
10274 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10275 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10276 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10277 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10278 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10279 &$value$&.
10280
10281 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10282 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10283 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10284 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10285
10286 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10287 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10288 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10289 troubleshoot:
10290 .code
10291 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10292 log_message = Output of id: $value
10293 .endd
10294 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10295 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10296 .code
10297 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10298 .endd
10299
10300 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10301 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10302 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10303 .code
10304 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10305 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10306 ...
10307 endif
10308 .endd
10309 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10310 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10311 commands.
10312
10313 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10314 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10315 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10316 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10317
10318 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10319 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10320
10321
10322 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10323 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10324 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10325 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10326 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10327 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10328 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10329 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10330 .code
10331 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10332 .endd
10333 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10334 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10335 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10336 .code
10337 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10338 .endd
10339 yields &"defabc"&, and
10340 .code
10341 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10342 .endd
10343 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10344 the regular expression from string expansion.
10345
10346 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10347 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10348
10349
10350 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10351 .cindex sorting "a list"
10352 .cindex list sorting
10353 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10354 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10355 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10356 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10357 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10358 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10359 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10360 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10361 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10362 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10363 to give values for comparison.
10364
10365 The item result is a sorted list,
10366 with the original list separator,
10367 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10368
10369 Examples:
10370 .code
10371 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10372 .endd
10373 sorts a list of numbers, and
10374 .code
10375 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10376 .endd
10377 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10378
10379
10380 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10381 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10382 .cindex "substring extraction"
10383 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10384 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10385 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10386 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10387 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10388 .code
10389 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10390 .endd
10391 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10392 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10393 omitted.
10394
10395 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10396 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10397 length required. For example
10398 .code
10399 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10400 .endd
10401 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10402 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10403 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10404 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10405
10406 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10407 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10408 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10409 .code
10410 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10411 .endd
10412 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10413 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10414 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10415 .code
10416 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10417 .endd
10418 yields an empty string, but
10419 .code
10420 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10421 .endd
10422 yields &"1"&.
10423
10424 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10425 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10426 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10427 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10428 .code
10429 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10430 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10431 .endd
10432 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10433
10434 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10435
10436
10437
10438 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10439 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10440 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10441 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10442 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10443 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10444 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10445 replacement list. For example
10446 .code
10447 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10448 .endd
10449 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10450 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10451 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10452 place.
10453
10454 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10455
10456 .endlist
10457
10458
10459
10460 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10461 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10462 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10463 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10464 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10465 following operations can be performed:
10466
10467 .vlist
10468 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10469 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10470 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10471 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10472 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10473 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10474
10475 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10476
10477
10478 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10479 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10480 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10481 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10482 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10483 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10484 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10485 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10486 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10487
10488 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10489 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10490 character. For example:
10491 .code
10492 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10493 .endd
10494 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10495 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10496 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10497 separator explicitly:
10498 .code
10499 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10500 .endd
10501
10502 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10503 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10504 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10505 processing lists.
10506
10507 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10508 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10509 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10510 email address separator. For the example header line:
10511 .code
10512 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10513 .endd
10514 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10515 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10516 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10517 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10518 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10519 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10520 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10521 .code
10522 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10523 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10524 user@example.com
10525 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10526 Last:user@example.com
10527 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10528 user@example.com
10529 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10530 フィリップ@example.jp
10531 .endd
10532
10533 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10534 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10535 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10536 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10537 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10538 Only lowercase letters are used.
10539
10540 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10542 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10543 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10544 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10545
10546 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10547 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10548 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10549 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10550 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10551 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10552 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10553 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10554 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10555
10556 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10557 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10558 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10559 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10560 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10561 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10562 string.
10563
10564 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10565 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10566 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10567 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10568 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10569 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10570
10571 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10572 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10573
10574
10575 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10576 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10577 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10578 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10579 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10580
10581
10582 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10583 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10584 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10585 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10586 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10587
10588
10589 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10590 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10591 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10592 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10593 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10594 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10595 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10596
10597 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10598 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10599 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10600 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10601 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10602 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10603
10604
10605 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10606 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10607 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10608 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10609 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10610 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10611 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10612 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10613 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10614 C programming language):
10615 .table2 70pt 300pt
10616 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10617 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10618 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10619 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10620 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10621 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10622 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10623 .endtable
10624 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10625 space is permitted before or after operators.
10626
10627 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10628 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10629 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10630 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10631 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10632
10633 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10634 or 1024*1024*1024,
10635 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10636 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10637
10638 .display
10639 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10640 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10641 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10642 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10643 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10644 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10645 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10646 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10647 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10648 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10649 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10650 .endd
10651
10652 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10653 .code
10654 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10655 condition = \
10656 ${if and { \
10657 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10658 { \
10659 < \
10660 {$recipients_count} \
10661 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10662 } \
10663 }{yes}{no}}
10664 .endd
10665 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10666 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10667
10668
10669 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10670 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10671 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10672 example,
10673 .code
10674 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10675 .endd
10676 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10677 and then re-expands what it has found.
10678
10679
10680 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10681 .cindex "Unicode"
10682 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10683 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10684 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10685 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10686 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10687 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10688 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10689 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10690 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10691
10692 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10693 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10694 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10695 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10696 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10697 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10698 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10699
10700
10701 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10702 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10703 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10704 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10705 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10706 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10707 .code
10708 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10709 .endd
10710 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10711 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10712
10713
10714
10715 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10716 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10717 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10718 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10719 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10720 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10721
10722
10723
10724 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10725 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10726 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10727 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10728 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10729 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10730 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10731
10732
10733 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10734 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10735 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10736 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10737 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10738 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10739 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10740
10741 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10742 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10743 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10744 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10745 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10746 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10747 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10748 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10749 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10750
10751
10752 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10753 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10754 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10755 .cindex "lower casing"
10756 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10757 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10758 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10759 .code
10760 ${lc:$local_part}
10761 .endd
10762 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10763
10764 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10765 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10766 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10767 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10768 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10769 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10770 .code
10771 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10772 .endd
10773 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10774 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10775 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10776 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10777
10778
10779 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10780 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10781 .cindex "list" "item count"
10782 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10783 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10784 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10785
10786
10787 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10788 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10789 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10790 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10791 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10792 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10793 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10794 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10795 matching list is returned.
10796
10797
10798 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10799 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10800 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10801 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10802 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10803 empty.
10804 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10805
10806
10807 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "masked IP address"
10809 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10810 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10811 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10812 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10813 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10814 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10815 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10816 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10817 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10818 .code
10819 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10820 .endd
10821 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10822 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10823 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10824 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10825 .code
10826 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10827 .endd
10828 returns the string
10829 .code
10830 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10831 .endd
10832 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10833
10834
10835 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10836 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10837 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10838 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10839 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10840 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10841 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10842
10843 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10844 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10845
10846
10847 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10848 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10849 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10850 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10851 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10852 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10853 .code
10854 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10855 .endd
10856 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10857
10858
10859 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10860 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10861 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10862 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10863 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10864 is an empty string or
10865 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10866 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10867 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10868 respectively For example,
10869 .code
10870 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10871 .endd
10872 becomes
10873 .code
10874 "ab\"*\"cd"
10875 .endd
10876 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10877 variable or a message header.
10878
10879 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10880 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10881 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10882 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10883 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10884 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10885 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10886
10887 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10888 will likely use the quoting form.
10889 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10890
10891
10892 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10893 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10894 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10895 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10896 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10897 .code
10898 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10899 .endd
10900 returns
10901 .code
10902 two%20%5C2A%20two
10903 .endd
10904 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10905 yields an unchanged string.
10906
10907
10908 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10909 .cindex "random number"
10910 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10911 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10912 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10913 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10914 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10915 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10916 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10917 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10918 random().
10919
10920
10921 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10923 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10924 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10925 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10926 for DNS. For example,
10927 .code
10928 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10929 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10930 .endd
10931 returns
10932 .code
10933 4.2.0.192
10934 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10935 .endd
10936
10937
10938 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10939 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10940 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10941 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10942 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10943 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10944 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10945 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10946 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10947 characters
10948 .code
10949 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10950 .endd
10951 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10952 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10953 characters.
10954
10955
10956 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10958 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10959 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10960 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10961 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10962 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10963 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10964
10965 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10966 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10967 to use this operator as well.
10968
10969
10970
10971 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10972 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10973 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10974 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10975 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10976 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10977 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10978
10979
10980 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10981 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10982 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10983 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10984 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10985 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10986 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10987
10988 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10989 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10990
10991
10992 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10993 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10994 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10995 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10996 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10997 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10998 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10999 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11000 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11001 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11002 and returns
11003 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11004
11005 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11006 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11007
11008 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11009 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11010 Finally, if an underbar
11011 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11012 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11013 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11014
11015
11016 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11017 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11018 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11019 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11020 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11021 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11022 and returns
11023 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11024
11025 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11026 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11027 with 256 being the default.
11028
11029 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11030 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11031 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11032 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11033
11034
11035 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11036 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11037 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11038 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11039 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11040 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11041 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11042 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11043 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11044 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11045 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11046 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11047 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11048
11049 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11050 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11051 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11052
11053 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11054 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11055 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11056
11057
11058
11059 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11060 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11061 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11062 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11063 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11064 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11065 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11066
11067
11068 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11069 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11070 .cindex "substring extraction"
11071 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11072 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11073 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11074 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11075 .code
11076 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11077 .endd
11078 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11079 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11080 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11081
11082 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11084 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11085 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11086 seconds.
11087
11088 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11089 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11090 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11091 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11092 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11093 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11094 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11095
11096 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11097 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11098 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11099 .cindex "upper casing"
11100 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11101 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11102 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11103 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11104
11105 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11106 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11107 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11108 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11109 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11110 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11111 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11112 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11113 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11114 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11115 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11116 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11117 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11118 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11119 .code
11120 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11121 .endd
11122 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11123 literal question mark).
11124
11125 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11126 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11127 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11128 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11129 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11130 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11131 .cindex EAI
11132 .cindex internationalisation
11133 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11134 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11135 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11136 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11137 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11138 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11139 .endlist
11140
11141
11142
11143
11144
11145
11146 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11147 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11148 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11149 while expanding strings:
11150
11151 .vlist
11152 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11153 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11154 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11155 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11156 condition.
11157
11158 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11159 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11160 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11161 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11162 are:
11163 .display
11164 &`= `& equal
11165 &`== `& equal
11166 &`> `& greater
11167 &`>= `& greater or equal
11168 &`< `& less
11169 &`<= `& less or equal
11170 .endd
11171 For example:
11172 .code
11173 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11174 .endd
11175 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11176 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11177 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11178 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11179 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11180 zero.
11181
11182 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11183 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11184 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11185
11186
11187 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11188 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11189 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11190 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11191 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11192 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11193 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11194 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11195 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11196 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11197 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11198 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11199 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11200 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11201
11202 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11203 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11204 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11205 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11206 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11207 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11208 false if zero.
11209 An empty string is treated as false.
11210 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11211 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11212 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11213
11214 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11215 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11216 For example:
11217 .code
11218 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11219 .endd
11220
11221
11222 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11223 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11224 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11225 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11226 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11227 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11228 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11229 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11230
11231 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11232
11233 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11234 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11235 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11236 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11237 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11238 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11239 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11240 included in the binary.
11241
11242 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11243 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11244 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11245 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11246 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11247 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11248 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11249 string in LDAP form is:
11250 .code
11251 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11252 .endd
11253 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11254 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11255 .code
11256 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11257 .endd
11258 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11259 supported:
11260
11261 .ilist
11262 .cindex "MD5 hash"
11263 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11264 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11265 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11266 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11267 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11268 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11269 comparison fails.
11270
11271 .next
11272 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11273 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11274 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11275 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11276 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11277 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11278
11279 .next
11280 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11281 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11282 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11283 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11284 whatever its length.
11285
11286 .next
11287 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11288 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11289 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11290 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11291 .endlist
11292 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11293 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11294 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11295 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11296 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11297 support &[crypt16()]&.
11298
11299 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11300 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11301 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11302 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11303 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11304
11305 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11306 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11307 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11308
11309 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11310 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11311 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11312 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11313 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11314
11315 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11316 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11317 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11318 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11319 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11320 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11321 .code
11322 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11323 .endd
11324 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11325 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11326
11327 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11328 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11329 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11330 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11331 exists in the message. For example,
11332 .code
11333 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11334 .endd
11335 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11336 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11337
11338 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11339 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11340 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11341 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11342 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11343 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11344 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11345 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11346 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11347 case is defined per the system C locale.
11348
11349 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11350 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11351 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11352 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11353 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11354 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11355 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11356 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11357
11358 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11359 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11360 .cindex "first delivery"
11361 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11362 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11363 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11364 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11365
11366
11367 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11368 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11369 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11370 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11371 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11372 .vindex "&$item$&"
11373 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11374 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11375 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11376 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11377 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11378 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11379 .ilist
11380 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11381 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11382 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11383 .next
11384 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11385 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11386 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11387 .endlist
11388 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11389 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11390 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11391 list separator is changed to a comma:
11392 .code
11393 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11394 .endd
11395 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11396 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11397
11398 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11399
11400 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11401 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11402 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11403 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11404 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11405 .cindex JSON expansions
11406 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11407 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11408 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11409 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11410 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11411 be a JSON array.
11412 The array separator is not changeable.
11413 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11414 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11415
11416
11417
11418 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11419 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11420 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11421 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11422 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11423 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11424 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11425 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11426 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11427 case-independent.
11428 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11429
11430 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11431 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11432 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11433 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11434 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11435 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11436 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11437 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11438 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11439 case-independent.
11440 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11441
11442 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11443 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11444 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11445 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11446 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11447 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11448 is true.
11449 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11450
11451 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11452 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11453 .code
11454 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11455 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11456 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11457 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11458 .endd
11459
11460 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11461 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11462 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11463 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11464 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11465 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11466 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11467 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11468 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11469 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11470 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11471
11472 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11473 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11474 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11475 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11476 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11477
11478 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11479 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11480 check.
11481 This is no longer the case.
11482
11483 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11484 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11485 .code
11486 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11487 .endd
11488 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11489
11490 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11491 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11492 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11493 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11494 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11495 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11496 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11497 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11498 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11499 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11500 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11501 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11502 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11503 this can be used.
11504
11505
11506 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11507 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11508 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11509 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11510 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11511 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11512 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11513 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11514 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11515 case-independent.
11516 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11517
11518 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11519 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11520 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11521 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11522 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11523 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11524 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11525 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11526 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11527 case-independent.
11528 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11529
11530
11531 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11532 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11533 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11534 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11535 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11536 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11537 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11538 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11539 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11540 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11541 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11542 For example,
11543 .code
11544 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11545 .endd
11546 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11547 backslashes is also required.
11548
11549 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11550 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11551 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11552 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11553 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11554 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11555 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11556 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11557
11558 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11559 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11560 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11561 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11562 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11563 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11564 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11565 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11566
11567 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11568 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11569 See &*match_local_part*&.
11570
11571 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11572 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11573 See &*match_local_part*&.
11574
11575 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11576 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11577 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11578 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11579 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11580 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11581 .code
11582 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11583 .endd
11584 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11585
11586 .ilist
11587 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11588 .next
11589 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11590 .next
11591 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11592 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11593 in a single test such as
11594 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11595 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11596 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11597 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11598 .code
11599 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11600 .endd
11601 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11602 .next
11603 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11604 .next
11605 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11606 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11607 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11608 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11609 masks. For example:
11610 .code
11611 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11612 .endd
11613 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11614 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11615 address mask, for example:
11616 .code
11617 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11618 .endd
11619 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11620 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11621 .code
11622 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11623 .endd
11624 .endlist ilist
11625
11626 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11627 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11628
11629 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11630
11631 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11632 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11633 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11634 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11635 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11636 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11637 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11638 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11639 example is:
11640 .code
11641 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11642 .endd
11643 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11644 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11645 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11646 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11647 .code
11648 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11649 .endd
11650 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11651 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11652 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11653 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11654 caselessly.
11655
11656 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11657 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11658
11659 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11660 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11661 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11662 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11663
11664 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11665 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11666 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11667 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11668 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11669 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11670 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11671 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11672 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11673 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11674 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11675 .code
11676 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11677 .endd
11678 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11679 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11680
11681 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11682 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11683 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11684 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11685 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11686 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11687 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11688
11689 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11690 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11691 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11692 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11693 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11694 .code
11695 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11696 .endd
11697 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11698 .code
11699 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11700 .endd
11701 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11702 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11703 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11704 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11705
11706
11707 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11708 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11709 .cindex "Cyrus"
11710 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11711 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11712 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11713 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11714 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11715 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11716
11717 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11718 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11719 building Exim. For example:
11720 .code
11721 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11722 .endd
11723 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11724 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11725 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11726 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11727
11728 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11729 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11730 configuration, you might have this:
11731 .code
11732 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11733 .endd
11734 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11735 .code
11736 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11737 .endd
11738 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11739 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11740 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11741 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11742 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11743 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11744
11745
11746 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11747 .cindex "Radius"
11748 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11749 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11750 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11751 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11752 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11753 support.
11754
11755 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11756 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11757 this library, you need to set
11758 .code
11759 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11760 .endd
11761 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11762 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11763 .code
11764 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11765 .endd
11766 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11767 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11768 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11769
11770 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11771 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11772 the authentication is successful. For example:
11773 .code
11774 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11775 .endd
11776
11777
11778 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11779 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11780 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11781 .cindex "Cyrus"
11782 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11783 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11784 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11785 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11786 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11787 by a process that is not running as root.
11788
11789 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11790 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11791 building Exim. For example:
11792 .code
11793 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11794 .endd
11795 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11796 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11797 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11798
11799 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11800 two are mandatory. For example:
11801 .code
11802 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11803 .endd
11804 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11805 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11806 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11807 .endlist vlist
11808
11809
11810
11811 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11812 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11813 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11814 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11815 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11816 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11817 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11818
11819
11820 .vlist
11821 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11822 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11823 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11824 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11825 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11826 For example,
11827 .code
11828 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11829 .endd
11830 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11831 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11832 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11833
11834 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11835 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11836 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11837 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11838 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11839 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11840 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11841 parsed but not evaluated.
11842 .endlist
11843 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11844
11845
11846
11847
11848 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11849 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11850 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11851 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11852 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11853
11854 .vlist
11855 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11856 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11857 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11858 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11859 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11860 In the expansion condition case
11861 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11862 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11863 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11864 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11865 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11866 matching condition.
11867
11868 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11869 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11870 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11871 any unused variables being made empty.
11872
11873 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11874 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11875 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11876 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11877 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11878 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11879 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11880 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11881 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11882 during subsequent delivery.
11883
11884 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11885 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11886 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11887 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11888 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11889 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11890 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11891 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11892 delivery.
11893
11894 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11895 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11896 this variable has the number of arguments.
11897
11898 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11899 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11900 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11901 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11902 be preserved by coding like this:
11903 .code
11904 warn !verify = sender
11905 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11906 .endd
11907 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11908 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11909 failure.
11910
11911 .vitem &$address_data$&
11912 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11913 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11914 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11915 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11916 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11917 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11918 user filter files.
11919
11920 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11921 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11922 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11923 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11924 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11925 from the child's routing.
11926
11927 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11928 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11929 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11930 address.
11931
11932 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11933 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11934 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11935
11936 .vitem &$address_file$&
11937 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11938 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11939 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11940 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11941 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11942 .code
11943 /home/r2d2/savemail
11944 .endd
11945 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11946 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11947 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11948 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11949 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11950 to the relevant file.
11951
11952 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11953 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11954 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11955 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11956
11957 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11958 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11959 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11960 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11961
11962 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11963 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11964 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11965 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11966 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11967 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11968 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11969 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11970 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11971
11972 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11973 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11974 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11975 command line option.
11976 This second case also sets up information used by the
11977 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11978
11979 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11980 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11981 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11982 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11983 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11984 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11985 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11986 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11987 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11988 the ACL's as well.
11989
11990
11991 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11992 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11993 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11994 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11995 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11996 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11997 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11998 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11999 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12000 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12001 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12002
12003 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12004 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12005 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12006 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12007 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12008
12009
12010 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12011 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12012 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12013 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12014 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12015 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12016 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12017 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12018 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12019 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12020 an undefined mechanism.
12021
12022 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12023 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12024 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12025 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12026 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12027 the ACL malware condition.
12028
12029 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12030 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12031 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12032 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12033 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12034 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12035
12036 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12037 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12038 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12039 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12040 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12041 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12042 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12043
12044 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12045 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12046 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12047 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12048 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12049
12050 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12051 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12052 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12053 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12054 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12055
12056 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12057 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12058 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12059 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12060 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12061 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12062 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12063
12064 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12065 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12066 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12067 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12068 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12069 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12070 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12071
12072 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12073 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12074 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12075 address that was connected to.
12076
12077 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12078 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12079 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12080 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12081 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12082
12083 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12084 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12085 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12086 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12087 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12088 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12089
12090 .vitem &$config_file$&
12091 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12092 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12093
12094 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12095 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12096 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12097 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12098 Results of DMARC verification.
12099 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12100
12101 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12102 Results of DKIM verification.
12103 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12104
12105 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12106 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12114 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12115 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12116 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12117 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12118 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12119 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12120 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12121 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12122 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12123 &$dkim_key_length$&
12124 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12125 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12126
12127 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12128 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12129 When a message has been received this variable contains
12130 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12131 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12132
12133 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12134 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12135 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12136 &$dnslist_value$&
12137 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12138 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12139 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12140 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12141 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12142 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12143 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12144 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12145 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12146
12147 .vitem &$domain$&
12148 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12149 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12150 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12151 case for &$domain$&.
12152
12153 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12154 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12155 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12156 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12157
12158 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12159 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12160 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12161 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12162 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12163 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12164
12165 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12166 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12167 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12168
12169 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12170
12171 .ilist
12172 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12173 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12174 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12175 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12176 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12177 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12178 the &(smtp)& transport.
12179
12180 .next
12181 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12182 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12183 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12184 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12185
12186 .next
12187 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12188 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12189 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12190 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12191 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12192 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12193
12194 .next
12195 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12196 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12197 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12198 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12199 .endlist
12200
12201 .new
12202 .cindex "tainted data"
12203 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12204 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12205 .wen
12206
12207
12208 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12209 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12210 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12211 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12212 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12213 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12214 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12215 used.
12216
12217 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12218 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12219 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12220 to nothing.
12221
12222 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12223 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12224 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12225
12226 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12227 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12228 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12229
12230 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12231 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12232 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12233
12234 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12235 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12236 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12237 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12238 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12239 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12240 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12241
12242 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12243 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12244 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12245 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12246 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12247 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12248
12249 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12250 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12251 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12252 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12253 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12254
12255 .vitem &$home$&
12256 .vindex "&$home$&"
12257 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12258 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12259 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12260 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12261 by a setting on the transport itself.
12262
12263 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12264 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12265 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12266
12267 .vitem &$host$&
12268 .vindex "&$host$&"
12269 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12270 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12271 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12272 to local and remote transports.
12273
12274 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12275 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12276 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12277 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12278 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12279 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12280 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12281 is connected.
12282
12283 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12284 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12285 client is connected.
12286
12287
12288 .vitem &$host_address$&
12289 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12290 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12291 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12292 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12293
12294 .vitem &$host_data$&
12295 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12296 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12297 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12298 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12299 .code
12300 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12301 message = $host_data
12302 .endd
12303 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12304 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12305 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12306 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12307 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12308 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12309 variables is set to &"1"&.
12310
12311 .ilist
12312 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12313 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12314
12315 .next
12316 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12317 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12318 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12319 .endlist ilist
12320
12321 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12322 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12323 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12324 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12325 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12326 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12327 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12328 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12329 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12330 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12331
12332 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12333 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12334 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12335
12336
12337 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12338 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12339 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12340
12341 .vitem &$host_port$&
12342 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12343 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12344 for an outbound connection.
12345
12346 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12347 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12348 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12349 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12350 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12351 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12352
12353 .vitem &$inode$&
12354 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12355 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12356 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12357 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12358 a unique name for the file.
12359
12360 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12361 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12362 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12363
12364 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12365 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12366 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12367
12368 .vitem &$item$&
12369 .vindex "&$item$&"
12370 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12371 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12372 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12373 empty.
12374
12375 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12376 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12377 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12378 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12379 lookup.
12380
12381 .vitem &$load_average$&
12382 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12383 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12384 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12385 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12386
12387 .vitem &$local_part$&
12388 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12389 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12390 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12391 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12392 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12393
12394 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12395 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12396 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12397 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12398 once.
12399
12400 .new
12401 .cindex "tainted data"
12402 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12403 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12404
12405 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential attacker.
12406 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12407 for file access.
12408 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12409 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the &$home$&
12410 variable rather than this one.
12411 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12412 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12413 rather than this variable.
12414 .wen
12415
12416 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12417 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12418 .cindex affix variables
12419 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12420 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12421 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12422 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12423
12424 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12425 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12426 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12427 &$address_pipe$&).
12428
12429 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12430 local part of the recipient address.
12431
12432 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12433 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12434 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12435
12436 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12437 the addresses
12438 .code
12439 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12440 abc\:xyz@test.example
12441 .endd
12442 the value of &$local_part$& is
12443 .code
12444 abc:xyz
12445 .endd
12446 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12447 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12448 have:
12449 .code
12450 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12451 .endd
12452 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12453 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12454 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12455
12456 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12457 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12458 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12459 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12460 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12461 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12462 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12463
12464 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12465 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12466 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12467 variable expands to nothing.
12468
12469 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12470 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12471 .cindex affix variables
12472 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12473 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12474 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12475
12476 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12477 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12478 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12479 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12480 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12481
12482 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12483 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12484 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12485 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12486
12487 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12488 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12489 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12490
12491 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12492 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12493 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12494 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12495 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12496 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12497 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12498 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12499
12500 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12501 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12502 This contains the expanded value of the
12503 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12504 been read.
12505
12506 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12507 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12508 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12509 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12510 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12511 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12512
12513 .vitem &$log_space$&
12514 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12515 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12516 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12517 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12518 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12519 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12520
12521
12522 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12523 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12524 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12525 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12526 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12527 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12528 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12529 and &"yes"& if it was.
12530 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12531 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12532 as authenticated data.
12533
12534 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12535 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12536 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12537 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12538 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12539 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12540 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12541 variable is empty.
12542
12543 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12544 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12545 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12546 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12547 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12548
12549 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12550 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12551 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12552 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12553 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12554 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12555 character(s).
12556 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12557
12558 .vitem &$message_age$&
12559 .cindex "message" "age of"
12560 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12561 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12562 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12563 delivery attempt.
12564
12565 .vitem &$message_body$&
12566 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12567 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12568 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12569 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12570 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12571 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12572 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12573 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12574 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12575
12576 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12577 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12578 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12579 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12580 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12581
12582 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12583 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12584 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12585 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12586 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12587 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12588 &$message_body$&.
12589
12590 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12591 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12592 .cindex "message body" "size"
12593 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12594 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12595 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12596 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12597 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12598
12599 If the spool file is wireformat
12600 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12601 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12602
12603 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12604 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12605 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12606 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12607 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12608 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12609 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12610 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12611
12612 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12613 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12614 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12615 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12616 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12617 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12618
12619 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12620 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12621 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12622 contents of header lines is done.
12623
12624 .vitem &$message_id$&
12625 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12626
12627 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12628 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12629 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12630 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12631 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12632 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12633 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12634 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12635 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12636 from the body is not counted.
12637
12638 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12639 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12640 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12641 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12642 header and the body).
12643
12644 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12645 .code
12646 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12647 condition = \
12648 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12649 .endd
12650 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12651 message has not yet been received.
12652
12653 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12654
12655 .vitem &$message_size$&
12656 .cindex "size" "of message"
12657 .cindex "message" "size"
12658 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12659 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12660 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12661 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12662 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12663 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12664 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12665 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12666 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12667
12668 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12669 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12670 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12671 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12672
12673 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12674 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12675 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12676 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12677
12678 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12679 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12680 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12681
12682 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12683 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12684 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12685 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12686 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12687 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12688 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12689 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12690 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12691 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12692
12693 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12694 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12695 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12696
12697 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12698 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12699 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12700 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12701 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12702 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12703 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12704 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12705 the original address.
12706
12707 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12708 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12709 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12710 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12711 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12712
12713 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12714 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12715 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12716
12717 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12718 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12719 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12720 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12721 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12722 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12723 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12724 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12725 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12726
12727 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12728 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12729 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12730 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12731 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12732 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12733 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12734 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12735 user.
12736
12737 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12738 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12739 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12740 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12741
12742 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12743 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12744 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12745 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12746
12747 .vitem &$pid$&
12748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12749 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12750 This variable contains the current process id.
12751
12752 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12753 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12754 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12755 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12756 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12757 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12758 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12759 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12760 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12761 variable"& error if encountered.
12762
12763 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12764 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12765 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12766 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12767 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12768 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12769 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12770
12771
12772 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12773 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12774 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12775 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12776 &$proxy_session$&
12777 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12778 or SOCKS5 support.
12779 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12780
12781 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12782 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12783 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12784 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12785
12786 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12787 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12788 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12789 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12790
12791 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12792 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12793 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12794 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12795
12796 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12797 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12798 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12799 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12800
12801 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12802 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12803 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12804
12805 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12806 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12807 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12808 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12809
12810 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12811 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12812 .cindex "named queues"
12813 .cindex queues named
12814 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12815
12816 .vitem &$r_...$&
12817 .vindex &$r_...$&
12818 .cindex router variables
12819 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12820 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12821 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12822 and the eventual transport.
12823
12824 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12825 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12826 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12827 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12828 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12829
12830 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12831 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12832 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12833 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12834 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12835 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12836
12837 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12838 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12839 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12840 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12841 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12842
12843 .vitem &$received_count$&
12844 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12845 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12846 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12847 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12848 delivering.
12849
12850 .vitem &$received_for$&
12851 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12852 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12853 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12854 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12855 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12856
12857 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12858 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12859 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12860 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12861 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12862 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12863 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12864 option.
12865
12866 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12867 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12868 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12869 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12870 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12871 time.
12872 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12873
12874 .vitem &$received_port$&
12875 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12876 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12877
12878 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12879 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12880 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12881 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12882 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12883 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12884 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12885 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12886 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12887
12888 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12889 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12890 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12891 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12892 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12893 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12894
12895 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12896 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12897 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12898
12899 .vitem &$received_time$&
12900 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12901 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12902 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12903
12904 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12905 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12906 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12907 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12908 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12909 .display
12910 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12911 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12912 .endd
12913 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12914 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12915 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12916 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12917
12918 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12919 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12920 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12921 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12922
12923 .ilist
12924 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12925 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12926
12927 .next
12928 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12929
12930 .next
12931 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12932 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12933 MAIL).
12934
12935 .next
12936 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12937 .next
12938
12939 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12940 .endlist
12941
12942 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12943 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12944
12945 .vitem &$recipients$&
12946 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12947 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12948 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12949 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12950 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12951 cases:
12952
12953 .olist
12954 In a system filter file.
12955 .next
12956 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12957 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12958 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12959 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12960 .next
12961 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12962 .endlist
12963
12964
12965 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12966 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12967 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12968 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12969 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12970 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12971
12972
12973 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12974 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12975 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12976 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12977
12978 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12979 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12980 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12981 these variables contain the
12982 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12983
12984
12985 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12986 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12987 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12988 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12989 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12990 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12991 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12992
12993 .vitem &$return_path$&
12994 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12995 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12996 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12997 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12998 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12999 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13000 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13001 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13002 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13003 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13004 envelope sender.
13005
13006 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13007 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13008 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13009
13010 .vitem &$router_name$&
13011 .cindex "router" "name"
13012 .cindex "name" "of router"
13013 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13014 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13015
13016 .vitem &$runrc$&
13017 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13018 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13019 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13020 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13021 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13022 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13023 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13024 another.
13025
13026 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13027 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13028 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13029 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13030 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13031 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13032 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13033 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13034
13035 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13036 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13037 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13038 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13039 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13040 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13041
13042 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13043 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13044 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13045 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13046 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13047 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13048 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13049 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13050
13051 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13052 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13053 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13054
13055 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13056 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13057 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13058
13059 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13060 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13061 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13062 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13063 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13064 this:
13065 .display
13066 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13067 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13068 .endd
13069 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13070 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13071 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13072 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13073
13074 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13075 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13076 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13077 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13078 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13079 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13080 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13081 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13082 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13083 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13084 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13085 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13086 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13087
13088 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13089 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13090 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13091 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13092 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13093
13094 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13095 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13096 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13097 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13098 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13099 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13100
13101 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13102 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13103 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13104 this variable contains that
13105 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13106
13107 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13108 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13109 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13110 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13111 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13112 &$authenticated_id$&.
13113
13114 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13115 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13116 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13117 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13118 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13119 resolver library states that both
13120 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13121 other times, this variable is false.
13122
13123 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13124 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13125 library, by setting:
13126 .code
13127 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13128 .endd
13129
13130 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13131 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13132
13133 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13134 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13135
13136 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13137 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13138 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13139 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13140
13141
13142 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13143 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13144 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13145 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13146 other means, this variable is empty.
13147
13148 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13149 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13150 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13151 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13152 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13153 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13154 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13155
13156 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13157 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13158 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13159 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13160
13161 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13162 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13163 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13164 is set to &"1"&.
13165
13166 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13167 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13168 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13169 following are true:
13170
13171 .ilist
13172 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13173 .next
13174 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13175 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13176 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13177 .next
13178 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13179 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13180 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13181 .next
13182 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13183 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13184 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13185 .next
13186 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13187 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13188 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13189 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13190 .code
13191 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13192 .endd
13193 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13194 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13195 .endlist
13196
13197
13198 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13199 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13200 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13201 number that was used on the remote host.
13202
13203 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13204 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13205 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13206 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13207 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13208 called Exim.
13209
13210 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13211 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13212 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13213 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13214
13215 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13216 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13217 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13218 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13219 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13220 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13221 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13222 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13223 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13224 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13225 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13226 the parentheses.
13227
13228 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13229 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13230 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13231 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13232 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13233
13234 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13235 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13236 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13237 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13238 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13239
13240 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13241 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13242 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13243 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13244 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13245 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13246 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13247
13248 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13249 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13250 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13251 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13252 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13253
13254 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13255 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13256 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13257 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13258 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13259 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13260
13261 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13262 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13263 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13264 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13265 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13266 .code
13267 MAIL FROM:<>
13268 MAIL FROM: <>
13269 .endd
13270 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13271 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13272 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13273 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13274
13275 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13276 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13277 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13278 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13279 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13280 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13281 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13282
13283 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13284 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13285 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13286 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13287 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13288 are remembered.
13289
13290 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13291 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13292 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13293 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13294 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13295 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13296 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13297 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13298 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13299 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13300 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13301
13302 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13303 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13304 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13305 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13306 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13307 message is junk mail.
13308
13309 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13310 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13311 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13312 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13313
13314 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13315 &$spf_received$& &&&
13316 &$spf_result$& &&&
13317 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13318 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13319 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13320 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13321
13322 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13323 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13324 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13325
13326 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13327 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13328 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13329 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13330 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13331 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13332
13333 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13334 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13335 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13336 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13337 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13338 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13339 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13340 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13341 .code
13342 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13343 .endd
13344 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13345
13346
13347 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13348 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13349 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13350 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13351 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13352 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13353
13354 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13355 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13356 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13357 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13358 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13359 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13360 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13361 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13362
13363 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13364 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13365 the outbound.
13366
13367 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13368 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13369 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13370 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13371 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13372 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13373
13374 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13375 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13376 .cindex certificate variables
13377 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13378 inbound connection when the message was received.
13379 It is only useful as the argument of a
13380 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13381 or a &%def%& condition.
13382
13383 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13384 when a list of more than one
13385 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13386 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13387
13388 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13389 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13390 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13391 inbound connection when the message was received.
13392 It is only useful as the argument of a
13393 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13394 or a &%def%& condition.
13395 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13396 which is not the leaf.
13397
13398 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13399 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13400 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13401 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13402 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13403 or a &%def%& condition.
13404
13405 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13406 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13407 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13408 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13409 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13410 or a &%def%& condition.
13411 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13412 which is not the leaf.
13413
13414 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13415 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13416 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13417 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13418
13419 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13420 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13421 the outbound.
13422
13423 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13424 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13425 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13426 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13427 and &"0"& otherwise.
13428
13429 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13430 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13431 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13432 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13433 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13434 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13435 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13436 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13437 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13438
13439 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13440 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13441 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13442
13443 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13444 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13445 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13446
13447 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13448 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13449 This variable is
13450 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13451 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13452 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13453 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13454
13455 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13456 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13457 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13458
13459 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13460 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13461 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13462
13463 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13464 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13465 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13466 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13467 .code
13468 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13469 1 No response to request
13470 2 Response not verified
13471 3 Verification failed
13472 4 Verification succeeded
13473 .endd
13474
13475 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13476 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13477 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13478 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13479 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13480
13481 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13482 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13483 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13484 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13485 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13486 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13487 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13488 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13489 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13490 which is not the leaf.
13491
13492 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13493 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13494 the outbound.
13495
13496 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13497 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13498 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13499 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13500 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13501 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13502 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13503 which is not the leaf.
13504
13505 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13506 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13507 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13508 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13509 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13510 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13511 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13512 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13513 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13514 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13515 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13516
13517 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13518 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13519 the outbound.
13520
13521 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13522 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13523 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13524 During outbound
13525 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13526 the transport.
13527
13528 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13529 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13530 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13531
13532 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13533 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13534 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13535 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13536
13537 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13538 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13539 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13540 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13541
13542
13543 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13544 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13545 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13546 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13547
13548 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13549 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13550 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13551
13552 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13553 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13554 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13555
13556 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13557 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13558 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13559 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13560 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13561 values for those that are behind (west).
13562
13563 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13564 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13565 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13566 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13567
13568 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13569 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13570 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13571 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13572 flag.
13573
13574 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13575 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13576 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13577 -0500.
13578
13579 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13580 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13581 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13582 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13583
13584 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13585 .cindex "transport" "name"
13586 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13587 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13588 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13589
13590 .vitem &$value$&
13591 .vindex "&$value$&"
13592 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13593 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13594 &*reduce*& expansion.
13595
13596 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13597 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13598 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13599 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13600 Otherwise, empty.
13601
13602 .vitem &$version_number$&
13603 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13604 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13605 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13606
13607 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13608 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13609 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13610 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13611
13612 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13613 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13614 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13615 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13616 .endlist
13617 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13618
13619
13620
13621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13623
13624 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13625 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13626 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13627 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13628 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13629 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13630 the line
13631 .code
13632 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13633 .endd
13634 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13635
13636
13637 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13638 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13639 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13640 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13641 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13642 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13643 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13644 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13645 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13646
13647 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13648 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13649 should usually be something like
13650 .code
13651 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13652 .endd
13653 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13654 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13655 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13656 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13657 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13658 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13659 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13660 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13661 two ways:
13662
13663 .ilist
13664 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13665 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13666 a startup when Exim is entered.
13667 .next
13668 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13669 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13670 .endlist
13671
13672 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13673 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13674
13675 .ilist
13676 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13677 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13678 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13679 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13680 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13681 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13682 defaults to false.
13683
13684
13685 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13686 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13687 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13688 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13689 forms:
13690 .code
13691 ${perl{foo}}
13692 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13693 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13694 .endd
13695 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13696 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13697 with an error message of the form
13698 .code
13699 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13700 .endd
13701 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13702 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13703 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13704 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13705 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13706 that was passed to &%die%&.
13707
13708
13709 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13710 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13711 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13712 the Perl code
13713 .code
13714 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13715 .endd
13716 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13717 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13718 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13719
13720 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13721 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13722 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13723 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13724
13725 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13726 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13727 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13728 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13729 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13730 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13731 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13732
13733
13734 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13735 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13736 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13737 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13738 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13739 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13740 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13741 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13742 avoided, but the output is lost.
13743
13744 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13745 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13746 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13747 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13748 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13749 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13750 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13751 .code
13752 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13753 .endd
13754 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13755 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13756 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13757 as the first subroutine argument.
13758 .ecindex IIDperl
13759
13760
13761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13763
13764 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13765 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13766 "Starting the daemon"
13767 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13768 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13769 .cindex "network interface"
13770 .cindex "interface" "network"
13771 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13772 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13773 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13774 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13775 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13776 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13777 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13778 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13779 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13780 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13781 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13782
13783 .olist
13784 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13785 and ports to listen on.
13786 .next
13787 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13788 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13789 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13790 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13791 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13792 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13793 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13794 as an error situation.
13795 .next
13796 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13797 for the outgoing connection.
13798 .endlist
13799
13800
13801 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13802 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13803 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13804 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13805 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13806
13807 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13808 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13809 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13810 chapter describes how they operate.
13811
13812 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13813 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13814
13815
13816
13817 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13818 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13819 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13820 following options:
13821
13822 .ilist
13823 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13824 or service names.
13825 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13826 .next
13827 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13828 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13829 .endlist
13830
13831 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13832 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13833 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13834 colons. For example:
13835 .code
13836 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13837 192.168.23.65 ; \
13838 ::1 ; \
13839 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13840 .endd
13841 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13842 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13843
13844 .olist
13845 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13846 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13847 .code
13848 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13849 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13850 .endd
13851 .next
13852 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13853 with a colon separator, for example:
13854 .code
13855 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13856 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13857 .endd
13858 .endlist
13859
13860 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13861 default setting contains just one port:
13862 .code
13863 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13864 .endd
13865 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13866 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13867 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13868 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13869 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13870
13871
13872
13873 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13874 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13875 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13876 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13877 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13878 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13879 .code
13880 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13881 .endd
13882 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13883 .code
13884 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13885 .endd
13886 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13887
13888
13889
13890 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13891 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13892 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13893 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13894 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13895 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13896 exim.
13897
13898 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13899 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13900 If there are any items that do not
13901 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13902 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13903 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13904 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13905 .code
13906 -oX 1225
13907 .endd
13908 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13909 whereas
13910 .code
13911 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13912 .endd
13913 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13914 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13915 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13916
13917
13918
13919 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13920 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13921 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13922 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13923 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13924 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13925 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13926 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13927 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13928 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13929 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13930 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13931 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13932 the 465 TCP ports.
13933
13934 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13935 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13936 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13937
13938 The common use of this option is expected to be
13939 .code
13940 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13941 .endd
13942 per RFC 8314.
13943 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13944 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13945
13946 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13947 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13948 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13949 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13950 connections via the daemon.)
13951
13952
13953
13954
13955 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13956 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13957 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13958 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13959 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13960 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13961 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13962 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13963 .code
13964 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13965 .endd
13966 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13967 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13968 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13969 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13970 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13971 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13972 .code
13973 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13974 .endd
13975 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13976 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13977 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13978 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13979 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13980
13981 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13982 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13983 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13984 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13985 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13986 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13987 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13988 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13989 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13990 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13991 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13992 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13993
13994 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13995 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13996 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13997 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13998 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13999
14000
14001
14002 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14003 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14004 .code
14005 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14006 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14007 .endd
14008 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14009 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14010 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14011 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14012
14013 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14014 .code
14015 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14016 .endd
14017 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14018 .code
14019 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14020 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14021 .endd
14022 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14023 IPv4 loopback address only:
14024 .code
14025 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14026 .endd
14027 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14028 .code
14029 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14030 .endd
14031 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14032
14033
14034
14035 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14036 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14037 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14038 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14039 treated as local.
14040
14041 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14042 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14043 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14044 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14045
14046 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14047 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14048 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14049 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14050 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14051 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14052 used for listening. Consider this example:
14053 .code
14054 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14055 192.168.53.235 ; \
14056 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14057
14058 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14059 .endd
14060 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14061 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14062 Exim is routing.
14063
14064 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14065 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14066 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14067 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14068 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14069 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14070 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14071 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14072
14073
14074
14075 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14076 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14077 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14078 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14079 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14080 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14081 details.
14082
14083
14084
14085
14086 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14087 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14088
14089 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14090 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14091 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14092 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14093
14094 .ilist
14095 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14096 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14097 .next
14098 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14099 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14100 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14101 .next
14102 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14103 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14104 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14105 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14106 settings.
14107 .endlist
14108
14109 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14110 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14111 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14112 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14113 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14114 listed in more than one group.
14115
14116 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14117 .table2
14118 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14119 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14120 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14121 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14122 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14123 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14124 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14125 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14126 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14127 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14128 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14129 .endtable
14130
14131
14132 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14133 .table2
14134 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14135 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14136 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14137 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14138 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14139 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14140 .endtable
14141
14142
14143
14144 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14145 .table2
14146 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14147 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14148 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14149 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14150 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14151 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14152 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14153 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14154 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14155 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14156 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14157 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14158 .endtable
14159
14160
14161
14162 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14163 .table2
14164 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14165 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14166 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14167 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14168 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14169 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14170 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14171 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14172 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14173 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14174 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14175 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14176 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14177 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14178 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14179 .endtable
14180
14181
14182
14183 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14184 .table2
14185 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14186 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14187 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14188 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14189 .endtable
14190
14191
14192
14193 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14194 .table2
14195 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14196 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14197 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14198 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14199 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14200 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14201 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14202 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14203 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14204 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14205 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14206 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14207 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14208 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14209 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14210 .endtable
14211
14212
14213
14214 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14215 .table2
14216 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14217 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14218 .endtable
14219
14220
14221
14222 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14223 .table2
14224 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14225 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14226 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14227 .endtable
14228
14229
14230
14231 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14232 .table2
14233 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14234 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14235 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14236 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14237 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14238 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14239 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14240 .endtable
14241
14242
14243
14244 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14245 .table2
14246 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14247 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14248 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14249 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14250 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14251 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14252 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14253 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14254 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14255 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14256 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14257 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14258 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14259 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14260 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14261 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14262 connection"
14263 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14264 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14265 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14266 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14267 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14268 .endtable
14269
14270
14271
14272 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14273 .table2
14274 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14275 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14276 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14277 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14278 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14279 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14280 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14281 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14282 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14283 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14284 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14285 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14286 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14287 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14288 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14289 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14290 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14291 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14292 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14293 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14294 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14295 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14296 words""&"
14297 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14298 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14299 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14300 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14301 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14302 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14303 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14304 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14305 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14306 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14307 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14308 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14309 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14310 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14311 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14312 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14313 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14314 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14315 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14316 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14317 .endtable
14318
14319
14320
14321 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14322 .table2
14323 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14324 item"
14325 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14326 item"
14327 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14328 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14329 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14330 .endtable
14331
14332
14333
14334 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14335 .table2
14336 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14337 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14338 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14339 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14340 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14341 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14342 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14343 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14344 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14345 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14346 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14347 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14348 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14349 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14350 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14351 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14352 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14353 .endtable
14354
14355
14356
14357 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14358 .table2
14359 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14360 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14361 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14362 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14363 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14364 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14365 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14366 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14367 .endtable
14368
14369
14370
14371 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14372 .table2
14373 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14374 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14375 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14376 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14377 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14378 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14379 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14380 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14381 .endtable
14382
14383
14384
14385
14386 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14387 .table2
14388 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14389 .endtable
14390
14391
14392
14393
14394
14395 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14396 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14397
14398 .table2
14399 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14400 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14401 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14402 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14403 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14404 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14405 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14406 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14407 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14408 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14409 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14410 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14411 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14412 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14413 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14414 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14415 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14416 connection"
14417 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14418 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14419 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14420 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14421 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14422 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14423 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14424 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14425 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14426 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14427 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14428 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14429 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14430 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14431 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14432 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14433 .endtable
14434
14435
14436
14437 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14438 .table2
14439 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14440 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14441 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14442 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14443 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14444 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14445 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14446 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14447 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14448 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14449 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14450 .endtable
14451
14452
14453
14454 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14455 .table2
14456 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14457 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14458 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14459 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14460 words""&"
14461 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14462 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14463 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14464 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14465 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14466 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14467 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14468 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14469 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14470 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14471 .endtable
14472
14473
14474
14475 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14476 .table2
14477 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14478 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14479 directory"
14480 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14481 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14482 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14483 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14484 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14485 .endtable
14486
14487
14488
14489 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14490 .table2
14491 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14492 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14493 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14494 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14495 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14496 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14497 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14498 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14499 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14500 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14501 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14502 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14503 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14504 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14505 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14506 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14507 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14508 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14509 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14510 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14511 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14512 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14513 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14514 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14515 .endtable
14516
14517
14518
14519 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14520 .table2
14521 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14522 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14523 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14524 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14525 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14526 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14527 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14528 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14529 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14530 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14531 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14532 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14533 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14534 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14535 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14536 .endtable
14537
14538
14539
14540 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14541 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14542 &dagger;.
14543
14544 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14545 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14546 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14547 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14548 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14549 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14550 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14551 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14552 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14553
14554 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14555 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14556 It now defaults to true.
14557 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14558 .display
14559 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14560 .endd
14561
14562 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14563 .code
14564 log_selector = +8bitmime
14565 .endd
14566
14567 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14568 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14569 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14570 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14571 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14572 further details.
14573
14574 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14575 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14576 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14577 SMTP messages.
14578
14579 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14580 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14581 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14582 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14583 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14584
14585 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14586 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14587 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14588 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14589 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14590
14591 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14593 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14594 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14595
14596 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14597 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14598 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14599 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14600 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14601
14602 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14603 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14604 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14605 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14606 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14607 This option defines the ACL that,
14608 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14609 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14610 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14611 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14612
14613 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14614 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14615 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14616 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14617 of a received message.
14618 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14619
14620 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14621 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14622 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14623 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14624
14625 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14626 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14627 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14628 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14629
14630 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14631 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14632 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14633 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14634 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14635
14636
14637 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14638 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14639 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14640 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14641
14642 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14643 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14644 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14645 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14646 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14647
14648 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14649 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14650 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14651 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14652 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14653
14654 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14655 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14656 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14657 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14658 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14659
14660 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14661 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14662 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14663 further details.
14664
14665 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14666 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14667 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14668 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14669
14670 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14671 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14672 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14673 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14674
14675 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14676 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14677 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14678 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14679
14680 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14681 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14682 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14683 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14684
14685 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14686 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14687 This option adds individual environment variables that the
14688 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14689 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14690
14691 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14692
14693 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14694 .cindex "admin user"
14695 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14696 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14697 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14698 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14699 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14700 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14701 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14702
14703 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14704 .cindex "domain literal"
14705 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14706 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14707 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14708 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14709
14710 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14711 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14712 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14713 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14714 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14715 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14716 the local host's IP addresses.
14717
14718
14719 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14720 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14721 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14722 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14723 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14724 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14725 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14726 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14727 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14728
14729 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14730 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14731 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14732 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14733 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14734 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14735 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14736
14737 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14738 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14739 letters, digits, and hyphens.
14740
14741 If Exim is built with internationalization support
14742 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14743 this option can be left as default.
14744 Without that,
14745 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14746 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14747 suitable setting is:
14748 .code
14749 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14750 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14751 .endd
14752 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14753 .code
14754 dns_check_names_pattern =
14755 .endd
14756 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14757
14758
14759 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14760 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14761 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14762 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14763 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14764 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14765 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14766 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14767 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14768 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14769 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14770
14771 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14772 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14773 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14774 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14775 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14776 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14777
14778 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14779 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14780 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14781 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14782 .code
14783 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14784 .endd
14785 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14786 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14787 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14788 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14789
14790
14791 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14792 .cindex "thawing messages"
14793 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14794 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14795 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14796 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14797 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14798 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14799
14800 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14801 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14802 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14803
14804
14805 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14806 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14807 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14808 .code
14809 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14810 .endd
14811 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14812 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14813
14814
14815 .option bi_command main string unset
14816 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14817 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14818 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14819 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14820 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14821
14822
14823 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14824 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14825 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14826 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14827 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14828 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14829
14830
14831 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14832 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14833 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14834 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14835
14836 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14837 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14838 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14839 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14840 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14841 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14842 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14843 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14844 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14845 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14846
14847 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14848 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14849 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14850 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14851 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14852 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14853 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14854 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14855 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14856 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14857
14858 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14859 during reception of a message.
14860 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14861
14862 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14863
14864
14865 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14866 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14867 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14868 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14869
14870
14871 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14872 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14873 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14874 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14875 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14876 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14877 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14878 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14879 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14880
14881 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14882 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14883 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14884 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14885 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14886 messages.
14887
14888 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14889 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14890 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14891 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14892 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14893 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14894 connection. A typical setting might be:
14895 .code
14896 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14897 .endd
14898 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14899 .code
14900 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14901 .endd
14902 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14903 address.
14904
14905 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14906 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14907 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14908 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14909 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14910 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14911
14912
14913 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14914 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14915 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14916 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14917
14918
14919 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14920 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14921 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14922 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14923
14924
14925 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14926 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14927 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14928 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14929
14930
14931 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14932 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14933 callout verification. The default value is
14934 .code
14935 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14936 .endd
14937 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14938
14939
14940 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14941 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14942
14943
14944 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14945 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14946
14947 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14948 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14949 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14950 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14951 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14952 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14953 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14954 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14955 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14956 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14957
14958
14959 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14960 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14961
14962
14963 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14964 .cindex "checking disk space"
14965 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14966 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14967 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14968 message is accepted.
14969
14970 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14971 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14972 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14973 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14974 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14975 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14976 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14977 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14978
14979
14980 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14981 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14982 .code
14983 check_spool_space = 100M
14984 check_spool_inodes = 100
14985 .endd
14986 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14987 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14988 transit.
14989
14990 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14991 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14992 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14993
14994 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14995 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14996 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14997 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14998 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14999 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15000
15001 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15002 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15003 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15004
15005 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15006 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15007 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15008
15009 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15010 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15011 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15012 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15013
15014 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15015 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15016 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15017 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15018 these hosts.
15019 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15020
15021 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15022 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15023 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15024 administrative user.
15025 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15026
15027 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15028 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15029 .cindex memory debugging
15030 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15031 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15032 it should normally be left as default.
15033
15034 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15035 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15036 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15037 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15038 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15039 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15040
15041 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15042 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15043 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15044 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15045 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15046 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15047 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15048
15049 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15050 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15051
15052 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15053 .cindex "warning of delay"
15054 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15055 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15056 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15057 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15058 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15059 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15060 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15061 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15062 with
15063 .code
15064 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15065 .endd
15066 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15067 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15068 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15069 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15070 .code
15071 delay_warning = 6h
15072 .endd
15073 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15074 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15075 .code
15076 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15077 .endd
15078 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15079 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15080 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15081
15082 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15083 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15084 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15085 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15086 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15087 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15088 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15089 not sent. The default is:
15090 .code
15091 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15092 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15093 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15094 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15095 } {no}{yes}}
15096 .endd
15097 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15098 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15099 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15100 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15101
15102 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15103 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15104 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15105 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15106 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15107 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15108 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15109 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15110
15111 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15112 .cindex "load average"
15113 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15114 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15115 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15116 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15117 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15118
15119
15120 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15121 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15122 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15123 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15124 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15125 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15126 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15127 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15128
15129 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15130 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15131 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15132 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15133 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15134 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15135 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15136 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15137
15138 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15139 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15140 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15141 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15142
15143
15144 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15145 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15146 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15147 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15148 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15149 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15150 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15151
15152
15153 .new
15154 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15155 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15156 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15157 .wen
15158 and an order of processing.
15159 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15160
15161 Acceptable values include:
15162 .code
15163 sha1
15164 sha256
15165 sha512
15166 .endd
15167
15168 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15169
15170 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15171 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15172 and an order of processing.
15173 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15174
15175 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15176 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15177 first success.
15178
15179 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15180 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15181 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15182 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15183 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15184 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15185
15186
15187 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15188 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15189 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15190 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15191 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15192 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15193 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15194 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15195 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15196 by a setting such as this:
15197 .code
15198 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15199 .endd
15200 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15201 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15202 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15203 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15204 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15205 options are applied after this global option.
15206
15207 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15208 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15209 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15210 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15211 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15212 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15213 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15214 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15215 value of this option. The default pattern is
15216 .code
15217 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15218 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15219 .endd
15220 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15221 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15222 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15223 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15224 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15225 empty string.
15226
15227 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15228 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15229 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15230
15231 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15232 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15233 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15234 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15235
15236 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15237 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15238 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15239 not do it internally.
15240 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15241 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15242
15243 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15244 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15245 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15246
15247
15248 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15249 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15250 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15251 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15252 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15253 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15254
15255 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15256
15257
15258 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15259 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15260 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15261 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15262 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15263 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15264 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15265 domain matches this list.
15266
15267 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15268 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15269 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15270 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15271 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15272 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15273
15274
15275 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15276 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15277 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15278 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15279 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15280 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15281 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15282 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15283 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15284 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15285 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15286 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15287 to set in them.
15288 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15289
15290
15291 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15292 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15293
15294
15295 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15296 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15297 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15298 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15299 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15300 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15301 match with this expanded domain list.
15302
15303 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15304 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15305 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15306 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15307 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15308 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15309
15310 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15311 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15312 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15313
15314 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15315 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15316 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15317 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15318 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15319
15320 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15321 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15322 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15323 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15324 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15325 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15326 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15327 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15328 on.
15329
15330 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15331
15332 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15333 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15334 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15335
15336
15337 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15338 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15339 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15340 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15341
15342 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15343 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15344 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15345 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15346 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15347 and accepted from, these hosts.
15348 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15349 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15350 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15351 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15352 are sent.
15353
15354 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15355 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15356 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15357 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15358 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15359 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15360 .code
15361 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15362 .endd
15363 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15364 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15365
15366 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15367 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15368 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15369 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15370 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15371 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15372 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15373 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15374 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15375
15376
15377 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15378 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15379 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15380 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15381 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15382 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15383 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15384 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15385 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15386
15387 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15388 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15389 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15390 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15391 are examined. For example:
15392 .code
15393 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15394 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15395 postmaster@mydomain.example
15396 .endd
15397 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15398 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15399 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15400 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15401 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15402 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15403 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15404
15405
15406 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15407 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15408 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15409 .display
15410 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15411 .endd
15412 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15413 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15414 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15415 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15416 overrides the default.
15417
15418 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15419 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15420 and warning messages. For example:
15421 .code
15422 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15423 .endd
15424 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15425 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15426 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15427 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15428 not used.
15429
15430
15431 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15432 .cindex events
15433 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15434 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15435
15436
15437 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15438 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15439 .cindex "Exim group"
15440 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15441 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15442 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15443 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15444 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15445 security issues.
15446
15447
15448 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15449 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15450 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15451 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15452 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15453 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15454 other place.
15455 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15456 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15457 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15458 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15459
15460
15461 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15462 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15463 .cindex "Exim user"
15464 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15465 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15466 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15467 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15468
15469 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15470 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15471 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15472 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15473
15474
15475 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15476 .cindex "Exim version"
15477 .cindex customizing "version number"
15478 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15479 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15480 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15481
15482
15483 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15484 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15485 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15486 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15487
15488
15489 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15490 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15491
15492 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15493 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15494 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15495 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15496 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15497 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15498 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15499 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15500 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15501 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15502 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15503 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15504 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15505 addresses.
15506
15507
15508 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15509 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15510 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15511 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15512 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15513 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15514 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15515 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15516 retries.
15517
15518 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15519 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15520 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15521 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15522
15523
15524
15525 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15526 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15527 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15528 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15529 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15530 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15531 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15532 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15533 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15534 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15535 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15536 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15537 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15538 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15539 logging that you require.
15540
15541
15542 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15543 .cindex "HP-UX"
15544 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15545 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15546 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15547 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15548 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15549 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15550 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15551 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15552
15553 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15554 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15555 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15556 user's name.
15557
15558 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15559 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15560 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15561 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15562 .code
15563 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15564 gecos_name = $1
15565 .endd
15566
15567 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15568 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15569
15570
15571 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15572 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15573 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15574 implementations of TLS.
15575
15576
15577 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15578 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15579 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15580
15581 See
15582 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15583 for documentation.
15584
15585
15586
15587 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15588 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15589 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15590 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15591 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15592 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15593
15594
15595
15596 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15597 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15598 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15599 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15600 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15601 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15602 sections are rejected.
15603
15604
15605 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15606 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15607 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15608 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15609 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15610 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15611 zero means &"no limit"&.
15612
15613
15614
15615
15616 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15617 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15618 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15619 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15620 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15621 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15622 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15623 if you want to do semantic checking.
15624 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15625 set.
15626
15627
15628 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15629 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15630 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15631 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15632 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15633 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15634 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15635 .code
15636 helo_allow_chars = _
15637 .endd
15638 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15639
15640
15641 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15642 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15643 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15644 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15645 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15646 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15647 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15648 do.
15649
15650
15651 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15652 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15653 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15654 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15655 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15656 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15657 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15658 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15659 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15660 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15661 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15662 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15663
15664 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15665 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15666 EHLO command either:
15667
15668 .ilist
15669 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15670 .next
15671 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15672 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15673 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15674 calling host address, or
15675 .next
15676 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15677 .endlist
15678
15679 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15680 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15681 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15682
15683 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15684 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15685 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15686
15687 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15688 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15689 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15690 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15691 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15692 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15693 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15694 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15695 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15696 error.
15697
15698 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15699 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15700 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15701 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15702 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15703 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15704 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15705 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15706 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15707
15708 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15709 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15710 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15711 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15712 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15713
15714 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15715 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15716 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15717 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15718
15719
15720 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15721 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15722 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15723 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15724 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15725 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15726 default configuration file contains
15727 .code
15728 host_lookup = *
15729 .endd
15730 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15731 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15732
15733 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15734 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15735 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15736
15737 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15738 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15739 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15740 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15741 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15742 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15743
15744
15745 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15746 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15747 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15748 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15749 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15750 if you want.
15751
15752 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15753 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15754 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15755 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15756
15757
15758
15759 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15760 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15761 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15762 as soon as the connection is made.
15763 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15764 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15765 connections immediately.
15766
15767 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15768 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15769 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15770 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15771 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15772
15773
15774 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15775 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15776 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15777 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15778 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15779 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15780 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15781 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15782 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15783 .code
15784 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15785 .endd
15786 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15787
15788
15789
15790 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15791 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15792 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15793 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15794
15795
15796 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15797 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15798 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15799 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15800 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15801 records
15802 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15803 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15804
15805 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15806 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15807 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15808 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15809 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15810 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15811 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15812
15813
15814 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15815 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15816 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15817 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15818 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15819
15820
15821
15822 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15823 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15824 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15825 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15826 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15827 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15828
15829 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15830 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15831 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15832 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15833 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15834 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15835 for frozen messages. For example,
15836 .code
15837 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15838 .endd
15839 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15840 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15841 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15842 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15843 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15844 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15845
15846
15847 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15848 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15849 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15850 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15851 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15852 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15853 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15854 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15855 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15856 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15857
15858
15859 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15860 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15861
15862 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15863 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15864 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15865 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15866 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15867 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15868 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15869 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15870 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15871
15872 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15873 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15874
15875 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15876 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15877 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15878 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15879
15880 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15881 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15882 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15883 anymore.
15884
15885 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15886 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15887 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15888 details.
15889
15890
15891 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15892 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15893 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15894 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15895 logged.
15896
15897
15898 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15899 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15900 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15901 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15902 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15903 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15904 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15905 and constrained to be a directory.
15906
15907
15908 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15909 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15910 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15911 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15912 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15913 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15914 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15915 and constrained to be a file.
15916
15917
15918 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15919 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15920 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15921 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15922 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15923 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15924
15925
15926 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15927 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15928 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15929 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15930 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15931 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15932 identity to be proven.
15933
15934
15935 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15936 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15937 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15938 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15939 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15940
15941
15942 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15943 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15944 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15945 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15946 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15947 with LDAP support.
15948
15949
15950 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15951 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15952 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15953 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15954 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15955 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15956 to hard/demand.
15957
15958
15959 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15960 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15961 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15962 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15963 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15964 of SSL-on-connect.
15965 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15966 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15967 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15968
15969
15970 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15971 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15972 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15973 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15974 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15975 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15976 has been built with LDAP support.
15977
15978
15979
15980 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15981 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15982 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15983 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15984 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15985 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15986 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15987
15988 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15989 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15990 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15991
15992 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15993 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15994 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15995 and the default qualify domain.
15996
15997 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15998 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15999 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16000 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16001
16002 .cindex "envelope from"
16003 .cindex "envelope sender"
16004 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16005 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16006 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16007
16008 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16009 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16010 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16011
16012
16013
16014
16015 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16016 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16017 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16018 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16019 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16020 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16021 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16022 example, if
16023 .code
16024 local_from_prefix = *-
16025 .endd
16026 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16027 .code
16028 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16029 .endd
16030 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16031 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16032 qualify domain.
16033
16034
16035 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16036 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16037
16038
16039 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16040 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16041 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16042 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16043 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16044 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16045 &%local_interfaces%& is
16046 .code
16047 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16048 .endd
16049 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16050 .code
16051 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16052 .endd
16053
16054 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16055 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16056 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16057 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16058 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16059 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16060 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16061 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16062
16063
16064
16065 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16066 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16067 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16068 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16069 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16070 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16071 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16072 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16073
16074
16075
16076
16077 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16078 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16079 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16080 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16081 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16082 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16083 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16084 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16085 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16086 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16087 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16088 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16089 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16090 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16091 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16092
16093
16094
16095 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16096 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16097 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16098 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16099 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16100 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16101 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16102 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16103 A path must start with a slash.
16104 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16105 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16106 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16107 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16108 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16109 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16110 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16111 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16112
16113
16114 .option log_selector main string unset
16115 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16116 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16117 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16118 minus characters. For example:
16119 .code
16120 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16121 .endd
16122 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16123 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16124
16125
16126 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16127 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16128 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16129 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16130 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16131 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16132 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16133 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16134 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16135 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16136 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16137 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16138 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16139
16140
16141 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16142 .cindex "too many open files"
16143 .cindex "open files, too many"
16144 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16145 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16146 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16147 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16148 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16149 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16150 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16151 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16152 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16153 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16154 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16155 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16156
16157
16158 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16159 .cindex "length of login name"
16160 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16161 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16162 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16163 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16164 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16165 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16166
16167
16168 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16169 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16170 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16171 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16172 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16173 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16174 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16175 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16176
16177
16178 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16179 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16180 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16181 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16182 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16183 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16184 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16185
16186
16187 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16188 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16189 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16190 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16191 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16192 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16193 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16194 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16195 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16196 empty string, the option is ignored.
16197
16198
16199 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16200 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16201 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16202 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16203 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16204 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16205 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16206 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16207 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16208 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16209 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16210 colons will become hyphens.
16211
16212
16213 .option message_logs main boolean true
16214 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16215 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16216 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16217 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16218 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16219 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16220 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16221 which is not affected by this option.
16222
16223
16224 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16225 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16226 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16227 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16228 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16229 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16230 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16231 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16232 optionally followed by K or M.
16233
16234 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16235 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16236 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16237 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16238 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16239
16240 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16241 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16242 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16243 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16244 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16245 message that an individual transport can process.
16246
16247 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16248 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16249 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16250 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16251 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16252 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16253 some problems may result.
16254
16255 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16256 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16257 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16258
16259
16260 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16261 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16262 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16263 .code
16264 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16265 .endd
16266 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16267 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16268 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16269 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16270 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16271
16272
16273 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16274 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16275 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16276 contains a full description of this facility.
16277
16278
16279
16280 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16281 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16282 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16283 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16284 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16285
16286
16287 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16288 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16289 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16290 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16291 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16292 safety precaution.
16293
16294 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16295 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16296 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16297 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16298 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16299
16300 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16301 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16302 example is
16303 .code
16304 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16305 .endd
16306 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16307 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16308 transport driver.
16309
16310
16311 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16312 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16313 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16314 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16315 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16316
16317 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16318 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16319 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16320 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16321 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16322 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16323 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16324
16325 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16326 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16327 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16328 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16329 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16330
16331 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16332
16333 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16334 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16335 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16336 some now infamous attacks.
16337
16338 Examples:
16339 .code
16340 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16341 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16342 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16343
16344 # Disable older protocol versions:
16345 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16346 .endd
16347
16348 Possible options may include:
16349 .ilist
16350 &`all`&
16351 .next
16352 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16353 .next
16354 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16355 .next
16356 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16357 .next
16358 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
16359 .next
16360 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16361 .next
16362 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16363 .next
16364 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16365 .next
16366 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16367 .next
16368 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16369 .next
16370 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16371 .next
16372 &`no_compression`&
16373 .next
16374 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16375 .next
16376 &`no_sslv2`&
16377 .next
16378 &`no_sslv3`&
16379 .next
16380 &`no_ticket`&
16381 .next
16382 &`no_tlsv1`&
16383 .next
16384 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
16385 .next
16386 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
16387 .next
16388 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16389 .next
16390 &`single_dh_use`&
16391 .next
16392 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16393 .next
16394 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16395 .next
16396 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16397 .next
16398 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16399 .next
16400 &`tls_d5_bug`&
16401 .next
16402 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16403 .endlist
16404
16405 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16406 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16407 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16408 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16409 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16410 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16411
16412
16413 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16414 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16415 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16416 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16417 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16418
16419
16420 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16421 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16422 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16423 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16424 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16425 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16426 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16427 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16428 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16429 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16430 an ACL.
16431
16432 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16433 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16434 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16435 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16436 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16437 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16438 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16439
16440
16441 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16442 .cindex "Perl"
16443 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16444 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16445
16446
16447 .option perl_startup main string unset
16448 .cindex "Perl"
16449 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16450 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16451
16452 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16453 .cindex "Perl"
16454 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16455
16456
16457 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16458 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16459 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16460 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16461 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16462 PostgreSQL support.
16463
16464
16465 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16466 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16467 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16468 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16469 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16470 to the host name:
16471 .code
16472 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16473 .endd
16474 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16475 spool directory.
16476 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16477 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16478 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16479
16480
16481 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16482 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16483 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16484 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16485 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16486 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16487 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16488 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16489 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16490
16491 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16492 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16493 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16494 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16495 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16496 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16497 commands are acceptable.
16498 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16499
16500 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16501
16502 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16503
16504
16505 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16506 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16507 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16508 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16509 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16510 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16511 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16512 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16513
16514 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16515 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16516 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16517 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16518 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16519 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16520 volume of mail. Use with care!
16521
16522
16523 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16524 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16525 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16526 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16527 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16528 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16529 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16530 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16531 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16532 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16533
16534 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16535 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16536 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16537 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16538 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16539 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16540
16541
16542 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16543 .cindex "printing characters"
16544 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16545 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16546 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16547 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16548 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16549 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16550 characters.
16551
16552 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16553 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16554 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16555 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16556 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16557 standards.
16558
16559
16560 .option process_log_path main string unset
16561 .cindex "process log path"
16562 .cindex "log" "process log"
16563 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16564 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16565 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16566 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16567 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16568 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16569 different spool directories.
16570
16571
16572 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16573 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16574 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16575 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16576 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16577 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16578 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16579 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16580
16581
16582 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16583 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16584 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16585 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16586 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16587 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16588 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16589 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16590 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16591
16592 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16593 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16594 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16595 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16596 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16597 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16598 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16599
16600
16601 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16602 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16603 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16604
16605
16606
16607 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16608 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16609 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16610 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16611 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16612 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16613 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16614 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16615
16616
16617 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16618 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16619 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16620 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16621 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16622 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16623 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16624
16625
16626 .option queue_only main boolean false
16627 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16628 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16629 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16630 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16631 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16632 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16633
16634 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16635 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16636 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16637 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16638
16639
16640 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16641 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16642 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16643 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16644 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16645 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16646 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16647 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16648 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16649 .code
16650 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16651 .endd
16652 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16653 &_/some/file_& exists.
16654
16655
16656 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16657 .cindex "load average"
16658 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16659 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16660 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16661 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16662 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16663 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16664 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16665 false.
16666
16667 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16668 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16669 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16670 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16671
16672
16673 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16674 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16675 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16676 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16677 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16678 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16679 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16680 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16681 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16682 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16683 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16684 re-evaluated for each message.
16685
16686
16687 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16688 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16689 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16690 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16691 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16692 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16693
16694
16695 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16696 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16697 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16698 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16699 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16700 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16701 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16702 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16703 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16704 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16705 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16706 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16707 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16708
16709
16710
16711 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16712 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16713 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16714 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16715 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16716 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16717 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16718 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16719 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16720
16721 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16722 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16723 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16724 the daemon's command line.
16725
16726 .cindex queues named
16727 .cindex "named queues"
16728 To set limits for different named queues use
16729 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16730
16731 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16732 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16733 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16734 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16735 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16736 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16737 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16738 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16739 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16740 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16741 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16742 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16743 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16744 &%queue_domains%&.
16745
16746
16747 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16748 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16749 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16750 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16751 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16752 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16753 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16754
16755 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16756 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16757 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16758 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16759 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16760 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16761 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16762 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16763 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16764 header lines.
16765 The default setting is:
16766
16767 .code
16768 received_header_text = Received: \
16769 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16770 {${if def:sender_ident \
16771 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16772 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16773 by $primary_hostname \
16774 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16775 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16776 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16777 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16778 ${if def:sender_address \
16779 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16780 id $message_exim_id\
16781 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16782 .endd
16783
16784 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16785 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16786 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16787 header lines such as the following:
16788 .code
16789 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16790 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16791 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16792 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16793 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16794 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16795 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16796 .endd
16797 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16798 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16799 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16800 message was accepted.
16801
16802
16803 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16804 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16805 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16806 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16807 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16808 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16809 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16810 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16811
16812
16813 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16814 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16815 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16816 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16817 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16818 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16819 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16820 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16821 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16822 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16823 option was not set.
16824
16825
16826 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16827 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16828 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16829 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16830 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16831 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16832 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16833 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16834 done.
16835
16836 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16837 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16838 RCPT commands in a single message.
16839
16840
16841 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16842 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16843 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16844 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16845 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16846 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16847 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16848
16849
16850 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16851 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16852 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16853 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16854 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16855 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16856 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16857 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16858 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16859 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16860 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16861 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16862 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16863 tagged with its process id.
16864
16865 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16866 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16867 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16868 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16869 is received.
16870
16871 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16872 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16873 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16874 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16875 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16876 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16877 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16878 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16879 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16880 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16881 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16882
16883 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16884 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16885 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16886 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16887
16888
16889 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16890 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16891 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16892 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16893 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16894 .code
16895 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16896 .endd
16897 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16898 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16899
16900
16901 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16902 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16903 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16904 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16905 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16906 past failures.
16907
16908
16909 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16910 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16911 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16912 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16913 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16914 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16915 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16916 the default value.
16917
16918
16919 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16920 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16921 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16922 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16923 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16924 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16925 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16926 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16927 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16928 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16929
16930
16931 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16932 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16933
16934
16935 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16936 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16937 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16938 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16939 an item in the list.
16940 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16941 for the system.
16942
16943 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16944 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16945 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16946 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16947 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16948
16949
16950 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16951 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16952 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16953 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16954 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16955 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16956 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16957 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16958 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16959 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16960
16961
16962 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16963 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16964 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16965 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16966 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16967 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16968 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16969
16970
16971
16972 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16973 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16974 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16975 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16976 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16977 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16978 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16979 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16980 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16981 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16982 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16983
16984
16985
16986 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16987 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16988 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16989 .cindex "inetd"
16990 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16991 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16992 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16993 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16994 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16995 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16996
16997 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16998 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16999 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17000 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17001
17002
17003 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17004 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17005 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17006 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17007 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17008 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17009 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17010 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17011
17012 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17013 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17014 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17015 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17016 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17017 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17018 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17019 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17020
17021
17022 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17023 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17024 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17025 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17026 live with.
17027
17028
17029 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17030 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17031 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17032 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17033 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17034 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17035 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17036 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17037 . the option name to split.
17038
17039 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17040 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17041 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17042 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17043 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17044 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17045 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17046 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17047 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17048 seen).
17049
17050
17051 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17052 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17053 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17054 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17055 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17056 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17057 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17058 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17059 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17060 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17061 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17062
17063 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17064 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17065 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17066 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17067 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17068 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17069
17070
17071
17072 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17073 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17074 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17075 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17076 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17077 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17078 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17079 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17080 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17081 to all messages received in the same connection.
17082
17083 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17084 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17085 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17086 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17087
17088
17089 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17090
17091 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17092 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17093 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17094 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17095 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17096 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17097 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17098 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17099 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17100 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17101 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17102 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17103 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17104
17105
17106 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17107 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17108 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17109 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17110 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17111 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17112 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17113 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17114 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17115 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17116 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17117 individual host.
17118
17119 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17120 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17121 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17122 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17123
17124
17125 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17126 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17127 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17128 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17129 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17130 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17131 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17132 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17133 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17134
17135 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17136 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17137 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17138 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17139
17140 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17141 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17142 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17143 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17144 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17145 For example:
17146 .code
17147 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17148 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17149 .endd
17150
17151 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17152 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17153 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17154 &%helo_data%& value.
17155
17156 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17157 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17158 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17159 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17160 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17161 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17162 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17163 .code
17164 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17165 $version_number $tod_full
17166 .endd
17167 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17168 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17169 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17170 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17171 multiline response).
17172
17173
17174 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17175 .cindex "checking disk space"
17176 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17177 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17178 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17179 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17180 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17181 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17182 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17183
17184
17185 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17186 .cindex "connection backlog"
17187 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17188 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17189 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17190 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17191 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17192 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17193 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17194 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17195 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17196 attacks by SYN flooding.
17197
17198
17199 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17200 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17201 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17202 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17203 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17204 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17205 fewer, but they still exist.
17206
17207 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17208 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17209 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17210 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17211 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17212 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17213 does detect many instances.
17214
17215 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17216 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17217 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17218 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17219
17220
17221
17222 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17223 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17224 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17225 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17226 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17227 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17228 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17229 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17230 example:
17231 .code
17232 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17233 $sender_host_address
17234 .endd
17235 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17236 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17237 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17238 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17239 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17240 the command.
17241
17242
17243 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17244 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17245 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17246 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17247 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17248
17249
17250 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17251 .cindex "load average"
17252 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17253 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17254 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17255 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17256 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17257 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17258
17259
17260
17261 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17262 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17263 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17264 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17265 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17266 .code
17267 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17268 .endd
17269 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17270 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17271 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17272 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17273 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17274
17275 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17276 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17277 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17278 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17279 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17280 not count towards the limit.
17281
17282
17283
17284 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17285 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17286 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17287 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17288 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17289 that subvert web
17290 clients
17291 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17292 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17293
17294
17295
17296 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17297 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17298 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17299 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17300 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17301 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17302 recipients.
17303
17304 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17305 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17306 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17307 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17308
17309 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17310 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17311 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17312 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17313 values:
17314
17315 .ilist
17316 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17317 .next
17318 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17319 fractional parts are allowed here.
17320 .next
17321 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17322 .next
17323 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17324 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17325 .endlist
17326
17327 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17328 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17329 .code
17330 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17331 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17332 .endd
17333 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17334 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17335 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17336 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17337
17338
17339 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17340 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17341
17342
17343 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17344 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17345
17346
17347 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17348 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17349 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17350 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17351 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17352 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17353 the message is abandoned.
17354 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17355 .code
17356 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17357 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17358 .endd
17359 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17360 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17361
17362 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17363 expanded before use and may depend on
17364 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17365
17366
17367 .oindex "&%-os%&"
17368 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17369 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17370 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17371 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17372 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17373
17374
17375 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17376 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17377 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17378
17379
17380 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17381 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17382 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17383 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17384 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17385 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17386 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17387 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17388 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17389 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17390 .code
17391 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17392 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17393 .endd
17394
17395
17396 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17397 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17398 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17399 the availability thereof is advertised in
17400 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17401 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17402
17403
17404 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17405 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17406 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17407 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17408
17409
17410
17411 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17412 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17413 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17414
17415
17416
17417 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17418 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17419 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17420 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17421 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17422 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17423 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17424 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17425 arrival of the message.
17426
17427 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17428 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17429 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17430 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17431 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17432
17433 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17434 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17435 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17436 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17437 automatically deleted.
17438
17439 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17440 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17441 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17442 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17443 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17444 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17445 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17446 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17447 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17448
17449
17450 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17451 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17452 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17453 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17454 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17455 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17456 &$primary_hostname$&.
17457
17458 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17459 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17460 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17461 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17462 as failures in the configuration file.
17463
17464 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17465 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17466
17467 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17468 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17469 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17470 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17471 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17472 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17473 option.
17474
17475 The following variables will not have useful values:
17476 .code
17477 $max_received_linelength
17478 $body_linecount
17479 $body_zerocount
17480 .endd
17481
17482 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17483 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17484 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17485 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17486
17487 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17488 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17489 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17490
17491 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17492 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17493 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17494 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17495
17496 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17497 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17498 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17499 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17500 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17501 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17502
17503 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17504 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17505 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17506 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17507 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17508 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17509 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17510
17511
17512 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17513 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17514 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17515 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17516 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17517 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17518 domain causes a syntax error.
17519 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17520 syntax checking.
17521
17522
17523 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17524 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17525 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17526 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17527 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17528 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17529 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17530 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17531 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17532 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17533 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17534 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17535
17536
17537 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17538 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17539 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17540 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17541 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17542 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17543 details of Exim's logging.
17544
17545
17546 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17547 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17548 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17549 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17550 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17551 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17552 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17553
17554
17555
17556 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17557 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17558 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17559 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17560 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17561
17562
17563
17564 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17565 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17566 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17567 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17568 details of Exim's logging.
17569
17570
17571 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17572 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17573 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17574 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17575 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17576 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17577 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17578 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17579 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17580 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17581 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17582 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17583
17584
17585 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17586 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17587 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17588 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17589 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17590 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17591
17592
17593 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17594 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17595 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17596 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17597 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17598
17599 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17600 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17601 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17602 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17603 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17604
17605 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17606 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17607 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17608 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17609 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17610 contains the pipe command.
17611
17612
17613 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17614 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17615 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17616 is used in a system filter.
17617
17618
17619 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17620 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17621 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17622 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17623 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17624 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17625 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17626 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17627 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17628 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17629
17630 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17631 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17632 transport option overrides.
17633
17634
17635 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17636 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17637 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17638 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17639 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17640 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17641 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17642 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17643 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17644 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17645 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17646 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17647 TCP_NODELAY.
17648
17649
17650 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17651 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17652 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17653 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17654 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17655 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17656 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17657 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17658 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17659 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17660
17661 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17662 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17663 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17664
17665
17666 .option timezone main string unset
17667 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17668 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17669 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17670 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17671 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17672 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17673 .code
17674 timezone = UTC
17675 .endd
17676 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17677 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17678 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17679 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17680 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17681 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17682
17683
17684 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17685 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17686 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17687 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17688 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17689 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17690 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17691 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17692 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17693 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17694 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17695
17696
17697 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17698 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17699 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17700 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17701 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17702 Commonly only one file is needed.
17703 The server's private key is also
17704 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17705 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17706
17707 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17708 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17709 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17710 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17711
17712 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17713 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17714
17715 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17716 when a list of more than one
17717 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17718 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17719
17720 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17721 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17722 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17723 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17724
17725 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17726 generated for every connection.
17727
17728 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17729 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17730 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17731 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17732 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17733
17734 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17735
17736 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17737 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17738 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17739
17740 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17741
17742
17743 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17744 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17745 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17746 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17747 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17748 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17749
17750 The value must be at least 1024.
17751
17752 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17753 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17754 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17755
17756 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17757 number.
17758
17759 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17760 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17761 larger prime than requested.
17762
17763
17764 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17765 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17766 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17767 to be used by Exim.
17768
17769 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17770 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17771
17772 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17773 for other TLS library versions,
17774 using a filename with site-generated
17775 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17776 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17777 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17778
17779 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17780 then it names a file from which DH
17781 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17782 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17783 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17784 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17785 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17786 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17787
17788 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17789 loaded by Exim.
17790
17791 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17792 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17793 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17794 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17795
17796 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17797 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17798
17799 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17800 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17801 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17802
17803 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17804 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17805 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17806 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17807 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17808
17809 The available standard primes are:
17810 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17811 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17812 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17813 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17814
17815 The available additional primes are:
17816 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17817
17818 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17819 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17820 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17821 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17822 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17823
17824 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17825 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17826 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17827
17828 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17829 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17830 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17831 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17832 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17833 userbase.
17834
17835 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17836 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17837 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17838 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17839 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17840 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17841 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17842
17843
17844 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17845 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17846 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17847 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17848
17849 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17850 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17851 for valid selections.
17852
17853 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17854 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17855 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17856
17857 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17858
17859
17860 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17861 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17862 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17863 This option
17864 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17865 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17866 Certificate Authority.
17867
17868 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17869 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17870
17871 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17872 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17873 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17874 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17875 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17876
17877 The file(s) should be in DER format,
17878 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17879 or for OpenSSL,
17880 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17881 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17882 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17883 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17884 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17885 (this only works under TLS1.3)
17886 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17887
17888 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17889 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17890 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17891 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17892
17893 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17894 .cindex SSMTP
17895 .cindex SMTPS
17896 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17897 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17898 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17899 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17900
17901
17902
17903 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17904 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17905 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17906 files which contains the server's private keys.
17907 If this option is unset, or if
17908 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17909 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17910 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17911
17912 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17913
17914
17915 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17916 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17917 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17918 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17919 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17920 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17921 TLS session.
17922
17923
17924 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17925 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17926 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17927 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17928 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17929 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17930 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17931 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17932 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17933 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17934 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17935
17936
17937 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17938 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17939 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17940 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17941
17942
17943 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17944 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17945 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17946 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17947 word "system"
17948 or the absolute path to
17949 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17950 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17951
17952 The "system" value for the option will use a
17953 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17954 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17955 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17956 must be specified.
17957
17958 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17959 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17960
17961 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17962 explicitly
17963 either by file or directory
17964 are added to those given by the system default location.
17965
17966 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17967 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17968 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17969 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17970 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17971 use the explicit directory version.
17972
17973 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17974
17975 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17976 being unset.
17977
17978
17979 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17980 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17981 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17982 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17983 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17984 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17985 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17986 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17987
17988 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17989 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17990 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17991 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17992 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17993 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17994 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17995
17996 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17997 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17998 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17999 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18000 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18001 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18002 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18003 certificate"&.
18004
18005 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18006 certificates.
18007
18008
18009 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18010 .cindex "trusted groups"
18011 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18012 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18013 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18014 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18015 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18016 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18017 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18018 are trusted.
18019
18020 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18021 .cindex "trusted users"
18022 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18023 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18024 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18025 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18026 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18027 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18028 Exim user are trusted.
18029
18030 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18031 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18032 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18033 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18034 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18035 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18036 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18037 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18038 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18039 &%-F%& option.
18040
18041 .option unknown_username main string unset
18042 See &%unknown_login%&.
18043
18044 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18045 .cindex "trusted users"
18046 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18047 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18048 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18049 .cindex "envelope from"
18050 .cindex "envelope sender"
18051 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18052 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18053 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18054 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18055 is used) is ignored.
18056
18057 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18058 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18059 .code
18060 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18061 .endd
18062 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18063 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18064 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18065 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18066 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18067 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18068 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18069 followed by a hyphen
18070 by a setting like this:
18071 .code
18072 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18073 .endd
18074 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18075 restriction, you can use
18076 .code
18077 untrusted_set_sender = *
18078 .endd
18079 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18080 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18081 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18082 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18083 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18084 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18085 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18086 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18087
18088 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18089 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18090 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18091 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18092 sender address.
18093
18094
18095 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18096 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18097 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18098 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18099 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18100 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18101 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18102 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18103 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18104 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18105 .code
18106 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18107 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18108 .endd
18109 The pattern can be seen by running
18110 .code
18111 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18112 .endd
18113 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18114 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18115 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18116 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18117 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18118 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18119
18120
18121 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18122 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18123
18124
18125 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18126 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18127 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18128 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18129 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18130 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18131 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18132 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18133
18134
18135 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18136 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18137 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18138 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18139 .ecindex IIDconfima
18140 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18141
18142
18143
18144
18145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18147
18148 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18149 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18150 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18151 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18152 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18153
18154 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18155 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18156 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18157 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18158 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18159
18160
18161
18162 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18163 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18164 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18165 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18166 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18167 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18168 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18169
18170 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18171 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18172 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18173 routers, and the eventual transport.
18174
18175 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18176 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18177 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18178 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18179 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18180
18181 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18182 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18183 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18184 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18185 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18186
18187 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18188 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18189 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18190 .code
18191 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18192 .endd
18193 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18194 .code
18195 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18196 .endd
18197 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18198 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18199
18200 See also the &%set%& option below.
18201
18202 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18203 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18204 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18205 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18206 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18207 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18208 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18209
18210
18211
18212 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18213 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
18214 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18215 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18216 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18217 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18218 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18219 routing.
18220
18221
18222
18223 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18224 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18225 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18226 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18227 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18228 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18229 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18230 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18231 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18232 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18233 you could put:
18234 .code
18235 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18236 .endd
18237 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18238 and
18239 .code
18240 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18241 .endd
18242 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18243 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18244 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18245 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18246
18247
18248 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18249 .cindex "case of local parts"
18250 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18251 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18252 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18253 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18254 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18255 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18256 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18257 more details.
18258
18259 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18260 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18261 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18262 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18263 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18264 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18265 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18266 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18267 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18268
18269 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18270 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18271 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18272 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18273
18274
18275
18276 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18277 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18278 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18279 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18280 .vindex "&$home$&"
18281 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18282 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18283 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18284 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18285 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18286 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18287 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18288 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18289 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18290 the router is skipped.
18291
18292 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18293 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18294 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18295 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18296 setting to achieve this. For example:
18297 .code
18298 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18299 .endd
18300 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18301 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18302 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18303
18304
18305
18306 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18307 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18308 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18309 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18310 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18311 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18312 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18313 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18314
18315 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18316 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18317
18318 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18319 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18320
18321 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18322 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18323 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18324 .code
18325 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18326 .endd
18327 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18328 .code
18329 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18330 .endd
18331
18332 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18333 .code
18334 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18335 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18336 condition = foobar
18337 .endd
18338
18339 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18340 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18341 be specified using &%condition%&.
18342
18343 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18344 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18345 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18346 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18347 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18348 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18349 Router rules processing behavior.
18350
18351 This is best illustrated in an example:
18352 .code
18353 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18354 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18355
18356 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18357 true {yes} {no}}
18358
18359 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18360 {yes} {no}}
18361 .endd
18362 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18363 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18364 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18365 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18366 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18367 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18368 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18369 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18370
18371 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18372 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18373 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18374 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18375 string characters.
18376
18377 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18378 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18379 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18380 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18381 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18382
18383
18384 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18385 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18386 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18387 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18388 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18389 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18390 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18391 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18392 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18393 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18394 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18395 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18396 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18397 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18398
18399
18400
18401 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18402 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18403 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18404 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18405 transport option of the same name.
18406
18407 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18408 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18409 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18410 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18411 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18412 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18413 the dnssec request bit set.
18414 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18415
18416 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18417 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18418 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18419 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18420 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18421 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18422 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18423 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18424 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18425
18426
18427 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18428 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18429 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18430 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18431 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18432 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18433 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18434 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18435
18436
18437
18438 .option driver routers string unset
18439 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18440 to be used.
18441
18442
18443 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18444 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18445 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18446 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18447 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18448 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18449 Not effective on redirect routers.
18450
18451
18452
18453 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18454 .cindex "envelope from"
18455 .cindex "envelope sender"
18456 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18457 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18458 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18459 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18460 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18461 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18462 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18463
18464 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18465 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18466 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18467 setting.
18468
18469 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18470 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18471 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18472 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18473
18474 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18475 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18476 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18477 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18478 settings:
18479 .code
18480 errors_to =
18481 errors_to = ""
18482 .endd
18483 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18484 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18485 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18486 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18487 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18488
18489 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18490 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18491 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18492 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18493 setting &%return_path%&.
18494
18495 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18496 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18497 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18498
18499
18500
18501 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18502 .cindex "address" "testing"
18503 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18504 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18505 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18506 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18507 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18508 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18509 on for the system alias file.
18510 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18511 are evaluated.
18512
18513 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18514 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18515 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18516
18517
18518
18519 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18520 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18521 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18522 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18523
18524
18525
18526 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18527 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18528 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18529
18530
18531
18532 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18533 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18534 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18535
18536
18537
18538 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18539 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18540 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18541 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18542 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18543 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18544 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18545 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18546 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18547
18548 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18549 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18550 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18551 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18552 transport for further details.
18553
18554
18555 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18556 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18557 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18558 .cindex "transport" "local"
18559 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18560 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18561 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18562 process.
18563 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18564 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18565 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18566 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18567 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18568
18569
18570
18571 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18572 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18573 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18574 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18575 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18576 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18577 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18578 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18579 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18580 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18581 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18582 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18583 &"see"& the added header lines.
18584
18585 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18586 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18587 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18588 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18589
18590 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18591 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18592
18593 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18594 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18595
18596 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18597 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18598 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18599 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18600 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18601 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18602 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18603 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18604 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18605 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18606
18607
18608
18609 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18610 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18611 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18612 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18613 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18614 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18615 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18616 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18617 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18618 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18619 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18620 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18621 &"see"& the original header lines.
18622
18623 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18624 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18625 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18626 errors.
18627
18628 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18629 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18630
18631 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18632 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18633
18634 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18635 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18636 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18637 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18638
18639 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18640 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18641 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18642
18643
18644
18645 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18646 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18647 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18648 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18649 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18650 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18651 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18652 like
18653 .code
18654 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18655 .endd
18656 by setting
18657 .code
18658 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18659 .endd
18660 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18661 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18662 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18663 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18664 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18665 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18666
18667 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18668 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18669 .code
18670 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18671 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18672 .endd
18673 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18674 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18675
18676 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18677 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18678 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18679 domain that is being routed.
18680
18681 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18682 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18683 checked.
18684
18685 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18686 .cindex "additional groups"
18687 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18688 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18689 .cindex "transport" "local"
18690 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18691 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18692 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18693 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18694 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18695
18696
18697
18698 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18699 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18700 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18701 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18702 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18703 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18704 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18705 evaluated.
18706
18707 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18708 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18709 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18710 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18711 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18712 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18713 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18714 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18715 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18716
18717 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18718 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18719 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18720 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18721 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18722 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18723 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18724 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18725 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18726 the relevant transport.
18727
18728 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18729 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18730 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18731 callout.
18732
18733 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18734 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18735 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18736 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18737 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18738 .code
18739 real_localuser:
18740 driver = accept
18741 local_part_prefix = real-
18742 check_local_user
18743 transport = local_delivery
18744 .endd
18745 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18746 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18747 .code
18748 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18749 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18750 .endd
18751
18752 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18753 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18754 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18755 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18756
18757
18758 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18759 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18760
18761
18762
18763 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18764 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18765 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18766 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18767 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18768 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18769 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18770 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18771 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18772 &%username-foo%&.
18773
18774
18775 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18776 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18777
18778
18779
18780 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18781 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18782 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18783 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18784 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18785 are evaluated, and
18786 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18787 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18788 example:
18789 .code
18790 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18791 .endd
18792 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18793 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18794 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18795 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18796 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18797 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18798 each virtual domain:
18799 .code
18800 postmaster:
18801 driver = redirect
18802 local_parts = postmaster
18803 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18804 .endd
18805
18806
18807 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18808 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18809 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18810 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18811 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18812 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18813 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18814 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18815 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18816 redirect addresses.
18817
18818
18819
18820 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18821 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18822 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18823 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18824 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18825 delivery to be deferred.
18826
18827 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18828 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18829 .oindex "&%self%&"
18830 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18831 means of the setting
18832 .code
18833 self = pass
18834 .endd
18835 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18836 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18837 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18838
18839 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18840 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18841 controls what happens next.
18842
18843
18844 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18845 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18846 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18847 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18848 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18849 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18850 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18851 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18852
18853 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18854 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18855 applies to all of them.
18856
18857
18858
18859 .option pass_router routers string unset
18860 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18861 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18862 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18863 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18864 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18865 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18866 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18867 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18868 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18869 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18870
18871
18872
18873 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18874 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18875 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18876 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18877 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18878 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18879
18880 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18881 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18882 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18883 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18884
18885
18886
18887 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18888 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18889 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18890 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18891 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18892 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18893 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18894
18895 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18896 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18897 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18898 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18899 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18900
18901 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18902 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18903 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18904 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18905 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18906
18907 .cindex "NFS"
18908 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18909 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18910 unavailable.
18911
18912 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18913 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18914 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18915 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18916 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18917 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18918 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18919 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18920
18921 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18922 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18923 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18924 operates as follows:
18925
18926 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18927 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18928 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18929 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18930 used. For example:
18931 .code
18932 require_files = mail:/some/file
18933 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18934 .endd
18935 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18936 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18937
18938 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18939 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18940 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18941 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18942
18943 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18944 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18945 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18946 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18947 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18948
18949 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18950 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18951 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18952 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18953 check again in that process.
18954
18955 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18956 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18957 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18958 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18959 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18960 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18961 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18962 .code
18963 require_files = +/some/file
18964 .endd
18965 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18966 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18967 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18968
18969
18970
18971 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18972 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18973 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18974 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18975 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18976 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18977 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18978 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18979 latter kind.
18980
18981 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18982 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18983 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18984 &%check_local_user%&,
18985 &%local_parts%&,
18986 &%condition%&,
18987 &%local_part_prefix%&,
18988 &%local_part_suffix%&,
18989 &%senders%& or
18990 &%require_files%&
18991 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18992 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18993 same name.
18994
18995 Failing to set this option when it is needed
18996 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18997 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18998
18999 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19000 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19001 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19002
19003
19004
19005 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19006 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19007 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19008 .vindex "&$home$&"
19009 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19010 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19011 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19012 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19013 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19014 cause the router to defer.
19015
19016 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19017 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19018 place.
19019 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19020 are evaluated.)
19021 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19022 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19023
19024 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19025 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19026 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19027 of these values that is set:
19028
19029 .ilist
19030 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19031 .next
19032 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19033 .next
19034 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19035 .next
19036 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19037 .endlist
19038
19039 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19040 router, but not for the transport.
19041
19042
19043
19044 .option self routers string freeze
19045 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19046 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19047 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19048 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19049 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19050 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19051 of remote hosts.
19052 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19053 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19054 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19055 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19056 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19057
19058 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19059 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19060 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19061 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19062 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19063 cases:
19064
19065 .vlist
19066 .vitem &%defer%&
19067 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19068
19069 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19070 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19071 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19072 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19073
19074 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19075 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19076 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19077 rewritten.
19078
19079 .vitem &%pass%&
19080 .oindex "&%more%&"
19081 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19082 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19083 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19084 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19085 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19086 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19087 combination
19088 .code
19089 self = pass
19090 no_more
19091 .endd
19092 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19093 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19094 be passed to the next router.
19095
19096 .vitem &%fail%&
19097 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19098
19099 .vitem &%send%&
19100 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19101 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19102 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19103 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19104 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19105 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19106 .endlist
19107
19108
19109
19110 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19111 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19112 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19113 address matches something on the list.
19114 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19115 are evaluated.
19116
19117 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19118 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19119 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19120 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19121 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19122 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19123 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19124 matters.
19125
19126
19127 .option set routers "string list" unset
19128 .cindex router variables
19129 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19130 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19131 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19132 usual way.
19133
19134 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19135 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19136 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19137 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19138 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19139 the address.
19140 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19141 The variables can be used by the router options
19142 (not including any preconditions)
19143 and by the transport.
19144 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19145 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19146
19147 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19148 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19149
19150
19151 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19152 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19153 .cindex "packet radio"
19154 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19155 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19156 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19157 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19158 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19159 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19160 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19161 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19162
19163 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19164 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19165 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19166 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19167 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19168 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19169 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19170 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19171 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19172 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19173 .code
19174 translate_ip_address = \
19175 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19176 {$value}fail}}
19177 .endd
19178 The file would contain lines like
19179 .code
19180 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19181 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19182 .endd
19183 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19184 are doing.
19185
19186
19187
19188 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19189 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19190 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19191 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19192 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19193 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19194 delivery is deferred.
19195
19196 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19197 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19198 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19199
19200
19201
19202 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19203 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19204 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19205 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19206 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19207 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19208 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19209 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19210 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19211 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19212 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19213 environment.
19214
19215
19216
19217
19218 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19219 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19220 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19221 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19222 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19223 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19224 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19225 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19226 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19227 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19228
19229 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19230 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19231 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19232 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19233 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19234
19235 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19236 environment.
19237
19238
19239
19240
19241 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19242 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19243 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19244 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19245 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19246 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19247 delivery to be deferred.
19248
19249 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19250 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19251 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19252 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19253 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19254 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19255
19256 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19257 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19258 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19259 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19260 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19261 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19262 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19263 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19264
19265 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19266 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19267 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19268 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19269 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19270 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19271 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19272 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19273 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19274 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19275
19276 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19277 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19278 subsequent routers.
19279
19280
19281 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19282 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19283 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19284 .cindex "transport" "local"
19285 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19286 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19287 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19288 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19289 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19290 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19291 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19292 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19293 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19294 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19295 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19296 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19297
19298
19299
19300 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19301 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19302 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19303
19304
19305 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19306 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19307 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
19308 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19309 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19310 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19311 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19312 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19313 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19314 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19315
19316 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19317 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19318 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19319 user or group.
19320
19321
19322 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19323 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19324 addresses,
19325 delivering in cutthrough mode
19326 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19327 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19328 are evaluated.
19329 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19330
19331
19332 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19333 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19334 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19335 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19336 are evaluated.
19337 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19338 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19339 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19340
19341
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19348
19349 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19350 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19351 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19352 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19353 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19354 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19355 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19356 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19357 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19358 .code
19359 localusers:
19360 driver = accept
19361 domains = mydomain.example
19362 check_local_user
19363 transport = local_delivery
19364 .endd
19365 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19366 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19367 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19368 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19369
19370
19371
19372
19373
19374
19375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19377
19378 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19379 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19380 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19381 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19382 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19383 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19384
19385 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19386 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19387 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19388 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19389 records.
19390
19391 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19392 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19393 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19394 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19395 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19396 generic option, the router declines.
19397
19398 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19399 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19400 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19401
19402 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19403 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19404 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19405 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19406 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19407 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19408
19409
19410 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19411 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19412 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19413 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19414 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19415 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19416
19417 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19418 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19419 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19420 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19421 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19422 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19423 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19424 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19425 case routing fails.
19426
19427
19428 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19429 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19430 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19431 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19432 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19433
19434 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19435 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19436
19437 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19438 .ilist
19439 The domain does not exist in DNS
19440 .next
19441 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19442 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19443 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19444 .next
19445 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19446 .next
19447 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19448 .next
19449 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19450 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19451 .next
19452 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19453 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19454 .next
19455 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19456 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19457 .next
19458 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19459 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19460 .endlist
19461
19462
19463
19464
19465 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19466 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19467 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19468
19469 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19470 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19471 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19472 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19473 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19474 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19475 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19476
19477
19478 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19479 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19480 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19481 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19482 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19483 required. For example,
19484 .code
19485 check_srv = smtp
19486 .endd
19487 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19488 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19489 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19490 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19491 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19492 normal way.
19493
19494 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19495 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19496 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19497 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19498 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19499 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19500
19501 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19502 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19503 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19504 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19505 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19506 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19507 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19508 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19509
19510 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19511 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19512
19513
19514
19515
19516 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19517 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19518 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19519 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19520 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19521 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19522 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19523 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19524 also being queued.
19525
19526
19527 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19528 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19529 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19530 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19531 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19532 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19533 only A records are used.
19534
19535 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19536 .cindex IPv4 preference
19537 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19538 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19539 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19540 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19541 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19542
19543 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19544 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19545 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19546 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19547 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19548 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19549 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19550 setting:
19551 .code
19552 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19553 .endd
19554 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19555 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19556 the address record.
19557
19558
19559 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19560 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19561 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19562 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19563
19564
19565
19566
19567 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19568 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19569 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19570 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19571 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19572 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19573 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19574 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19575 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19576 &'resolv.conf'&.
19577
19578
19579
19580 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19581 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19582 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19583 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19584 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19585 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19586 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19587 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19588 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19589 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19590 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19591
19592 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19593 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19594 sense.
19595
19596 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19597 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19598 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19599 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19600 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19601 header rewriting.
19602
19603
19604 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19605 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19606 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19607 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19608 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19609 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19610 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19611 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19612
19613 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19614 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19615 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19616 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19617 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19618 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19619 without processing them independently,
19620 provided the following conditions are met:
19621
19622 .ilist
19623 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19624 &%headers_remove%&.
19625 .next
19626 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19627 the domain.
19628 .endlist
19629
19630
19631
19632
19633 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19634 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19635 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19636 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19637 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19638 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19639 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19640 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19641 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19642 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19643
19644 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19645 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19646 local wildcard.
19647
19648
19649
19650 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19651 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19652 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19653 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19654
19655
19656
19657
19658 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19659 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19660 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19661 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19662 if
19663 .code
19664 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19665 .endd
19666 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19667 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19668 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19669 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19670 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19671 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19672
19673
19674 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19675 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19676 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19677 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19678 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19679
19680 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19681 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19682 such as that implied by
19683 .code
19684 domains = @mx_any
19685 .endd
19686 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19687 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19688 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19689 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19690
19691
19692
19693
19694
19695
19696
19697
19698
19699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19701
19702 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19703 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19704 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19705 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19706 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19707 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19708 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19709 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19710 router handles the address
19711 .code
19712 root@[192.168.1.1]
19713 .endd
19714 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19715 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19716 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19717 .code
19718 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19719 .endd
19720 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19721 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19722
19723 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19724 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19725 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19726 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19727
19728 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19729 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19730 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19731 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19732
19733
19734
19735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19737
19738 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19739 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19740 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19741 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19742 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19743 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19744 must set
19745 .code
19746 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19747 .endd
19748 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19749
19750 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19751 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19752 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19753 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19754 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19755 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19756 must not be specified for it.
19757
19758 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19759 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19760 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19761 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19762 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19763 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19764 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19765
19766
19767 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19768 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19769 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19770 delivery to the address is deferred.
19771
19772
19773 .option port iplookup integer 0
19774 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19775 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19776 call.
19777
19778
19779 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19780 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19781 protocols is to be used.
19782
19783
19784 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19785 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19786 default value is:
19787 .code
19788 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19789 .endd
19790 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19791 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19792
19793
19794 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19795 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19796 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19797 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19798 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19799 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19800 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19801 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19802
19803
19804 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19805 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19806 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19807 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19808 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19809 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19810 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19811 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19812 following could be used:
19813 .code
19814 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19815 reroute = $local_part@$1
19816 .endd
19817
19818 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19819 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19820 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19821 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19822
19823
19824
19825
19826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19828
19829 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19830 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19831 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19832 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19833 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19834 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19835 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19836 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19837 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19838 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19839
19840 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19841 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19842 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19843 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19844 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19845 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19846 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19847
19848 .vindex "&$host$&"
19849 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19850 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19851 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19852 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19853 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19854 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19855 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19856 text string.
19857
19858 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19859 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19860 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19861 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19862 below, following the list of private options.
19863
19864
19865 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19866
19867 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19868 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19869
19870 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19871 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19872
19873 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19874 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19875 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19876 of the following values:
19877 .code
19878 decline
19879 defer
19880 fail
19881 freeze
19882 ignore
19883 pass
19884 .endd
19885 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19886 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19887 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19888 &%pass_router%&),
19889 .oindex "&%more%&"
19890 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19891 router only if &%more%& is true.
19892
19893 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19894 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19895 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19896 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19897
19898 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19899 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19900 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19901
19902
19903 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19904 .cindex "randomized host list"
19905 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19906 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19907 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19908 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19909 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19910 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19911 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19912 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19913
19914 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19915 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19916 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19917 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19918 .code
19919 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19920 .endd
19921 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19922 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19923 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19924 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19925 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19926
19927
19928 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19929 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19930 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19931 example:
19932 .code
19933 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19934 .endd
19935 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19936 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19937 deferred.
19938
19939
19940 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19941 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19942 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19943 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19944
19945
19946 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19947 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19948 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19949 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19950 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19951 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19952 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19953 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19954
19955 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19956 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19957 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19958 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19959 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19960 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19961 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19962 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19963
19964
19965
19966
19967 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19968 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19969 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19970 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19971 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19972 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19973 .display
19974 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19975 .endd
19976 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19977 no options:
19978 .code
19979 route_list = \
19980 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19981 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19982 .endd
19983 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19984 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19985 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19986 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19987 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19988 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19989 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19990 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19991 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19992 in a &%route_list%&).
19993
19994 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19995 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19996 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19997 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19998
19999
20000
20001 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20002 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20003 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20004 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20005 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20006 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20007 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20008 like this:
20009 .code
20010 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20011 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20012 .endd
20013 This data can be accessed by setting
20014 .code
20015 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20016 .endd
20017 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20018 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20019 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20020 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20021 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20022
20023
20024
20025
20026 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20027 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20028 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20029 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20030 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20031 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20032 The format of each item
20033 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20034 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20035
20036 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20037 variables are set during its expansion:
20038
20039 .ilist
20040 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20041 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20042 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20043 .code
20044 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20045 .endd
20046 .next
20047 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20048 .next
20049 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20050
20051 .next
20052 .vindex "&$value$&"
20053 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20054 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20055 .code
20056 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20057 .endd
20058 .endlist
20059
20060 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20061 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20062
20063
20064
20065 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20066 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20067 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20068 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20069 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20070 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20071
20072 .ilist
20073 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20074 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20075 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20076 .code
20077 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20078 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20079 .endd
20080 .next
20081 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20082 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20083 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20084 number follows. For example:
20085 .code
20086 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20087 .endd
20088 .endlist
20089
20090 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20091 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20092 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20093 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20094 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20095 transport.
20096
20097 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20098 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20099 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20100 records in the DNS. For example:
20101 .code
20102 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20103 .endd
20104 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20105 example:
20106 .code
20107 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20108 .endd
20109 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20110 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20111 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20112 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20113 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20114 happens is controlled by the
20115 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20116 &%self%& option of the router.
20117
20118 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20119 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20120 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20121 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20122 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20123 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20124 defined by MX preferences.
20125
20126 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20127 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20128 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20129
20130 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20131 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20132 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20133 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20134
20135 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20136 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20137 router.
20138
20139 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20140 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20141 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20142
20143 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20144 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20145
20146
20147
20148 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20149 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20150 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20151 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20152 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20153 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20154 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20155
20156 .ilist
20157 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20158 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20159 .next
20160 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20161 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20162 .next
20163 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20164 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20165 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20166 .next
20167 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20168 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20169 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20170 .next
20171 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20172 .next
20173 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20174 .endlist
20175
20176 For example:
20177 .code
20178 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20179 domain2 host4:host5
20180 .endd
20181 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20182 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20183 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20184 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20185 call.
20186
20187 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20188 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20189 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20190 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20191 function called.
20192
20193 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20194 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20195 option specified.
20196
20197
20198
20199 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20200 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20201
20202 .vindex "&$host$&"
20203 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20204 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20205
20206
20207
20208 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20209 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20210 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20211
20212 .ilist
20213 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20214 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20215 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20216 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20217 .code
20218 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20219 .endd
20220 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20221 your first router something like this:
20222 .code
20223 smart_route:
20224 driver = manualroute
20225 domains = !+local_domains
20226 transport = remote_smtp
20227 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20228 .endd
20229 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20230 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20231 they are tried in order
20232 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20233 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20234 .code
20235 smart_route:
20236 driver = manualroute
20237 transport = remote_smtp
20238 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20239 .endd
20240 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20241 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20242 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20243 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20244 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20245 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20246 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20247 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20248
20249 .next
20250 .cindex "mail hub example"
20251 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20252 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20253 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20254 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20255 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20256 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20257 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20258 lookup is easier to manage.
20259
20260 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20261 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20262 example:
20263 .code
20264 hub_route:
20265 driver = manualroute
20266 transport = remote_smtp
20267 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20268 .endd
20269 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20270 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20271 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20272 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20273 domain can be used to find the host:
20274 .code
20275 through_firewall:
20276 driver = manualroute
20277 transport = remote_smtp
20278 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20279 .endd
20280 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20281 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20282 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20283 next router.
20284
20285 .next
20286 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20287 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20288 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20289 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20290 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20291 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20292 .code
20293 save_in_file:
20294 driver = manualroute
20295 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20296 route_list = saved.domain.example
20297 .endd
20298 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20299 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20300 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20301 .code
20302 save_in_file:
20303 driver = manualroute
20304 route_list = \
20305 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20306 *.saved.domain2.example \
20307 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20308 batch_pipe
20309 .endd
20310 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20311 .vindex "&$host$&"
20312 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20313 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20314 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20315 the address if the lookup fails.
20316
20317 .next
20318 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20319 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20320 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20321 one way it can be done:
20322 .code
20323 # Transport
20324 uucp:
20325 driver = pipe
20326 user = nobody
20327 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20328 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20329 return_fail_output = true
20330
20331 # Router
20332 uucphost:
20333 transport = uucp
20334 driver = manualroute
20335 route_data = \
20336 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20337 .endd
20338 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20339 .code
20340 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20341 .endd
20342 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20343 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20344 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20345 .endlist
20346 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20347 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20348
20349
20350
20351
20352
20353
20354
20355
20356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20358
20359 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20360 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20361 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20362 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20363 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20364 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20365 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20366 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20367 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20368 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20369 options:
20370 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20371
20372 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20373 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20374 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20375 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20376 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20377
20378
20379 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20380 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20381 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20382 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20383 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20384 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20385
20386
20387 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20388 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20389 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20390 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20391 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20392 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20393 not set, a value for the gid also.
20394
20395 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20396 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20397 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20398 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20399 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20400 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20401 gid.
20402
20403
20404 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20405 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20406 before running the command.
20407
20408
20409 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20410 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20411 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20412 timeout.
20413
20414
20415 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20416 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20417 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20418 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20419 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20420
20421 .ilist
20422 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20423 below).
20424 .next
20425 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20426 &%no_more%& is set.
20427 .next
20428 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20429 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20430 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20431 included in the SMTP response.
20432 .next
20433 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20434 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20435 included in any SMTP response.
20436 .next
20437 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20438 .next
20439 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20440 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20441 .next
20442 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20443 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20444 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20445 .endlist
20446
20447 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20448 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20449 the page):
20450 .code
20451 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20452 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20453 .endd
20454 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20455 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20456 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20457 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20458
20459 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20460 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20461 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20462 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20463 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20464
20465 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20466 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20467 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20468 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20469 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20470
20471 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20472 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20473 variable. For example, this return line
20474 .code
20475 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20476 .endd
20477 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20478 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20479 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20480 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20481
20482
20483
20484
20485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20487
20488 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20489 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20490 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20491 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20492 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20493 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20494 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20495 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20496 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20497 redirected in several different ways:
20498
20499 .ilist
20500 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20501 independently.
20502 .next
20503 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20504 .next
20505 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20506 .next
20507 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20508 .next
20509 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20510 .next
20511 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20512 .next
20513 It can be discarded.
20514 .endlist
20515
20516 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20517 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20518 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20519 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20520
20521 If success DSNs have been requested
20522 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20523 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20524 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20525
20526
20527
20528 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20529 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20530 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20531 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20532 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20533 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20534 .code
20535 system_aliases:
20536 driver = redirect
20537 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20538 .endd
20539 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20540 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20541 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20542 cause delivery to be deferred.
20543
20544 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20545 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20546 .code
20547 userforward:
20548 driver = redirect
20549 check_local_user
20550 file = $home/.forward
20551 no_verify
20552 .endd
20553 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20554 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20555 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20556 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20557 comments.
20558
20559 .new
20560 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20561 directly for redirection,
20562 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20563 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20564 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20565 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20566 .wen
20567
20568
20569
20570 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20571 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20572 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20573 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20574
20575 .ilist
20576 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20577 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20578 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20579 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20580 .next
20581 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20582 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20583 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20584 saves some resources.
20585 .endlist
20586
20587
20588
20589
20590
20591
20592 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20593 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20594 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20595 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20596 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20597
20598 .ilist
20599 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20600 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20601 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20602 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20603 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20604 document is intended for use by end users.
20605 .next
20606 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20607 described in the next section.
20608 .endlist
20609
20610 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20611 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20612 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20613 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20614 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20615
20616
20617
20618 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20619 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20620 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20621 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20622 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20623 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20624 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20625 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20626 commas or newlines.
20627 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20628 quotes.
20629
20630 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20631 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20632 next newline character is ignored.
20633
20634 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20635 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20636 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20637 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20638 removed.
20639
20640 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20641 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20642 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20643 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20644 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20645 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20646 setting:
20647 .code
20648 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20649 .endd
20650
20651
20652 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20653 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20654 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20655 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20656 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20657 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20658 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20659 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20660 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20661 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20662 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20663
20664 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20665 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20666 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20667 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20668 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20669 .code
20670 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20671 .endd
20672 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20673 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20674 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20675 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20676 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20677 synonymously.
20678
20679 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20680 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20681 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20682 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20683 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20684
20685 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20686 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20687 contains:
20688 .code
20689 Sam.Reman: spqr
20690 .endd
20691 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20692 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20693 this forward file:
20694 .code
20695 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20696 .endd
20697 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20698 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20699 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20700 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20701 should really contain
20702 .code
20703 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20704 .endd
20705 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20706 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20707 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20708
20709
20710
20711 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20712 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20713 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20714
20715 .ilist
20716 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20717 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20718 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20719 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20720 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20721 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20722 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20723
20724 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20725 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20726 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20727 in double quotes, for example:
20728 .code
20729 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20730 .endd
20731 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20732 quote just the command. An item such as
20733 .code
20734 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20735 .endd
20736 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20737
20738 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20739 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20740 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20741 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20742 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20743 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20744 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20745 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20746 an &%accept%& router.
20747
20748 .next
20749 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20750 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20751 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20752 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20753 .code
20754 /home/world/minbari
20755 .endd
20756 is treated as a filename, but
20757 .code
20758 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20759 .endd
20760 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20761 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20762 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20763 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20764
20765 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20766 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20767
20768 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20769 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20770 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20771 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20772
20773 .next
20774 .cindex "included address list"
20775 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20776 If an item is of the form
20777 .code
20778 :include:<path name>
20779 .endd
20780 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20781 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20782 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20783 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20784 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20785 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20786 .code
20787 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20788 .endd
20789 It must be given as
20790 .code
20791 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20792 .endd
20793 .next
20794 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20795 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20796 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20797 .cindex "black hole"
20798 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20799 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20800 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20801 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20802 .code
20803 :blackhole:
20804 .endd
20805 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20806 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20807 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20808
20809 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20810 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20811 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20812 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20813 &_/dev/null_&.
20814
20815 .next
20816 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20817 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20818 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20819 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20820 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20821 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20822 redirection items of the form
20823 .code
20824 :defer:
20825 :fail:
20826 .endd
20827 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20828 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20829 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20830 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20831 .code
20832 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20833 .endd
20834 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20835 of a
20836 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20837 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20838 default.
20839 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20840 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20841 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20842
20843 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20844 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20845 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20846 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20847 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20848 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20849 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20850 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20851 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20852 ignored.
20853
20854 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20855 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20856 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20857 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20858
20859 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20860 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20861 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20862 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20863 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20864
20865 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20866 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20867 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20868 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20869 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20870 rules still apply.
20871
20872 .next
20873 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20874 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20875 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20876 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20877 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20878 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20879 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20880 .endlist
20881
20882
20883 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20884 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20885 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20886 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20887 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20888 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20889 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20890 aliasing scheme of the type
20891 .code
20892 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20893 localpart1: pipe
20894 localpart2: pipe
20895 .endd
20896 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20897 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20898 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20899 such as
20900 .code
20901 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20902 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20903 .endd
20904 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20905 the pipes are distinct.
20906
20907
20908
20909 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20910 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20911 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20912 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20913 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20914 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20915 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20916 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20917 can be used to avoid this.
20918
20919
20920 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20921 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20922 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20923 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20924 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20925 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20926 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20927
20928
20929
20930 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20931
20932 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20933 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20934
20935
20936 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20937 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20938 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20939
20940
20941 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20942 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20943 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20944 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20945
20946
20947 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20948 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20949 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20950 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20951 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20952 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20953 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20954
20955 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20956 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20957
20958
20959 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20960 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20961 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20962 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20963 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20964
20965
20966
20967 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20968 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20969 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20970 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20971 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20972 let ordinary users do.
20973
20974
20975
20976 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20977 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20978 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20979 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20980 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20981 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20982
20983 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20984 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20985 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20986 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20987 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20988 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20989 .code
20990 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20991 .endd
20992 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20993 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20994 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20995 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20996 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20997 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20998 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20999 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21000
21001
21002 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21003 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21004 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21005 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21006 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21007 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21008 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21009 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21010
21011
21012
21013 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21014 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21015 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21016 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21017 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21018 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21019
21020
21021 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21022 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21023 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21024 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21025 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21026 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21027
21028 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21029 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21030 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21031 .code
21032 data = #Exim filter\n\
21033 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21034 .endd
21035 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21036 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21037 choice into a newline.
21038
21039
21040 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21041 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21042 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21043 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21044 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21045
21046
21047 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21048 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21049 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21050 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21051 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21052 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21053 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21054 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21055
21056 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21057 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21058 runs a check on the containing directory,
21059 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21060 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21061 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21062 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21063 not, the router declines.
21064
21065
21066 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21067 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21068 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21069 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21070 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21071 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21072 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21073
21074
21075 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21076 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21077 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21078 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21079 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21080
21081
21082 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21083 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21084 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21085 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21086 redirection list.
21087
21088
21089 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21090 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21091 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21092 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21093 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21094
21095
21096
21097
21098 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21099 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21100 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21101 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21102 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21103 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21104 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21105 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21106 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21107 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21108 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21109
21110
21111 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21112 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21113 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21114 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21115 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21116 functions.
21117
21118 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21119 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21120 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21121 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21122 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21123 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21124
21125 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21126 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21127 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21128 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21129 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21130 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21131 &_.forward_& files).
21132
21133
21134 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21135 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21136 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21137 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21138 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21139
21140
21141 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21142 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21143 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21144 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21145 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21146 of the embedded Perl support.
21147
21148
21149 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21150 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21151 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21152 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21153 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21154
21155
21156 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21157 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21158 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21159 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21160 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21161
21162
21163 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21164 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21165 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21166 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21167 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21168 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21169 &%one_time%& is set.
21170
21171
21172 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21173 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21174 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21175 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21176 to make use of &%run%& items.
21177
21178
21179 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21180 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21181 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21182 If this option is true, items of the form
21183 .code
21184 :include:<path name>
21185 .endd
21186 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21187
21188
21189 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21190 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21191 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21192 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21193 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21194 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21195 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21196
21197
21198 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21199 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21200 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21201 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21202 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21203
21204
21205 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21206 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21207 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21208 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21209 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21210
21211
21212
21213
21214 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21215 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21216 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21217 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21218 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21219 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21220 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21221
21222
21223 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21224 .cindex "EACCES"
21225 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21226 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21227 file did not exist.
21228
21229
21230 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21231 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
21232 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21233 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21234 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21235
21236 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21237 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21238 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21239 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21240 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21241 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21242 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21243 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21244
21245
21246
21247 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21248 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21249 redirection list must start with this directory.
21250
21251
21252 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21253 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21254 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21255
21256
21257 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21258 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21259 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21260 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21261 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21262 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21263 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21264 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21265 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21266 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21267 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21268 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21269 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21270 before they subscribed.
21271
21272 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21273 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21274 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21275 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21276 attempt.
21277
21278 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21279 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21280 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21281 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21282
21283 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21284 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21285 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21286
21287 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21288 &%one_time%&.
21289
21290 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21291 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21292 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21293 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21294 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21295 expansion.
21296
21297
21298 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21299 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21300 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21301 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21302 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21303 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21304 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21305 See &%check_owner%& above.
21306
21307
21308 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21309 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21310 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21311 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21312
21313
21314 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21315 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21316 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21317 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21318 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21319 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21320 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21321
21322
21323 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21324 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21325 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21326 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21327 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21328 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21329 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21330 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21331
21332 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21333 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21334 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21335 addresses.
21336
21337 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21338 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21339 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21340 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21341 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21342 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21343 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21344 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21345 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21346 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21347
21348
21349 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21350 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21351 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21352 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21353 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21354 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21355
21356
21357 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21358 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21359 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21360 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21361 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21362 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21363
21364
21365 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21366 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21367 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21368 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21369 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21370
21371
21372 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21373 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21374 :subaddress part of an address.
21375
21376 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21377 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21378 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21379 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21380
21381
21382 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21383 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21384 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21385 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21386 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21387 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21388 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21389
21390
21391
21392 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21393 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21394 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21395 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21396 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21397 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21398 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21399 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21400 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21401 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21402 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21403 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21404 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21405 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21406 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21407 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21408
21409 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21410 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21411 the following routers.
21412
21413 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21414 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21415 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21416 so it is passed to the following routers.
21417
21418 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21419 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21420 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21421 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21422
21423 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21424 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21425 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21426 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21427 .code
21428 userforward:
21429 driver = redirect
21430 allow_filter
21431 check_local_user
21432 file = $home/.forward
21433 file_transport = address_file
21434 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21435 reply_transport = address_reply
21436 no_verify
21437 skip_syntax_errors
21438 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21439 syntax_errors_text = \
21440 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21441 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21442 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21443 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21444 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21445 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21446 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21447 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21448 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21449 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21450 .endd
21451 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21452 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21453 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21454 .code
21455 real_localuser:
21456 driver = accept
21457 check_local_user
21458 local_part_prefix = real-
21459 transport = local_delivery
21460 .endd
21461 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21462 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21463 .code
21464 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21465 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21466 .endd
21467
21468
21469 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21470 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21471
21472
21473 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21474 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21475 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21476 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21477
21478
21479
21480
21481
21482
21483 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21485
21486 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21487 "Environment for local transports"
21488 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21489 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21490 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21491 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21492 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21493 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21494 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21495
21496 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21497 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21498 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21499 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21500
21501 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21502 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21503 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21504 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21505 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21506
21507
21508
21509 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21510 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21511 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21512 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21513 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21514 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21515 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21516 time.
21517
21518 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21519 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21520 .code
21521 my_transport:
21522 driver = pipe
21523 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21524 .endd
21525 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21526 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21527 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21528 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21529
21530
21531
21532
21533 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21534 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21535 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21536 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21537 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21538 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21539 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21540 group (set by the transport). For example:
21541 .code
21542 # Routers ...
21543 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21544 local_users:
21545 driver = accept
21546 check_local_user
21547 transport = group_delivery
21548
21549 # Transports ...
21550 # This transport overrides the group
21551 group_delivery:
21552 driver = appendfile
21553 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21554 group = mail
21555 .endd
21556 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21557 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21558 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21559 set.
21560
21561 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21562 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21563 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21564 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21565 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21566 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21567
21568 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21569 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21570 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21571 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21572 original gid is also used.
21573
21574 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21575 following that is set is used:
21576
21577 .ilist
21578 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21579 .next
21580 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21581 .next
21582 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21583 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21584 .next
21585 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21586 .next
21587 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21588 the uid is the creator's uid;
21589 .next
21590 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21591 .endlist
21592
21593 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21594 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21595 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21596 The first of the following that is set is used:
21597
21598 .ilist
21599 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21600 .next
21601 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21602 .next
21603 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21604 .next
21605 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21606 .next
21607 The Exim uid.
21608 .endlist
21609
21610 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21611 &%never_users%& list.
21612
21613
21614
21615
21616
21617 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21618 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21619 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21620 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21621 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21622 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21623 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21624 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21625 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21626 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21627
21628 .ilist
21629 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21630 .next
21631 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21632 .next
21633 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21634 .next
21635 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21636 .endlist
21637
21638 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21639
21640 .ilist
21641 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21642 .next
21643 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21644 .endlist
21645
21646
21647 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21648 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21649 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21650
21651
21652
21653 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21654 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21655 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21656 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21657 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21658 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21659 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21660 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21661 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21662 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21663 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21664 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21665 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21666 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21667
21668
21669
21670
21671
21672
21673
21674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21676
21677 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21678 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21679 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21680 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21681 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21682
21683
21684 .option body_only transports boolean false
21685 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21686 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21687 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21688 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21689 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21690 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21691 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21692 automatically suppress them.
21693
21694
21695 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21696 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21697 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21698 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21699 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21700 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21701
21702
21703 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21704 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21705 deliveries by the transport or for any
21706 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21707 what you are doing.
21708
21709
21710 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21711 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21712 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21713 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21714 transport is run.
21715 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21716 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21717 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21718 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21719 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21720 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21721 one.
21722 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21723 transport and the router that called it.
21724
21725 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21726 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21727 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21728 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21729 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21730 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21731 safely be resent to other recipients.
21732
21733
21734 .option driver transports string unset
21735 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21736 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21737
21738
21739 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21740 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21741 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21742 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21743 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21744 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21745 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21746 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21747 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21748 resent to other recipients.
21749
21750
21751 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21752 .cindex events
21753 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21754 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21755
21756
21757 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21758 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21759 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21760 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21761 &%user%& (see below).
21762
21763
21764 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21765 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21766 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21767 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21768 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21769 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21770 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21771 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21772 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21773 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21774 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21775
21776 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21777 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21778
21779
21780 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21781 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21782 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21783 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21784 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21785 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21786 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21787 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21788
21789
21790 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21791 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21792 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21793 This option specifies a list of header names,
21794 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21795 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21796 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21797 routers.
21798 Each list item is separately expanded.
21799 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21800 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21801 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21802
21803 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21804 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21805
21806 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21807 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21808 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21809
21810
21811
21812 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21813 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21814 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21815 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21816 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21817 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21818 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21819 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21820 example,
21821 .code
21822 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21823 x@y w@z
21824 .endd
21825 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21826 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21827 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21828 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21829 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21830 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21831 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21832 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21833 change envelope recipients at this time.
21834
21835
21836 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21837 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21838 .vindex "&$home$&"
21839 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21840 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21841 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21842 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21843 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21844 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21845 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21846 deferred.
21847
21848
21849 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21850 .cindex "additional groups"
21851 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21852 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21853 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21854 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21855 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21856
21857
21858 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21859 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21860 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21861 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21862 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21863 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21864 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21865 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21866
21867 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21868 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21869 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21870 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21871 Obviously there is scope for
21872 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21873 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21874
21875 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21876 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21877 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21878 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21879 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21880
21881
21882 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21883 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21884 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21885 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21886 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21887 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21888 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21889 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21890 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21891 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21892 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21893 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21894 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21895 delivered.
21896
21897
21898
21899 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21900 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21901 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21902 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21903 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21904 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21905 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21906 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21907 that contains
21908 .code
21909 local_part_prefix = *-
21910 .endd
21911 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21912 is delivered with
21913 .code
21914 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21915 .endd
21916 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21917 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21918 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21919 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21920 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21921
21922
21923 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21924 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21925 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21926 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21927 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21928 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21929 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21930 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21931 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21932
21933 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21934 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21935 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21936 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21937
21938 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21939 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21940 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21941
21942
21943 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21944 .cindex "envelope sender"
21945 .cindex "envelope from"
21946 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21947 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21948 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21949 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21950 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21951 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21952 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21953 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21954 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21955
21956 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21957 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21958
21959 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21960 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21961 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21962 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21963 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21964 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21965 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21966
21967 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21968 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21969 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21970 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21971 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21972
21973
21974
21975 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21976 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21977 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21978 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21979 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21980 have easy access to it.
21981
21982 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21983 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21984 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21985 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21986 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21987 recipients.
21988
21989
21990 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21991 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21992
21993
21994 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21995 .cindex "shadow transport"
21996 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21997 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21998 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21999
22000 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22001 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22002 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22003 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22004 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22005 cause a log line to be written.
22006
22007 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22008 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22009 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22010 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22011 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22012 of the form
22013 .code
22014 ST=<shadow transport name>
22015 .endd
22016 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22017 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22018 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22019 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22020 headers that some sites insist on.
22021
22022
22023 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22024 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22025 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22026 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22027 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22028 individual users or via a system filter.
22029 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22030
22031 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22032 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22033 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22034 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22035 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22036
22037 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22038 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22039 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22040 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22041 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22042 &(pipe)& transports.
22043
22044 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22045 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22046 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22047 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22048 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22049
22050 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22051 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22052 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22053 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22054
22055 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22056 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22057 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22058 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22059 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22060 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22061
22062 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22063 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22064 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22065 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22066 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22067 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22068 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22069 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22070
22071 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22072 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22073 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22074 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22075 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22076 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22077 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22078 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22079 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22080 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22081
22082 .vindex "&$host$&"
22083 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22084 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22085 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22086 which the message is being sent. For example:
22087 .code
22088 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22089 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22090 .endd
22091
22092 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22093 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22094 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22095 .ilist
22096 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22097 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22098 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22099 example:
22100 .code
22101 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22102 .endd
22103 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22104 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22105 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22106 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22107 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22108 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22109 .next
22110 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22111 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22112 arguments. Consider this example:
22113 .code
22114 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22115 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22116 .endd
22117 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22118 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22119 .code
22120 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22121 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22122 .endd
22123 .endlist
22124
22125 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22126 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22127 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22128 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22129 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22130 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22131 bounced from a transport filter.
22132
22133 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22134 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22135 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22136
22137
22138 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22139 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22140 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22141 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22142 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22143 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22144 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22145 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22146 becomes a temporary error.
22147
22148
22149 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22150 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22151 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22152 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22153 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22154 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22155 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22156 option is not set.
22157
22158 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22159 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22160 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22161
22162 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22163 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22164 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22165 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22166 retry data.
22167 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22168 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22169 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22170
22171
22172
22173
22174
22175
22176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22178
22179 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22180 "Address batching"
22181 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22182 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22183 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22184 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22185 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22186 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22187 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22188
22189 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22190 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22191 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22192 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22193 local transport, for example:
22194
22195 .ilist
22196 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22197 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22198 recipients saves space.
22199 .next
22200 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22201 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22202 .next
22203 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22204 to a scanner program or
22205 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22206 acceptable.
22207 .endlist
22208
22209 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22210 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22211 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22212
22213 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22214 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22215 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22216 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22217 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22218 to certain conditions:
22219
22220 .ilist
22221 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22222 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22223 batching is possible.
22224 .next
22225 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22226 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22227 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22228 .next
22229 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22230 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22231 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22232 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22233 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22234 from taking place.
22235 .next
22236 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22237 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22238 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22239 be the same.
22240 .endlist
22241
22242 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22243 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22244 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22245 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22246 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22247 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22248 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22249 .code
22250 check_string = "."
22251 escape_string = ".."
22252 .endd
22253 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22254 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22255 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22256
22257 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22258 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22259 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22260 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22261 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22262 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22263
22264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22265 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22266 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22267 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22268 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22269 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22270 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22271 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22272 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22273
22274
22275
22276
22277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22279
22280 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22281 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22282 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22283 .cindex "directory creation"
22284 .cindex "creating directories"
22285 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22286 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22287 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22288 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22289 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22290 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22291 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22292 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22293 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22294 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22295
22296 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22297 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22298 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22299 included.
22300
22301 .cindex "quota" "system"
22302 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22303 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22304 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22305
22306 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22307 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22308 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22309 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22310
22311 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22312 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22313 private options.
22314
22315 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22316 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22317 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22318 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22319 option).
22320
22321
22322
22323 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22324 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22325 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22326 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22327 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22328
22329 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22330 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22331 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22332 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22333 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22334 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22335 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22336 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22337 operation. There are two cases:
22338
22339 .ilist
22340 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22341 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22342 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22343 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22344 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22345 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22346 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22347 .next
22348 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22349 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22350 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22351 .endlist
22352
22353
22354 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22355 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22356 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22357 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22358 form:
22359 .code
22360 save folder23
22361 .endd
22362 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22363 .code
22364 require "fileinto";
22365 fileinto "folder23";
22366 .endd
22367 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22368 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22369 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22370 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22371 way of handling this requirement:
22372 .code
22373 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22374 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22375 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22376 {$address_file} \
22377 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22378 }} \
22379 }
22380 .endd
22381 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22382 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22383 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22384
22385 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22386 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22387 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22388 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22389 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22390 path to the transport.
22391
22392 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22393 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22394
22395
22396
22397
22398 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22399 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22400
22401
22402
22403 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22404 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22405 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22406 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22407 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22408 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22409 delivery is deferred.
22410
22411
22412 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22413 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22414 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22415 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22416 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22417 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22418 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22419 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22420
22421
22422 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22423 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22424 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22425 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22426 file.
22427
22428
22429 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22430 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22431
22432
22433 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22434 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22435 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22436 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22437 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22438
22439
22440 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22441 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22442 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22443 process is running.
22444
22445
22446 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22447 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22448 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22449 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22450 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22451 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22452 contains is significant.
22453
22454 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22455 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22456 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22457 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22458 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22459
22460 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22461 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22462 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22463 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22464 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22465 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22466 .code
22467 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22468 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22469 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22470 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22471 .endd
22472 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22473 .cindex "directory creation"
22474 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22475 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22476 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22477
22478 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22479 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22480 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22481 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22482 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22483
22484
22485
22486 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22487 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22488 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22489 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22490 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22491 beneath.
22492
22493 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22494 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22495 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22496 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22497 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22498 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22499 &%file_must_exist%&.
22500
22501
22502 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22503 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22504 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22505 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22506
22507 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22508 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22509 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22510 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22511 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22512
22513
22514 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22515 .cindex "base62"
22516 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22517 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22518 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22519 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22520 .code
22521 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22522 .endd
22523 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22524 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22525 option.
22526
22527
22528 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22529 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22530 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22531
22532
22533 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22534 See &%check_string%& above.
22535
22536
22537 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22538 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22539 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22540 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22541 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22542 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22543 &%file%&.
22544
22545 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22546 .cindex "locking files"
22547 .cindex "lock files"
22548 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22549 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22550
22551 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22552 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22553 examples:
22554 .code
22555 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22556 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22557 file = $home/inbox
22558 .endd
22559 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22560 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22561 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22562 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22563 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22564 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22565
22566
22567
22568 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22569 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22570 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22571 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22572 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22573 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22574 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22575 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22576 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22577 this added to it:
22578 .code
22579 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22580 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22581 .endd
22582 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22583 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22584 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22585 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22586 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22587 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22588 delivery is deferred.
22589
22590
22591 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22592 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22593 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22594 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22595
22596
22597 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22598 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22599 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22600 .cindex "locking files"
22601 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22602 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22603 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22604 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22605 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22606 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22607 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22608 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22609
22610 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22611 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22612 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22613 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22614
22615 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22616 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22617 retries is
22618 .code
22619 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22620 .endd
22621 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22622 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22623 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22624
22625 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22626 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22627 .code
22628 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22629 .endd
22630
22631 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22632 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22633 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22634 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22635
22636
22637 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22638 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22639 for details of locking.
22640
22641
22642 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22643 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22644 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22645
22646
22647 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22648 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22649 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22650
22651
22652 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22653 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22654 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22655 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22656 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22657
22658
22659 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22660 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22661 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22662 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22663 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22664 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22665 external source that maintains the data.
22666
22667
22668 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22669 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22670 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22671 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22672 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22673 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22674 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22675 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22676
22677
22678
22679 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22680 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22681 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22682 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22683 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22684 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22685 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22686 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22687 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22688 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22689
22690
22691 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22692 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22693 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22694 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22695 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22696 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22697 calculation. The default value is:
22698 .code
22699 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22700 .endd
22701 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22702 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22703 &_Trash_&
22704 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22705 .code
22706 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22707 .endd
22708 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22709 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22710 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22711 directly into that directory.
22712
22713
22714 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22715 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22716 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22717
22718
22719 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22720 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22721 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22722
22723
22724 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22725 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22726 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22727 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22728 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22729 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22730 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22731 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22732
22733 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22734 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22735 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22736 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22737 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22738 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22739 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22740 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22741 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22742 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22743
22744
22745 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22746 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22747 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22748 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22749 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22750 below for further details.
22751
22752
22753 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22754 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22755 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22756
22757
22758 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22759 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22760 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22761
22762
22763 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22764 .cindex "locking files"
22765 .cindex "file" "locking"
22766 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22767 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22768 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22769 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22770 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22771 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22772 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22773
22774 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22775 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22776 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22777 combination:
22778 .code
22779 mbx_format = true
22780 message_prefix =
22781 message_suffix =
22782 .endd
22783 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22784 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22785 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22786 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22787 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22788 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22789 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22790 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22791
22792 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22793 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22794 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22795 append messages to it.
22796
22797
22798 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22799 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22800 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22801 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22802 in which case it is:
22803 .code
22804 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22805 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22806 .endd
22807 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22808 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22809
22810 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22811 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22812 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22813 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22814 setting
22815 .code
22816 message_suffix =
22817 .endd
22818 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22819 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22820
22821 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22822 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22823 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22824 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22825 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22826 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22827 value, and this option is ignored.
22828
22829
22830 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22831 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22832 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22833 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22834 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22835
22836
22837 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22838 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22839 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22840 on users about incoming mail.
22841
22842
22843 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22844 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22845 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22846 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22847 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22848 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22849 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22850 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22851 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22852
22853 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22854 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22855 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22856
22857 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22858 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22859 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22860 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22861 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22862 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22863
22864 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22865 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22866 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22867 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22868 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22869 be handled.
22870
22871 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22872 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22873
22874 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22875
22876 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22877 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22878 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22879 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22880 system quota failures.
22881
22882 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22883 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22884 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22885 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22886 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22887 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22888 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22889 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22890 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22891 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22892
22893
22894 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22895 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22896 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22897 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22898 delivery directory.
22899
22900
22901 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22902 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22903 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22904 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22905 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22906 &"no quota"&.
22907
22908 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22909 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22910
22911 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22912 See &%quota%& above.
22913
22914
22915 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22916 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22917 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22918 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22919 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22920 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22921 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22922
22923 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22924 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22925 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22926 the file length to the filename. For example:
22927 .code
22928 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22929 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22930 .endd
22931 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22932 number of lines in the message.
22933
22934 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22935 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22936 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22937
22938 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22939
22940 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22941 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22942 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22943 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22944 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22945 as is used to adjust the effective size.
22946
22947
22948 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22949 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22950 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22951 .code
22952 quota_warn_message = "\
22953 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22954 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22955 This message is automatically created \
22956 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22957 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22958 a warning threshold that is\n\
22959 set by the system administrator.\n"
22960 .endd
22961
22962
22963 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22964 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22965 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22966 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22967 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22968 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22969 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22970 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22971 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22972 sign. For example:
22973 .code
22974 quota = 10M
22975 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22976 .endd
22977 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22978 percent sign is ignored.
22979
22980 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22981 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22982 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22983 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22984 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22985 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22986 .code
22987 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22988 .endd
22989 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22990 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22991 option.
22992
22993 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22994 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22995 percentage.
22996
22997
22998 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22999 .cindex "envelope from"
23000 .cindex "envelope sender"
23001 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23002 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23003 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23004 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23005 for details of batch SMTP.
23006
23007
23008 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23009 .cindex "carriage return"
23010 .cindex "linefeed"
23011 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23012 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23013 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23014 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23015
23016 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23017 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23018 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23019 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23020 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23021 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23022
23023
23024 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23025 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23026 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23027 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23028 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23029 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23030
23031
23032 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23033 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23034 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23035 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23036 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23037
23038 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23039 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23040 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23041 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23042
23043 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23044 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23045 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23046 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23047 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23048 error.
23049
23050 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23051 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23052
23053
23054 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23055 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23056 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23057 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23058 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23059 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23060 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23061
23062 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23063 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23064 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23065 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23066 file corruption.
23067
23068 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23069 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23070 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23071
23072
23073 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23074 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23075 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23076 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23077 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23078 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23079 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23080 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23081 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23082
23083 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23084 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23085 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23086 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23087
23088
23089
23090
23091 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23092 .cindex "appending to a file"
23093 .cindex "file" "appending"
23094 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23095
23096 .ilist
23097 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23098 return is given.
23099
23100 .next
23101 .cindex "directory creation"
23102 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23103 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23104 &%directory_mode%& option.
23105
23106 .next
23107 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23108 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23109 transport.
23110
23111 .next
23112 .cindex "file" "locking"
23113 .cindex "locking files"
23114 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23115 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23116 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23117
23118 .olist
23119 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23120 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23121 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23122 .next
23123 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23124 .next
23125 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23126 Unlink the hitching post name.
23127 .next
23128 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23129 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23130 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23131 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23132 .next
23133 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23134 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23135 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23136 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23137 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23138 it before trying again.
23139 .endlist olist
23140
23141 .next
23142 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23143 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23144 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23145
23146 .next
23147 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23148 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23149 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23150 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23151 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23152 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23153 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23154 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23155 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23156 checked.
23157
23158 .next
23159 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23160 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23161 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23162 delivery is deferred.
23163
23164 .next
23165 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23166 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23167 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23168 permissions.
23169
23170 .next
23171 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23172 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23173 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23174
23175 .next
23176 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23177 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23178 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23179
23180 .next
23181 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23182 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23183 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23184 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23185 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23186 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23187 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23188 that prevents link following.
23189
23190 .next
23191 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23192 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23193 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23194 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23195 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23196
23197 .next
23198 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23199
23200 .next
23201 .cindex "file" "locking"
23202 .cindex "locking files"
23203 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23204 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23205 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23206 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23207 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23208 .code
23209 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23210 .endd
23211 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23212 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23213 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23214
23215 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23216 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23217 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23218
23219 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23220 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23221 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23222 delivery is deferred.
23223
23224 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23225 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23226 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23227 immediately. It retries up to
23228 .code
23229 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23230 .endd
23231 times (rounded up).
23232 .endlist
23233
23234 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23235 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23236
23237
23238 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23239 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23240 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23241 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23242 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23243 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23244 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23245 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23246 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23247 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23248
23249 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23250 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23251 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23252 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23253 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23254 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23255 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23256
23257 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23258 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23259 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23260 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23261
23262
23263 .cindex "maildir format"
23264 .cindex "mailstore format"
23265 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23266 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23267 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23268 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23269 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23270
23271 .cindex "directory creation"
23272 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23273 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23274 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23275 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23276 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23277 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23278 deferred.
23279
23280
23281
23282 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23283 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23284 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23285 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23286 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23287 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23288 &_new_& subdirectory.
23289
23290 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23291 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23292 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23293 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23294 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23295 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23296 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23297
23298 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23299 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23300 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23301 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23302 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23303 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23304 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23305 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23306
23307 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23308 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23309 folders. Consider this example:
23310 .code
23311 maildir_format = true
23312 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23313 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23314 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23315 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23316 .endd
23317 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23318 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23319 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23320 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23321 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23322 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23323
23324 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23325 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23326 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23327 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23328 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23329
23330 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23331 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23332 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23333
23334 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23335 .cindex "maildir++"
23336 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23337 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23338 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23339 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23340 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23341 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23342 amount of space used.
23343
23344 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23345 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23346 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23347 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23348 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23349 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23350
23351
23352
23353
23354 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23355 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23356 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23357 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23358 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23359 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23360
23361
23362 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23363 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23364 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23365 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23366 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23367 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23368 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23369 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23370 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23371 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23372 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23373 backwards compatibility).
23374
23375 For one common implementation, you might set:
23376 .code
23377 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23378 .endd
23379 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23380
23381 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23382 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23383 &[stat()]& each message file.
23384
23385
23386 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23387 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23388 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23389 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23390 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23391 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23392 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23393 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23394 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23395
23396 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23397 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23398 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23399 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23400 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23401 need to know the quota.
23402
23403 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23404 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23405
23406 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23407 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23408 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23409 details.
23410
23411
23412 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23413 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23414 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23415 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23416 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23417 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23418 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23419 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23420
23421 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23422 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23423 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23424 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23425 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23426 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23427
23428 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23429 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23430 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23431 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23432 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23433 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23434
23435 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23436 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23437 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23438 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23439
23440
23441 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23442 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23443 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23444 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23445 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23446 .code
23447 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23448 .endd
23449 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23450 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23451 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23452 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23453 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23454
23455
23456
23457
23458
23459
23460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23462
23463 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23464 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23465 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23466 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23467 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23468 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23469 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23470 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23471
23472 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23473 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23474 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23475 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23476 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23477
23478
23479 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23480 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23481 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23482 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23483 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23484
23485 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23486 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23487 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23488 transport is run as a consequence of a
23489 &%mail%&
23490 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23491 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23492 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23493 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23494 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23495 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23496
23497 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23498 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23499 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23500 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23501
23502 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23503 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23504 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23505 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23506 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23507 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23508 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23509
23510 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23511 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23512 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23513 the transport defers.
23514 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23515 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23516
23517 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23518 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23519 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23520 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23521
23522 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23523 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23524 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23525 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23526 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23527 problems. They are just discarded.
23528
23529
23530
23531 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23532 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23533
23534 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23535 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23536 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23537
23538
23539 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23540 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23541 when the message is specified by the transport.
23542
23543
23544 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23545 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23546 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23547 string comes first.
23548
23549
23550 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23551 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23552 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23553
23554
23555 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23556 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23557 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23558
23559
23560 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23561 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23562 specified by the transport.
23563
23564
23565 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23566 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23567 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23568 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23569
23570
23571 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23572 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23573 the message is specified by the transport.
23574
23575
23576 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23577 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23578 used.
23579
23580
23581 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23582 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23583 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23584 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23585 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23586
23587
23588
23589 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23590 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23591 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23592 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23593
23594 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23595 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23596 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23597 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23598 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23599 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23600 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23601 infinity.
23602
23603 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23604 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23605 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23606 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23607 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23608
23609 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23610 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23611 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23612 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23613 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23614 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23615
23616
23617 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23618 See &%once%& above.
23619
23620
23621 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23622 See &%once%& above.
23623 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23624
23625
23626 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23627 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23628 specified by the transport.
23629
23630
23631 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23632 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23633 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23634 configuration option.
23635
23636
23637 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23638 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23639 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23640 automatic responses. For example:
23641 .code
23642 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23643 .endd
23644 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23645 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23646 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23647 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23648 small.
23649
23650
23651
23652 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23653 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23654 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23655 the text comes first.
23656
23657
23658 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23659 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23660 when the message is specified by the transport.
23661 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23662 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23663
23664
23665
23666
23667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23669
23670 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23671 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23672 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23673 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23674 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23675 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23676 specified command
23677 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23678 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23679 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23680 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23681 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23682 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23683 .code
23684 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23685 .endd
23686 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23687 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23688 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23689 as follows:
23690
23691 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23692 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23693
23694
23695 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23696 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23697 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23698 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23699 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23700
23701
23702 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23703 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23704 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23705 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23706 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23707 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23708 LMTP protocol.
23709
23710 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23711 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23712 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23713 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23714 in its response to the LHLO command.
23715
23716 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23717 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23718 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23719 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23720
23721
23722 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23723 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23724 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23725 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23726 LMTP transport:
23727 .code
23728 lmtp:
23729 driver = lmtp
23730 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23731 batch_max = 20
23732 user = exim
23733 .endd
23734 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23735 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23736
23737
23738
23739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23741
23742 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23743 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23744 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23745 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23746 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23747 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23748 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23749 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23750 following ways:
23751
23752 .ilist
23753 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23754 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23755 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23756 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23757 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23758 .next
23759 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23760 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23761 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23762 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23763 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23764 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23765 that are routed to the transport.
23766 .next
23767 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23768 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23769 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23770 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23771 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23772 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23773 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23774 .endlist
23775
23776
23777 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23778 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23779 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23780
23781 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23782 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23783 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23784 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23785 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23786 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23787 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23788
23789
23790 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23791 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23792 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23793 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23794 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23795 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23796 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23797
23798
23799
23800
23801 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23802 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23803 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23804 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23805 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23806 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23807 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23808 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23809 &"local delivery failed"&.
23810
23811 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23812 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23813 will be sent as normal.
23814
23815 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23816 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23817 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23818 apply in this case.
23819
23820 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23821 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23822 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23823 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23824
23825 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23826 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23827 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23828 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23829 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23830 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23831 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23832 &%temp_errors%&.
23833
23834
23835
23836 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23837 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23838 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23839 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23840 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23841 run.
23842
23843 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23844 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23845 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23846 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23847
23848 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23849 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23850 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23851 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23852 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23853 .code
23854 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23855 .endd
23856 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23857 arguments. You have to write
23858 .code
23859 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23860 .endd
23861 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23862 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23863 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23864 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23865 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23866 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23867 example:
23868 .code
23869 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23870 .endd
23871
23872 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23873 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23874 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23875 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23876 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23877 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23878 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23879 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23880 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23881 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23882 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23883
23884 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23885 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23886 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23887 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23888 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23889 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23890 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23891 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23892
23893 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23894 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23895 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23896 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23897 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23898 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23899 control what is done with it.
23900
23901 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23902 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23903 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23904 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23905 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23906 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23907 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23908 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23909 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23910 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23911 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23912
23913
23914
23915 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23916 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23917 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23918 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23919 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23920 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23921 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23922 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23923 .display
23924 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23925 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23926 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23927 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23928 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23929 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23930 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23931 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23932 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23933 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23934 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23935 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23936 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23937 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23938 &`USER `& see below
23939 .endd
23940 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23941 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23942 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23943 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23944 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23945 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23946 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23947
23948 .cindex "HOST"
23949 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23950 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23951 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23952 the router.
23953
23954 .cindex "HOME"
23955 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23956 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23957 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23958 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23959
23960
23961 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23962 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23963
23964
23965
23966 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23967 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23968 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23969 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23970 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23971 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23972 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23973 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23974 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23975 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23976 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23977 example, if
23978 .code
23979 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23980 .endd
23981 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23982 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23983 &%use_shell%& is set.
23984
23985
23986 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23987 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23988
23989
23990 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23991 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23992 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23993
23994
23995 .option check_string pipe string unset
23996 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23997 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23998 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23999 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24000 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24001 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24002 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24003 ignored.
24004
24005
24006 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24007 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24008 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24009 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24010 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24011 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24012 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24013
24014
24015 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24016 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24017 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24018 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24019 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24020 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24021 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24022
24023
24024 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24025 See &%check_string%& above.
24026
24027
24028 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24029 .cindex "exec failure"
24030 .cindex "failure of exec"
24031 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24032 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24033 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24034 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24035 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24036
24037
24038 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24039 .cindex "signal exit"
24040 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24041 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24042 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24043 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24044
24045
24046 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24047 .cindex "force command"
24048 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24049 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24050 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24051 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24052 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24053 command. For example:
24054 .code
24055 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24056 force_command
24057 .endd
24058
24059 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24060 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24061 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24062
24063
24064 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24065 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24066 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24067 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24068 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24069 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24070
24071 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24072 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24073
24074
24075 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24076 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24077 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24078 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24079 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24080 written to the main log.
24081
24082
24083 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24084 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24085 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24086 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24087 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24088 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24089 be set.
24090
24091
24092 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24093 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24094 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24095 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24096 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24097
24098
24099 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24100 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24101 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24102 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24103 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24104 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24105 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24106 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24107
24108
24109 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24110 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24111 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24112 .code
24113 message_prefix = \
24114 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24115 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24116 .endd
24117 .cindex "Cyrus"
24118 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24119 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24120 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24121 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24122 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24123 setting
24124 .code
24125 message_prefix =
24126 .endd
24127 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24128 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24129
24130
24131 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24132 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24133 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24134 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24135 .code
24136 message_suffix =
24137 .endd
24138 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24139 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24140
24141
24142 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24143 This option is expanded and
24144 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24145 variable of the subprocess.
24146 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24147 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24148 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24149
24150
24151 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24152 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24153 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24154 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24155 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24156 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24157 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24158 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24159 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24160
24161
24162 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24163 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24164 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24165 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24166 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24167 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24168 accept the message is used.
24169
24170
24171 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24172 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24173 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24174 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24175 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24176 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24177
24178
24179 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24180 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24181 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24182 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24183 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24184 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24185 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24186
24187
24188
24189 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24190 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24191 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24192 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24193 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24194 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24195 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24196 of them may be set.
24197
24198
24199
24200 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24201 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24202 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24203 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24204 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24205 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24206 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24207 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24208 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24209 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24210 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24211 and 73, respectively.
24212
24213
24214 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24215 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24216 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24217 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24218 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24219 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24220 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24221
24222 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24223 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24224 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24225 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24226 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24227 delivery to be deferred.
24228
24229 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24230 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24231
24232
24233 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24234 .cindex "envelope sender"
24235 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24236 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24237 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24238 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24239 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24240
24241 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24242 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24243 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24244 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24245 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24246 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24247 class database.
24248
24249
24250 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24251 .cindex "carriage return"
24252 .cindex "linefeed"
24253 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24254 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24255 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24256 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24257
24258 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24259 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24260 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24261 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24262 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24263
24264
24265 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24266 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24267 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24268 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24269 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24270 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24271 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24272 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24273 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24274 its &%-c%& option.
24275
24276
24277
24278 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24279 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24280 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24281 .cindex "external local delivery"
24282 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24283 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24284 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24285 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24286 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24287 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24288 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24289 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24290 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24291 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24292 .code
24293 # transport
24294 procmail_pipe:
24295 driver = pipe
24296 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24297 return_path_add
24298 delivery_date_add
24299 envelope_to_add
24300 check_string = "From "
24301 escape_string = ">From "
24302 umask = 077
24303 user = $local_part
24304 group = mail
24305
24306 # router
24307 procmail:
24308 driver = accept
24309 check_local_user
24310 transport = procmail_pipe
24311 .endd
24312 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24313 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24314 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24315 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24316 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24317 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24318
24319 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24320 .code
24321 IFS=" "
24322 .endd
24323 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24324 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24325
24326 .cindex "Cyrus"
24327 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24328 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24329 .code
24330 # transport
24331 local_delivery_cyrus:
24332 driver = pipe
24333 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24334 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24335 user = cyrus
24336 group = mail
24337 return_output
24338 log_output
24339 message_prefix =
24340 message_suffix =
24341
24342 # router
24343 local_user_cyrus:
24344 driver = accept
24345 check_local_user
24346 local_part_suffix = .*
24347 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24348 .endd
24349 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24350 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24351 sender.
24352 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24353 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24354
24355
24356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24358
24359 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24360 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24361 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24362 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24363 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24364 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24365 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24366 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24367
24368
24369 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24370 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24371 two ways:
24372
24373 .ilist
24374 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24375 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24376 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24377 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24378 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24379 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24380 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24381 .next
24382 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24383 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24384 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24385 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24386 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24387 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24388 process.
24389 .endlist
24390
24391
24392 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24393 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24394 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24395
24396
24397
24398 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24399 .vindex "&$host$&"
24400 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24401 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24402 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24403 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24404 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24405 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24406 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24407 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24408
24409
24410 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24411 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24412 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24413 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24414 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24415 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24416 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24417 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24418 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24419 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24420 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24421 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24422 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24423 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24424
24425 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24426 and will be removed in a future release.
24427
24428
24429 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24430 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24431 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24432
24433
24434 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24435 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24436 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24437 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24438 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24439 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24440 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24441 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24442
24443 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24444 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24445 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24446 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24447 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24448 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24449 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24450 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24451 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24452
24453
24454 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24455 .cindex "Cyrus"
24456 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24457 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24458 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24459 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24460 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24461 ignored.
24462
24463 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24464 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24465 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24466 particular connection.
24467
24468 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24469 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24470 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24471 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24472
24473 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24474 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24475 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24476 .code
24477 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24478 .endd
24479 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24480 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24481
24482 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24483 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24484 value.
24485
24486
24487 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24488 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24489 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24490 authenticated as a client.
24491
24492
24493 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24494 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24495 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24496 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24497
24498
24499 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24500 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24501 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24502 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24503 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24504 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24505 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24506
24507
24508 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24509 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24510 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24511 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24512 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24513 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24514 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24515 option.
24516
24517
24518 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24519 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24520 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24521 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24522 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24523 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24524 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24525 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24526 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24527 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24528 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24529 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24530 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24531 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24532
24533
24534 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24535 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24536 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24537 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24538
24539
24540 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24541 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24542 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24543 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24544 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24545 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24546 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24547 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24548 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24549 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24550 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24551 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24552 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24553 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24554 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24555 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24556 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24557 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24558
24559
24560 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24561 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24562 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24563 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24564 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24565 cutoff times.
24566
24567 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24568 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24569 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24570 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24571 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24572 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24573
24574 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24575 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24576 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24577 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24578 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24579 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24580 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24581 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24582 to them.
24583
24584
24585 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24586 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24587 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24588 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24589 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24590
24591
24592 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24593 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24594 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24595 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24596 details.
24597
24598
24599 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24600 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24601 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24602 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24603 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24604 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24605 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24606 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24607 router option.
24608
24609
24610
24611 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24612 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24613 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24614 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24615 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24616 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24617 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24618 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24619 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24620
24621
24622
24623 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24624 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24625 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24626 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24627 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24628 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24629 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24630
24631 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24632 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24633 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24634 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24635 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24636
24637
24638 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24639 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24640 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24641 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24642 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24643 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24644 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24645 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24646
24647 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24648 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24649 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24650 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24651 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24652 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24653
24654 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24655 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24656 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24657 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24658 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24659
24660 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24661 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24662 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24663 copy of the message is sent.
24664
24665 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24666 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24667 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24668 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24669 fails"& facility.
24670
24671
24672 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24673 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24674 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24675 zero.
24676
24677 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24678 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24679 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24680 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24681 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24682 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24683
24684 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24685 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24686 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24687 implementations of TLS.
24688
24689 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24690 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24691 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24692 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24693 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24694 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24695 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24696 option is:
24697 .code
24698 $primary_hostname
24699 .endd
24700 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24701 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24702 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24703 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24704 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24705 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24706 interface address, you could use this:
24707 .code
24708 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24709 {$primary_hostname}}
24710 .endd
24711 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24712 callouts.
24713
24714 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24715 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24716 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24717 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24718 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24719 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24720
24721 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24722 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24723 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24724 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24725
24726 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24727 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24728 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24729 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24730 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24731 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24732 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24733
24734 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24735 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24736 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24737 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24738 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24739 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24740 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24741 address are used.
24742
24743 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24744 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24745
24746
24747 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24748 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24749 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24750 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24751 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24752 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24753 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24754 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24755 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24756 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24757
24758
24759 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24760 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24761 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24762 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24763
24764 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24765 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24766 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24767 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24768 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24769 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24770
24771 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24772 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24773 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24774 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24775 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24776
24777 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24778
24779 Note:
24780 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24781 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24782 is filled in.
24783 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24784 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24785 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24786 You have been warned.
24787
24788
24789 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24790 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24791 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24792 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24793
24794 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24795 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24796 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24797 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24798 to any host that matches this list.
24799
24800
24801 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24802 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24803 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24804 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24805 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24806 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24807 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24808 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24809
24810
24811 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24812 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24813 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24814 why it exists.
24815
24816
24817
24818 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24819 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24820 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24821 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24822 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24823 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24824 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24825 explanation of when this might be needed.
24826
24827 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24828 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24829 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24830 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24831 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24832 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24833 message on the same session.
24834
24835 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24836 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24837 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24838 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24839 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24840 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24841 logging.
24842
24843
24844
24845 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24846 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24847 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24848 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24849 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24850
24851
24852 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24853 .cindex "randomized host list"
24854 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24855 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24856 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24857 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24858 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24859 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24860 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24861 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24862
24863 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24864 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24865 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24866 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24867 .code
24868 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24869 .endd
24870 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24871 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24872 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24873
24874 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24875 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24876 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24877 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24878 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24879 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24880 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24881 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24882 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24883
24884
24885 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24886 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24887 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24888 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24889 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24890
24891 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24892 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24893 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24894 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24895 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24896 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24897 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24898 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24899 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24900
24901 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24902 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24903 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24904 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24905 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24906
24907 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24908 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24909 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24910 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24911 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24912 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24913
24914 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24915 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24916 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24917 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24918 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24919 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24920 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24921
24922 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24923 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24924 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24925 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24926 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24927 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24928 .new
24929 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
24930 .wen
24931 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24932
24933 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24934 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24935 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24936 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24937 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24938 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24939 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24940 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24941 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24942
24943 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24944 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24945 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24946 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24947 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24948 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24949 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24950 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24951 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24952 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24953
24954 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24955 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24956
24957 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24958 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24959 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24960 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24961 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24962
24963 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24964 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24965 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24966 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24967 for multi-recipient messages.
24968 The option can usually be left as default.
24969
24970 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24971 .cindex "bind IP address"
24972 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24973 .vindex "&$host$&"
24974 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24975 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24976 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24977 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24978 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24979 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24980 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24981 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24982 unknown.
24983
24984 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24985 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24986 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24987 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24988 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24989 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24990 For example:
24991 .code
24992 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24993 .endd
24994 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24995 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24996 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24997 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24998
24999
25000 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25001 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25002 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25003 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25004 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25005 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25006 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25007 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25008 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25009 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25010 unreachable hosts.
25011
25012
25013 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25014 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25015 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25016 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25017 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25018
25019 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25020 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25021 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25022 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25023 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25024 permits this.
25025
25026
25027 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25028 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25029 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25030 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25031 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25032 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25033 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25034 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25035
25036 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25037 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25038 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25039
25040 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25041 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25042 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25043 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25044 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25045 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25046 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25047 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25048
25049 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25050 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25051 normally &"smtp"&,
25052 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25053 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25054 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25055 is deferred.
25056
25057 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25058 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25059
25060
25061
25062 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25063 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25064 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25065 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25066 .vindex "&$port$&"
25067 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25068 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25069 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25070 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25071 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25072
25073 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25074 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25075 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25076 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25077 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25078 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25079
25080
25081 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25082 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25083 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25084 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25085 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25086 addresses is not affected.
25087
25088 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25089 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25090 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25091 Exim to use only the host name.
25092 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25093
25094
25095 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25096 .cindex "serializing connections"
25097 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25098 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25099 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25100 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25101 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25102 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25103 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25104
25105 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25106 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25107 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25108 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25109 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25110 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25111
25112 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25113 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25114 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25115 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25116 are used for ETRN serialization.
25117
25118 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25119
25120
25121 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25122 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25123 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25124 .cindex "size" "of message"
25125 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25126 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25127 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25128 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25129 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25130 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25131 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25132 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25133
25134 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25135 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25136
25137
25138 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25139 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25140 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25141 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25142
25143
25144 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25145 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25146 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25147 .vindex "&$host$&"
25148 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25149 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25150 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25151 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25152 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25153 details of TLS.
25154
25155 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25156 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25157 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25158 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25159 client.
25160
25161
25162 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25163 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25164 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25165 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25166 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25167
25168
25169 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25170 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25171 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25172 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25173 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25174 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25175 will fail.
25176
25177 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25178
25179
25180 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25181 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25182 .vindex "&$host$&"
25183 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25184 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25185 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25186 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25187 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25188 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25189 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25190 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25191
25192
25193 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25194 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25195 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25196 .vindex "&$host$&"
25197 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25198 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25199 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25200 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25201 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25202 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25203 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25204 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25205 ciphers is a preference order.
25206
25207
25208
25209 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25210 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25211 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25212 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25213 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25214 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25215 certificate and private key for the session.
25216
25217 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25218
25219 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25220 TLS extensions.
25221
25222
25223
25224
25225 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25226 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25227 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25228 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25229 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25230 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25231 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25232 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25233 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25234 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25235 in clear.
25236
25237
25238 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25239 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25240 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25241 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25242 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25243 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25244 Note that unless the host is in this list
25245 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25246 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25247 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25248 certificate verification succeeds.
25249
25250
25251 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25252 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25253 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25254 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25255 while verifying the server certificate,
25256 checks will be included on the host name
25257 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25258 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25259 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25260
25261 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25262
25263
25264 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25265 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25266 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25267 .vindex "&$host$&"
25268 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25269 The value of this option must be either the
25270 word "system"
25271 or the absolute path to
25272 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25273 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25274
25275 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25276 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25277 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25278 must be specified.
25279
25280 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25281 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25282
25283 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25284 explicitly
25285 either by file or directory
25286 are added to those given by the system default location.
25287
25288 The values of &$host$& and
25289 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25290 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25291
25292 For back-compatibility,
25293 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25294 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25295 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25296
25297
25298 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25299 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25300 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25301 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25302 certificate verification must succeed.
25303 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25304 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25305 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25306
25307 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25308 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25309 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25310 If built with internationalization support,
25311 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25312 to a-label form.
25313 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25314
25315
25316
25317
25318 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25319 "SECTvalhosmax"
25320 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25321 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25322 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25323 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25324 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25325
25326
25327 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25328 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25329 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25330 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25331 retrying.
25332
25333 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25334 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25335 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25336
25337 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25338 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25339 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25340 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25341 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25342
25343 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25344 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25345 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25346 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25347 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25348 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25349 see below for an exception).
25350
25351 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25352 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25353 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25354 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25355 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25356
25357 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25358 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25359 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25360 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25361 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25362 reached their retry times.
25363
25364 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25365 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25366 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25367 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25368 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25369 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25370 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25371 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25372 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25373 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25374 reached.
25375
25376 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25377 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25378 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25379 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25380 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25381 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25382
25383 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25384 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25385 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25386 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25387 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25388 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25389
25390
25391
25392
25393
25394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25396
25397 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25398 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25399 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25400 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25401 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25402 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25403
25404 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25405 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25406 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25407 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25408 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25409 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25410 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25411
25412 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25413 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25414 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25415 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25416
25417
25418 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25419 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25420 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25421 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25422
25423 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25424 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25425 facility; you do not have to use it.
25426
25427 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25428 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25429 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25430 address to which it applies.
25431
25432 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25433 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25434 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25435 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25436 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25437 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25438 rules.
25439
25440 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25441 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25442 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25443 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25444
25445
25446 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25447 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25448 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25449 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25450 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25451 discouraged.
25452
25453 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25454 illustrated by these examples:
25455
25456 .ilist
25457 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25458 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25459 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25460 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25461 .next
25462 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25463 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25464 .endlist
25465
25466
25467
25468 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25469 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25470 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25471 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25472 message's processing.
25473
25474 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25475 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25476 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25477 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25478 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25479 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25480 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25481 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25482 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25483
25484 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25485 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25486 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25487 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25488 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25489 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25490 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25491 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25492 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25493 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25494
25495 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25496 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25497 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25498 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25499 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25500 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25501
25502 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25503 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25504 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25505
25506 .cindex "envelope from"
25507 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25508 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25509 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25510 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25511 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25512 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25513 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25514 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25515 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25516
25517 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25518 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25519 transport time.
25520
25521
25522
25523
25524 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25525 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25526 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25527 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25528 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25529 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25530 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25531 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25532 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25533 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25534 .code
25535 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25536 .endd
25537 might produce the output
25538 .code
25539 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25540 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25541 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25542 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25543 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25544 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25545 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25546 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25547 .endd
25548 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25549 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25550 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25551 set for a particular transport.
25552
25553
25554 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25555 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25556 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25557 rules in the form
25558 .display
25559 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25560 .endd
25561 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25562 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25563 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25564 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25565
25566 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25567 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25568 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25569 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25570 ignored.
25571
25572 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25573 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25574 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25575
25576 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25577 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25578 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25579 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25580 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25581 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25582 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25583
25584 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25585 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25586 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25587 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25588 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25589 .code
25590 *@* ${lookup ...
25591 .endd
25592 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25593 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25594
25595
25596 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25597 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25598 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25599 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25600 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25601 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25602 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25603 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25604 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25605
25606 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25607 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25608 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25609
25610 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25611 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25612 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25613 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25614 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25615 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25616 of pattern they are set as follows:
25617
25618 .ilist
25619 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25620 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25621 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25622 pattern
25623 .code
25624 *queen@*.fict.example
25625 .endd
25626 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25627 .code
25628 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25629 $1 = hearts-
25630 $2 = wonderland
25631 .endd
25632 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25633 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25634
25635 .next
25636 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25637 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25638 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25639 rewriting rule of the form
25640 .display
25641 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25642 .endd
25643 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25644 .code
25645 $1 = foo
25646 $2 = bar
25647 $3 = baz.example
25648 .endd
25649 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25650 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25651 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25652 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25653 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25654 .endlist
25655
25656
25657 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25658 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25659 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25660 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25661 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25662 .code
25663 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25664 .endd
25665 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25666 &'From:'& headers.
25667
25668 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25669 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25670 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25671 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25672 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25673 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25674 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25675 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25676 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25677 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25678 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25679 entry written to the panic log.
25680
25681
25682
25683 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25684 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25685
25686 .ilist
25687 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25688 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25689 .next
25690 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25691 .next
25692 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25693 .endlist
25694
25695 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25696 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25697
25698
25699
25700 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25701 "SECID154"
25702 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25703 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25704 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25705 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25706 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25707 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25708 .display
25709 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25710 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25711 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25712 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25713 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25714 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25715 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25716 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25717 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25718 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25719 .endd
25720 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25721 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25722 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25723
25724 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25725 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25726
25727
25728 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25729 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25730 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25731 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25732 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25733 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25734 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25735 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25736 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25737
25738 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25739 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25740 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25741 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25742 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25743 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25744 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25745 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25746
25747
25748 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25749 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25750 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25751 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25752
25753 .ilist
25754 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25755 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25756 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25757 .next
25758 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25759 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25760 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25761 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25762 .next
25763 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25764 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25765 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25766 .next
25767 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25768 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25769 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25770 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25771 .code
25772 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25773 .endd
25774 into
25775 .code
25776 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25777 .endd
25778 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25779 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25780 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25781 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25782 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25783 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25784 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25785 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25786 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25787
25788 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25789 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25790 .endlist
25791
25792
25793 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25794 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25795 .code
25796 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25797 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25798 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25799 .endd
25800 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25801 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25802 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25803 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25804 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25805 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25806 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25807 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25808
25809 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25810 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25811 .code
25812 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25813 .endd
25814 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25815 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25816
25817 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25818 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25819 messages that originate outside the local host:
25820 .code
25821 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25822 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25823 .endd
25824 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25825 space.
25826
25827 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25828 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25829 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25830 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25831 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25832 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25833 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25834 components. For example, the rule
25835 .code
25836 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25837 .endd
25838 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25839 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25840 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25841 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25842 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25843 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25844 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25845 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25846
25847
25848
25849
25850
25851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25853
25854 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25855 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25856 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25857 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25858 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25859 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25860 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25861 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25862 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25863 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25864 address, domain and error.
25865
25866 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25867 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25868 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25869 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25870 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25871 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25872 log selector is set, the message
25873 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25874 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25875 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25876 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25877
25878 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25879 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25880 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25881 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25882 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25883 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25884 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25885 domain are maintained independently.
25886
25887 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25888 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25889 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25890 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25891 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25892 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25893 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25894 the local address is reached.
25895
25896 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25897 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25898 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25899 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25900 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25901
25902 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25903 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25904 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25905 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25906 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25907 messages that it should now be retaining.
25908
25909
25910
25911 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25912 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25913 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25914 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25915 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25916 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25917 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25918 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25919 message's sender, respectively.
25920
25921
25922 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25923 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25924 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25925 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25926 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25927 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25928 example,
25929 .code
25930 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25931 .endd
25932 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25933 whereas
25934 .code
25935 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25936 .endd
25937 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25938 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25939 part.
25940
25941 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25942 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25943 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25944 expressions work in address lists.
25945 .display
25946 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25947 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25948 .endd
25949
25950
25951 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25952 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25953 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25954 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25955 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25956 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25957 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25958 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25959 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25960
25961 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25962 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25963 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25964 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25965 local transports).
25966
25967 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25968 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25969 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25970 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25971 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25972 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25973 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25974 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25975 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25976 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25977 commands.
25978
25979
25980
25981 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25982 "SECID160"
25983 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25984 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25985 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25986 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25987 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25988 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25989 .code
25990 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25991 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25992 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25993 .endd
25994 and the retry rules are
25995 .code
25996 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25997 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25998 .endd
25999 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26000 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26001 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26002 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26003 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26004 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26005
26006 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26007 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26008 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26009 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26010
26011 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26012 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26013 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26014 .code
26015 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26016 .endd
26017 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26018 textual form of the IP address.
26019
26020 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26021 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26022 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26023 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26024
26025 .vlist
26026 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26027 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26028 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26029
26030 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26031 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26032 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26033
26034 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26035 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26036
26037 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26038 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26039 .endlist
26040
26041 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26042 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26043 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26044 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26045 retry rule of this form:
26046 .code
26047 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26048 .endd
26049 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26050 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26051
26052 .vlist
26053 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26054 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26055 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26056 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26057
26058 .vitem &%lookup%&
26059 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26060 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26061 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26062 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26063 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26064
26065 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26066 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26067
26068 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26069 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26070
26071 .vitem &%refused%&
26072 A connection was refused.
26073
26074 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26075 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26076
26077 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26078 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26079
26080 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26081 A connection attempt timed out.
26082
26083 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26084 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26085 obtained from an MX record.
26086
26087 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26088 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26089 obtained from an MX record.
26090
26091 .vitem &%timeout%&
26092 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26093
26094 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26095 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26096 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26097 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26098
26099 .vitem &%quota%&
26100 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26101 transport.
26102
26103 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26104 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26105 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26106 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26107 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26108 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26109 for four days.
26110 .endlist
26111
26112 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26113 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26114 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26115 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26116 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26117 heuristic rules:
26118
26119 .ilist
26120 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26121 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26122 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26123 .next
26124 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26125 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26126 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26127 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26128 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26129 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26130 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26131 .next
26132 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26133 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26134 .endlist
26135
26136 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26137 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26138 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26139 error).
26140
26141
26142
26143 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26144 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26145 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26146 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26147 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26148 form:
26149 .display
26150 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26151 .endd
26152 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26153 .code
26154 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26155 .endd
26156 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26157 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26158 For example:
26159 .code
26160 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26161 .endd
26162 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26163 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26164 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26165 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26166 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26167
26168 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26169 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26170 .code
26171 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26172 .endd
26173 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26174 list is never matched.
26175
26176
26177
26178
26179
26180 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26181 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26182 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26183 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26184 .display
26185 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26186 .endd
26187 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26188 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26189 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26190 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26191 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26192
26193 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26194 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26195 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26196 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26197 The available algorithms are:
26198
26199 .ilist
26200 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26201 the interval.
26202 .next
26203 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26204 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26205 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26206 .next
26207 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26208 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26209 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26210 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26211 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26212 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26213 queue processing times.
26214 .endlist
26215
26216 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26217 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26218 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26219 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26220 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26221 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26222 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26223 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26224 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26225 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26226 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26227 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26228
26229 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26230 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26231 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26232 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26233 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26234 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26235 time.
26236
26237 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26238 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26239 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26240 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26241 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26242 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26243 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26244 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26245 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26246 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26247 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26248 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26249
26250 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26251 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26252 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26253 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26254 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26255 deliveries that have been deferred.
26256
26257
26258 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26259 Here are some example retry rules:
26260 .code
26261 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26262 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26263 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26264 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26265 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26266 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26267 .endd
26268 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26269 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26270 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26271 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26272 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26273 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26274 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26275 days.
26276
26277 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26278 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26279 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26280 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26281 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26282
26283 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26284 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26285 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26286 were not obtained from an MX record.
26287
26288 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26289 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26290 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26291 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26292 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26293
26294
26295
26296 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26297 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26298 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26299 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26300 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26301 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26302 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26303 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26304 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26305 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26306 failing for the first time.
26307
26308 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26309 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26310 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26311 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26312
26313 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26314 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26315 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26316
26317
26318
26319
26320 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26321 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26322 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26323 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26324 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26325 default retry rule:
26326 .code
26327 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26328 .endd
26329 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26330 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26331 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26332
26333 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26334 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26335 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26336 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26337 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26338
26339 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26340 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26341 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26342
26343 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26344 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26345 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26346 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26347 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26348 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26349 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26350 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26351 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26352 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26353 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26354
26355 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26356 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26357 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26358 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26359 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26360 notice.
26361
26362 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26363 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26364 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26365 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26366 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26367 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26368 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26369 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26370 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26371 true.
26372
26373 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26374 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26375 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26376 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26377 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26378 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26379 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26380 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26381 reached.
26382
26383 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26384 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26385 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26386 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26387 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26388 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26389 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26390 time out the address.
26391
26392 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26393 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26394 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26395 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26396 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26397 considered immediately.
26398 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26399 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26400
26401
26402
26403
26404
26405
26406 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26408
26409 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26410 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26411 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26412 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26413 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26414 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26415 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26416 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26417 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26418 other.
26419
26420 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26421 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26422
26423 .ilist
26424 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26425 the client's EHLO command.
26426 .next
26427 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26428 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26429 .next
26430 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26431 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26432 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26433 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26434 with the AUTH command.
26435 .next
26436 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26437 .next
26438 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26439 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26440 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26441 connection.
26442 .next
26443 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26444 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26445 unauthenticated connection.
26446 .endlist
26447
26448 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26449 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26450 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26451 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26452 .display
26453 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26454 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26455 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26456 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26457 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26458 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26459 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26460 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26461 &`250-PIPELINING`&
26462 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26463 &`250 HELP`&
26464 .endd
26465 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26466 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26467 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26468 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26469 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26470 included by setting
26471 .code
26472 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26473 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26474 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26475 AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26476 AUTH_GSASL=yes
26477 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26478 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26479 AUTH_SPA=yes
26480 AUTH_TLS=yes
26481 .endd
26482 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26483 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26484 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26485 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26486 work via a socket interface.
26487 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26488 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26489 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26490 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26491 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26492 supporting setting a server keytab.
26493 The seventh can be configured to support
26494 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26495 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26496 The eighth authenticator
26497 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26498 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26499 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26500
26501 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26502 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26503 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26504 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26505 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26506 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26507 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26508
26509 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26510 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26511 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26512 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26513 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26514 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26515 .code
26516 cram:
26517 driver = cram_md5
26518 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26519 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26520 client_name = ph10
26521 client_secret = secret2
26522 .endd
26523 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26524 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26525
26526 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26527 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26528 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26529 in Exim.
26530
26531 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26532 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26533 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26534 authenticating data.
26535
26536 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26537 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26538 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26539 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26540 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26541 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26542 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26543 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26544 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26545 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26546 choose to honour.
26547
26548 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26549 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26550 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26551 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26552
26553
26554
26555 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26556 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26557 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26558
26559 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26560 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26561 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26562 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26563 encrypted by a setting such as:
26564 .code
26565 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26566 .endd
26567
26568
26569 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26570 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26571 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26572 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26573
26574
26575 .option driver authenticators string unset
26576 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26577 authenticators is to be used.
26578
26579
26580 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26581 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26582 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26583 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26584 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26585 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26586
26587
26588 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26589 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26590 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26591 mechanism is not advertised.
26592 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26593 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26594 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26595
26596
26597 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26598 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26599 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26600 for details.
26601
26602 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26603 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26604
26605 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26606 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26607 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26608 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26609 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26610 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26611 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26612 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26613 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26614 the error text.
26615
26616
26617 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26618 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26619 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26620 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26621 out the values of variables.
26622 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26623 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26624
26625
26626 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26627 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26628 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26629 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26630 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26631 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26632 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26633 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26634 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26635 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26636 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26637 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26638
26639
26640 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26641 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26642 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26643 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26644 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26645 remembered for later use.
26646 How it is used is described in the following section.
26647
26648
26649
26650
26651
26652 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26653 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26654 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26655 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26656 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26657 message:
26658
26659 .ilist
26660 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26661 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26662 .next
26663 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26664 .next
26665 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26666 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26667 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26668 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26669 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26670 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26671 given for the MAIL command.
26672 .next
26673 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26674 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26675 authenticated.
26676 .next
26677 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26678 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26679 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26680 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26681 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26682 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26683 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26684 message.
26685 .endlist
26686
26687
26688 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26689 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26690 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26691 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26692
26693 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26694 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26695 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26696 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26697 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26698 ACL is run.
26699
26700
26701
26702 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26703 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26704 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26705 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26706 conditions:
26707
26708 .ilist
26709 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26710 .next
26711 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26712 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26713 .endlist
26714
26715 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26716 the mechanisms are advertised.
26717
26718 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26719 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26720 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26721 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26722 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26723 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26724 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26725 .code
26726 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26727 .endd
26728 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26729
26730 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26731 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26732 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26733 such as:
26734 .code
26735 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26736 .endd
26737 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26738 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26739 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26740
26741 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26742 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26743 command. This is the case if
26744
26745 .ilist
26746 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26747 .next
26748 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26749 .next
26750 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26751 server authenticators.
26752 .endlist
26753
26754
26755 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26756 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26757 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26758
26759 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26760 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26761 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26762 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26763 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26764 rejected with a 504 error.
26765
26766 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26767 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26768 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26769 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26770 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26771 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26772 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26773 no successful authentication.
26774
26775 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26776 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26777 &%authresults%& expansion item.
26778
26779
26780
26781
26782 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26783 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26784 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26785 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26786 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26787 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26788 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26789 script:
26790 .code
26791 use MIME::Base64;
26792 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26793 .endd
26794 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26795 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26796 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26797 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26798 command line to run this script on such data might be
26799 .code
26800 encode '\0user\0password'
26801 .endd
26802 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26803 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26804 whose code value is zero.
26805
26806 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26807 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26808 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26809 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26810
26811 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26812 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26813 example, a command such as
26814 .code
26815 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26816 .endd
26817 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26818
26819 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26820 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26821 .code
26822 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26823 .endd
26824 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26825 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26826 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26827 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26828
26829
26830
26831 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26832 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26833 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26834 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26835 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26836 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26837
26838 .ilist
26839 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26840 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26841 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26842 of the authenticator.
26843 .next
26844 .vindex "&$host$&"
26845 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26846 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26847 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26848 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26849 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26850 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26851 delivery to be deferred.
26852 .next
26853 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26854 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26855 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26856 usual way.
26857 .next
26858 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26859 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26860 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26861 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26862 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26863 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26864 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26865 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26866 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26867 .endlist
26868
26869 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26870 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26871 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26872 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26873 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26874 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26875 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26876 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26877
26878 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26879
26880 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26881 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26882 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26883 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26884 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26885 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26886 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26887 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26888 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26889 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26890 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26891 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26892 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26893
26894
26895
26896
26897
26898
26899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26901
26902 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26903 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26904 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26905 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26906 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26907 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26908 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26909 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26910 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26911 connections as you do for login accounts.
26912
26913 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
26914 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
26915 TLS is not being used:
26916 .code
26917 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
26918 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
26919 .endd
26920
26921 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
26922 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
26923 (including their names) have been properly verified.
26924
26925 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
26926 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26927 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26928
26929 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26930 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26931 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26932
26933 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
26934 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26935 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26936 given.
26937
26938 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26939 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26940 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26941 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26942 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26943 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26944 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26945
26946 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26947 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26948 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26949 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26950 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26951 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26952 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26953
26954 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26955 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26956 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26957 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26958
26959 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26960 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26961 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26962
26963 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26964 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26965 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26966 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26967 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26968 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26969 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26970 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26971 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26972 string as the error text.
26973
26974 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26975 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26976 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26977
26978
26979
26980 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26981 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26982 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26983 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26984 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26985 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26986 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26987 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26988
26989 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26990 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26991 configured as follows:
26992 .code
26993 fixed_plain:
26994 driver = plaintext
26995 public_name = PLAIN
26996 server_prompts = :
26997 server_condition = \
26998 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26999 server_set_id = $auth2
27000 .endd
27001 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27002 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27003 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27004 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27005
27006 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27007 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27008 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27009 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27010 .code
27011 250-AUTH PLAIN
27012 .endd
27013 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27014 .code
27015 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27016 .endd
27017 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27018 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27019 .code
27020 AUTH PLAIN
27021 .endd
27022 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27023 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27024
27025 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27026 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27027 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27028 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27029 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27030
27031 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27032 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27033 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27034
27035 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27036 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27037 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27038 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27039 This is an incorrect example:
27040 .code
27041 server_condition = \
27042 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27043 .endd
27044 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27045 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27046 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27047 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27048 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27049 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27050 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27051 .code
27052 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27053 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27054 .endd
27055 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27056 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27057 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27058 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27059 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27060
27061
27062 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27063 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27064 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27065 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27066 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27067 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27068 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27069 .code
27070 fixed_login:
27071 driver = plaintext
27072 public_name = LOGIN
27073 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27074 server_condition = \
27075 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27076 server_set_id = $auth1
27077 .endd
27078 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27079 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27080 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27081 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27082
27083 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27084 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27085 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27086 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27087 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27088 .code
27089 login:
27090 driver = plaintext
27091 public_name = LOGIN
27092 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27093 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27094 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27095 ldapauth{\
27096 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27097 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27098 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27099 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27100 .endd
27101 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27102 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27103 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27104 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27105 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27106 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27107 uninterpreted string.
27108
27109
27110 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27111 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27112 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27113 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27114 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27115 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27116
27117
27118
27119
27120 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27121 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27122 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27123
27124 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27125 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27126 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27127 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27128 usual.
27129
27130 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27131 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27132 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27133 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27134 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27135 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27136 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27137 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27138 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27139 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27140 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27141 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27142
27143 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27144 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27145
27146 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27147 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27148 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27149 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27150 the string.
27151
27152 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27153 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27154 .code
27155 fixed_plain:
27156 driver = plaintext
27157 public_name = PLAIN
27158 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27159 .endd
27160 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27161 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27162 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27163 .code
27164 fixed_login:
27165 driver = plaintext
27166 public_name = LOGIN
27167 client_send = : username : mysecret
27168 .endd
27169 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27170 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27171 prompts.
27172 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27173 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27174
27175
27176
27177
27178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27180
27181 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27182 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27183 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27184 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27185 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27186 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27187 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27188 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27189 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27190 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27191 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27192 available in plain text at either end.
27193
27194
27195 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27196 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27197 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27198 authenticator as a server:
27199
27200 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27201 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27202 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27203 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27204 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27205 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27206 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27207 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27208 returned to the client.
27209
27210 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27211 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27212 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27213 numeric variables for other things.
27214
27215 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27216 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27217 user name, authentication fails.
27218 .code
27219 fixed_cram:
27220 driver = cram_md5
27221 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27222 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27223 server_set_id = $auth1
27224 .endd
27225 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27226 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27227 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27228 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27229 .code
27230 lookup_cram:
27231 driver = cram_md5
27232 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27233 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27234 {$value}fail}
27235 server_set_id = $auth1
27236 .endd
27237 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27238 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27239
27240 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27241 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27242 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27243 realm, with:
27244 .code
27245 cyrusless_crammd5:
27246 driver = cram_md5
27247 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27248 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27249 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27250 server_set_id = $auth1
27251 .endd
27252
27253 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27254 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27255 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27256
27257
27258
27259 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27260 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27261 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27262
27263
27264 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27265 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27266 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27267
27268
27269 .vindex "&$host$&"
27270 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27271 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27272 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27273 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27274 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27275 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27276 send the message to the current server.
27277
27278 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27279 strings, is:
27280 .code
27281 fixed_cram:
27282 driver = cram_md5
27283 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27284 client_name = ph10
27285 client_secret = secret
27286 .endd
27287 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27288 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27289
27290
27291
27292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27294
27295 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27296 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27297 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27298 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27299 .cindex "Kerberos"
27300 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27301 at A L Digital Ltd.
27302
27303 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27304 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27305 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27306 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27307 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27308
27309 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27310 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27311 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27312 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27313
27314 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27315 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27316 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27317 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27318 depending on the driver you are using.
27319
27320 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27321 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27322 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27323 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27324 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27325 implementation.
27326
27327 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27328 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27329 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27330 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27331 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27332 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27333 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27334 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27335
27336
27337 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27338 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27339 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27340 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27341 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27342 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27343 things.
27344
27345
27346 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27347 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27348 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27349 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27350
27351
27352 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27353 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27354 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27355 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27356 example:
27357 .code
27358 sasl:
27359 driver = cyrus_sasl
27360 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27361 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27362 server_set_id = $auth1
27363 .endd
27364
27365 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27366 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27367
27368
27369 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27370 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27371
27372
27373 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27374 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27375 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27376 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27377 .code
27378 sasl_cram_md5:
27379 driver = cyrus_sasl
27380 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27381 server_set_id = $auth1
27382
27383 sasl_plain:
27384 driver = cyrus_sasl
27385 public_name = PLAIN
27386 server_set_id = $auth2
27387 .endd
27388 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27389 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27390 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27391 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27392 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27393
27394
27395
27396
27397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27399 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27400 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27401 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27402 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27403 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27404 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27405 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27406 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27407 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27408
27409 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27410
27411 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27412 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27413 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27414 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27415 .code
27416 dovecot_plain:
27417 driver = dovecot
27418 public_name = PLAIN
27419 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27420 server_set_id = $auth1
27421
27422 dovecot_ntlm:
27423 driver = dovecot
27424 public_name = NTLM
27425 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27426 server_set_id = $auth1
27427 .endd
27428 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27429 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27430 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27431 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27432 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27433 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27434
27435 .new
27436 The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27437 something like:
27438 .code
27439 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27440
27441 service auth {
27442 ...
27443 #SASL
27444 unix_listener auth-client {
27445 mode = 0660
27446 user = mail
27447 }
27448 ...
27449 }
27450
27451 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27452
27453 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27454 .endd
27455 .wen
27456
27457 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27458 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27459
27460
27461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27463 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27464 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27465 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27466 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27467 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27468 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27469 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27470 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27471 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27472 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27473 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27474 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27475 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1-PLUS"
27476 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256"
27477 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256-PLUS"
27478 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27479 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27480 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27481 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27482 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27483 without code changes in Exim.
27484
27485 .new
27486 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27487 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27488 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27489 when this happens.
27490
27491
27492 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27493 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27494 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27495 by &%client_username%& option.
27496 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27497 which is the common case.
27498
27499 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27500 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27501
27502 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27503 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27504 the password to be used, in clear.
27505
27506 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27507 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27508 the account name to be used.
27509 .wen
27510
27511 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27512 Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27513 without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27514
27515 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27516 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27517 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27518 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27519 context.
27520
27521 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27522 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27523 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27524
27525 .new
27526 This is
27527 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27528 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27529 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27530 .wen
27531
27532 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27533 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27534 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27535
27536 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27537 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27538 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27539
27540
27541 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27542 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27543 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27544 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27545
27546
27547 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27548 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27549 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27550 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27551 example:
27552 .code
27553 sasl:
27554 driver = gsasl
27555 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27556 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27557 server_set_id = $auth1
27558 .endd
27559
27560
27561 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27562 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27563 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27564 the password itself.
27565
27566 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27567 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27568 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27569 if available, else the empty string.
27570 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27571 else the empty string.
27572
27573 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27574
27575 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27576 option to be simply "true".
27577
27578
27579 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27580 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27581 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27582
27583
27584 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27585 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27586 .new
27587 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27588
27589 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27590 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27591 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27592 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27593 either the iteration count or the salt).
27594 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27595 for all current CRAM mechanism variants.
27596 .wen
27597
27598
27599 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27600 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27601 .new
27602 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27603 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27604 protocol conversation.
27605 .wen
27606
27607
27608 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27609 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27610 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27611
27612
27613 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27614 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27615 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27616 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27617
27618 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27619 meanings for these variables:
27620
27621 .ilist
27622 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27623 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27624 .next
27625 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27626 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27627 .next
27628 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27629 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27630 .endlist
27631
27632 On a per-mechanism basis:
27633
27634 .ilist
27635 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27636 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27637 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27638 .next
27639 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27640 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27641 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27642 .next
27643 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27644 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27645 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27646 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27647 .endlist
27648
27649 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27650 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27651 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27652
27653
27654 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27655 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27656 .code
27657 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27658 driver = gsasl
27659 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27660 server_realm = imap.example.org
27661 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27662 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27663 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27664 server_condition = yes
27665 .endd
27666
27667
27668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27670
27671 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27672 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27673 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27674 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27675 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27676 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27677 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27678 reliably.
27679
27680 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27681 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27682 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27683 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27684
27685 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27686 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27687 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27688 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27689
27690 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27691 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27692 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27693 from the keytab.
27694
27695
27696 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27697 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27698 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27699 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27700
27701 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27702 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27703 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27704 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27705
27706 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27707 .ilist
27708 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27709 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27710 .next
27711 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27712 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27713 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27714 GSS Display Name.
27715 .endlist
27716
27717
27718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27720
27721 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27722 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27723 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27724 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27725 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27726 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27727 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27728 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27729 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27730 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27731 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27732 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27733 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27734 follows:
27735
27736 .ilist
27737 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27738 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27739 .next
27740 The server sends back a challenge.
27741 .next
27742 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27743 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27744 .endlist
27745
27746 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27747
27748
27749
27750 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27751 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27752 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27753
27754 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27755 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27756 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27757 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27758 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27759 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27760 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27761 for other things. For example:
27762 .code
27763 spa:
27764 driver = spa
27765 public_name = NTLM
27766 server_password = \
27767 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27768 .endd
27769 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27770 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27771
27772
27773
27774
27775
27776 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27777 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27778 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27779
27780
27781
27782 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27783 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27784
27785
27786 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27787 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27788
27789
27790 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27791 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27792 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27793 &'msn.com'&:
27794 .code
27795 msn:
27796 driver = spa
27797 public_name = MSN
27798 client_username = msn/msn_username
27799 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27800 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27801 .endd
27802 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27803 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27804
27805
27806
27807
27808
27809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27811
27812 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27813 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27814 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27815 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27816 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27817 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27818 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27819 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27820 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27821 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27822 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27823 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27824 by the server configuration.
27825
27826 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27827 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27828 and for clients to only attempt,
27829 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27830
27831 One possible use, compatible with the
27832 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27833 is for using X509 client certificates.
27834
27835 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27836 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27837 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27838 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27839 client certificates only.
27840
27841 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27842 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27843
27844 The client must present a certificate,
27845 for which it must have been requested via the
27846 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27847 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27848 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27849 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27850
27851 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27852 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27853 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27854
27855 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27856 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27857 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27858 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27859 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27860 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27861 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27862
27863 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27864
27865 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27866 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27867 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27868 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27869 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27870 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27871
27872 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27873 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27874 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27875 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27876 an identity for authentication and
27877 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27878
27879 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27880 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27881 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27882 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27883
27884 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27885 Once an identity has been received,
27886 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27887 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27888 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27889 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27890 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27891 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27892 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27893 string as the error text.
27894
27895 Example:
27896 .code
27897 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27898 driver = external
27899 public_name = EXTERNAL
27900
27901 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27902 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27903 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27904 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27905 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27906 server_set_id = $auth1
27907 .endd
27908 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27909 of your configured trust-anchors
27910 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27911 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27912
27913 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
27914 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27915 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27916 in this way.
27917
27918
27919 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27920 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27921 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27922
27923 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27924 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27925 identity being asserted.
27926
27927 Example:
27928 .code
27929 ext_ccert:
27930 driver = external
27931 public_name = EXTERNAL
27932
27933 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27934 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27935 .endd
27936
27937
27938 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27939 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27940
27941
27942
27943
27944
27945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27947
27948 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27949 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27950 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27951 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27952 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27953 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27954 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27955 authentication based on client certificates.
27956
27957 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27958 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27959 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27960 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27961 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27962 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27963
27964 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27965 for which it must have been requested via the
27966 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27967 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27968
27969 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27970 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27971 and can authenticate the connection.
27972 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27973
27974 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27975
27976
27977 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27978 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27979
27980 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27981 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27982 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27983 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27984 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27985 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27986
27987 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27988 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27989 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27990
27991 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27992
27993
27994 Example:
27995 .code
27996 tls:
27997 driver = tls
27998 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27999 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28000 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28001 {forany {$auth1} \
28002 {!= {0} \
28003 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28004 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28005 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28006 } } } }}}
28007 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28008 .endd
28009 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28010 of your configured trust-anchors
28011 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28012 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28013
28014 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28015 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28016 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28017 in this way.
28018 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28019
28020 . An alternative might use
28021 . .code
28022 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28023 . .endd
28024 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28025 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28026 . This would help for per-device use.
28027 .
28028 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28029 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28030
28031 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28032 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28033
28034
28035 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28036 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28037 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28038
28039
28040
28041 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28042 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28043
28044 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28045 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28046 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28047 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28048 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28049 .cindex "OpenSSL"
28050 .cindex "GnuTLS"
28051 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28052 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28053 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28054 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28055 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28056 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28057 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28058 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28059 certificates are used.
28060
28061 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28062 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28063 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28064 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28065 between them is encrypted.
28066
28067 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28068 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28069 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28070 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28071 encryption state.
28072
28073 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28074 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28075 in order to get TLS to work.
28076
28077
28078
28079 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28080 "SECID284"
28081 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28082 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28083 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28084 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28085 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28086 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28087 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28088 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28089 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28090 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28091 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28092
28093 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28094 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28095 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28096
28097 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28098 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28099 reassigned for other use.
28100 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28101 this port.
28102 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28103 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28104 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28105
28106 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28107 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28108 the most common use is expected to be:
28109 .code
28110 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28111 .endd
28112 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28113 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28114 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28115 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28116 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28117 defined elsewhere.
28118
28119 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28120 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28121
28122
28123
28124
28125
28126
28127 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28128 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28129 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28130 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28131 .code
28132 USE_OPENSSL=yes
28133 .endd
28134 in Local/Makefile.
28135
28136 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28137 .code
28138 USE_GNUTLS=yes
28139 .endd
28140 in Local/Makefile.
28141
28142 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28143 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28144
28145 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28146
28147 .ilist
28148 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28149 cannot be the path of a directory
28150 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28151 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28152 .next
28153 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28154 .next
28155 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28156 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28157 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28158 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28159 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28160 .next
28161 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28162 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28163 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28164 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28165 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28166 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28167 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28168 option).
28169 .next
28170 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28171 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28172 .next
28173 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28174 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28175 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28176 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28177 .next
28178 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28179 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28180 .next
28181 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28182 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28183 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28184 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28185 .endlist
28186
28187
28188 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28189 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28190 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28191 but not the chosen filename.
28192 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28193 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28194
28195 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28196 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28197 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28198 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28199 of bits requested.
28200 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28201 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28202 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28203 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28204 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28205 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28206 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28207
28208 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28209 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28210 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28211 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28212 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28213
28214 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28215 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28216 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28217 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28218 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28219 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28220
28221 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28222 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28223 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28224
28225 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28226 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28227 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28228 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28229 .code
28230 # ls
28231 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28232 # rm -f new-params
28233 # touch new-params
28234 # chown exim:exim new-params
28235 # chmod 0600 new-params
28236 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28237 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28238 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28239 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28240 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28241 # chmod 0400 new-params
28242 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28243 .endd
28244 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28245 stalling is removed.
28246
28247 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28248 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28249 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28250 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28251 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28252 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28253 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28254 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28255 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28256 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28257 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28258
28259 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28260 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28261 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28262 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28263
28264 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28265 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28266 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28267 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28268 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28269
28270
28271 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28272 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28273 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28274 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28275 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28276 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28277 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28278 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28279 directly to this function call.
28280 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28281 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28282 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28283 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28284
28285 .ilist
28286 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28287 .next
28288 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28289 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28290 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28291 SSL v3 algorithms.
28292 .next
28293 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28294 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28295 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28296 algorithms.
28297 .endlist
28298
28299 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28300 &`-`& or &`+`&.
28301 .ilist
28302 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28303 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28304 stated.
28305 .next
28306 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28307 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28308 .next
28309 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28310 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28311 .endlist
28312
28313 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28314 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28315 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28316 not be moved to the end of the list.
28317 .endlist
28318
28319 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28320 string:
28321 .code
28322 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28323 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28324 .endd
28325
28326 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28327 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28328 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28329 choice of clients used:
28330 .code
28331 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28332 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28333 {DEFAULT}\
28334 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28335 .endd
28336
28337 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28338 .code
28339 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28340 .endd
28341
28342 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28343 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28344 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28345 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28346
28347 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28348 .code
28349 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28350 .endd
28351
28352
28353 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28354 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28355 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28356 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28357 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28358 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28359 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28360 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28361 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28362 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28363 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28364 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28365
28366 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28367 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28368
28369 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28370 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28371 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28372 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28373 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28374 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28375
28376 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28377 "Priority strings". This is online as
28378 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28379 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28380 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28381 then the example code
28382 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28383 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28384
28385 For example:
28386 .code
28387 # Disable older versions of protocols
28388 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28389 .endd
28390
28391 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28392 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28393 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28394
28395 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28396 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28397 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28398 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28399 used:
28400 .code
28401 # GnuTLS variant
28402 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28403 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28404 {SECURE128}}
28405 .endd
28406
28407
28408 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28409 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28410 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28411 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28412 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28413 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28414 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28415
28416 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28417 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28418
28419 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28420 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28421 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28422 with the error
28423 .code
28424 554 Security failure
28425 .endd
28426 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28427 rejected with a 554 error code.
28428
28429 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28430 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28431
28432 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28433 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28434 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28435 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28436
28437 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28438
28439 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28440 .code
28441 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28442 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28443 .endd
28444 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28445 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28446 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28447 that goes with it. These files need to be
28448 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28449 always be given as full path names.
28450 The key must not be password-protected.
28451 They can be the same file if both the
28452 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28453 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28454 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28455 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28456 the server's certificate.
28457
28458 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28459 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28460 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28461 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28462 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28463 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28464
28465 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28466 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28467 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28468
28469 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28470 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28471 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28472 transport.
28473
28474 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28475 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28476 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28477 .code
28478 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28479 .endd
28480 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28481 with the parameters contained in the file.
28482 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28483 available:
28484 .code
28485 tls_dhparam = none
28486 .endd
28487 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28488 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28489 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28490 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28491
28492 See the command
28493 .code
28494 openssl dhparam
28495 .endd
28496 for a way of generating file data.
28497
28498 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28499 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28500 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28501 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28502 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28503
28504 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28505 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28506 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28507 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28508 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28509 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28510 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28511 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28512 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28513
28514 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28515 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28516 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28517 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28518 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28519 documentation for more details.
28520
28521 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28522 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28523
28524
28525 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28526 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28527 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28528 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28529 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28530 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28531 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28532 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28533 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28534 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28535 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28536 an explicit file or,
28537 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28538 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28539
28540 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28541 directory is used
28542 (OpenSSL only),
28543 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28544 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28545 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28546 .code
28547 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28548 .endd
28549 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28550
28551 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28552 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28553
28554 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28555 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28556 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28557 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28558 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28559 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28560 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28561 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28562 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28563 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28564
28565 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28566 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28567 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28568 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28569
28570 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28571 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28572 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28573 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28574 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28575 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28576
28577
28578 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28579 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28580 .cindex "revocation list"
28581 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28582 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28583 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28584 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28585 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28586 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28587 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28588 CRL in PEM format.
28589 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28590 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28591
28592 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28593 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28594 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28595 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28596 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28597 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28598
28599 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28600 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28601 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28602 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28603
28604 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28605 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28606 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28607 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28608 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28609 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28610 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28611 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28612
28613 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28614 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28615 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28616
28617 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28618 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28619 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28620 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28621 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28622
28623 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28624 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28625 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28626 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28627 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28628 next connection.
28629
28630 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28631 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28632 ignored.
28633
28634 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28635 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28636 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28637 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28638 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28639 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28640
28641 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28642 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28643
28644 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28645
28646 .code
28647 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28648 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28649 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28650
28651 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28652 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28653 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28654 .endd
28655
28656
28657
28658
28659 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28660 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28661 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28662 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28663 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28664 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28665 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28666 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28667 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28668
28669 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28670 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28671 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28672 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28673 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28674
28675 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28676 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28677 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28678 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28679 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28680 usual way.
28681
28682 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28683 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28684 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28685 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28686 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28687 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28688 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28689 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28690 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28691 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28692 unencrypted.
28693
28694 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28695 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28696 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28697 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28698
28699 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28700 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28701 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28702 in failed connections.
28703
28704 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28705 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28706 These may be
28707 the system default set (depending on library version),
28708 a file,
28709 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28710 The client verifies the server's certificate
28711 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28712 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28713 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28714 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28715
28716 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28717 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28718 or need not succeed respectively.
28719
28720 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28721 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28722 is valid for the certificate.
28723 The option defaults to always checking.
28724
28725 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28726 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28727 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28728 value is empty.
28729 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28730 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28731 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28732 otherwise.
28733
28734 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28735 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28736 for OCSP to be relevant.
28737
28738 If
28739 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28740 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28741 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28742 alternative hosts, if any.
28743
28744 &*Note*&:
28745 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28746 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28747 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28748 client.
28749
28750 .vindex "&$host$&"
28751 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28752 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28753 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28754 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28755 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28756
28757 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28758 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28759 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28760 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28761 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28762 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28763 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28764 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28765 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28766 outgoing connection.
28767
28768
28769
28770 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28771 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28772 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28773 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28774 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28775 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28776 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28777 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28778 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28779 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28780 for this session.
28781
28782 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28783 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28784 address.
28785
28786 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28787 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28788 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28789 be of limited use in that environment.
28790
28791 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28792 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28793 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28794 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28795 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28796
28797 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28798 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28799 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28800 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28801 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28802
28803 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28804 received from a client.
28805 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28806
28807 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28808 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28809 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28810
28811 .ilist
28812 &%tls_certificate%&
28813 .next
28814 &%tls_crl%&
28815 .next
28816 &%tls_privatekey%&
28817 .next
28818 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28819 .next
28820 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
28821 .endlist
28822
28823 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28824 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28825 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28826 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28827 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28828 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28829 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28830
28831 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28832 are re-expanded.
28833
28834 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28835 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28836 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28837 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28838
28839 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28840 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28841 built, then you have SNI support).
28842
28843
28844
28845 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28846 "SECTmulmessam"
28847 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28848 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28849 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28850 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28851 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28852 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28853 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28854 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28855 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28856 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28857
28858 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28859 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28860 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28861 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28862 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28863 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28864 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28865
28866 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28867 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28868 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28869 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28870 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28871 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28872 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28873 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28874 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28875
28876 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28877 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28878 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28879 information is recorded.
28880
28881 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28882 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28883 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28884
28885
28886
28887
28888 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28889 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28890 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28891 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28892 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28893 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28894
28895 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28896 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28897 document is currently at
28898 .display
28899 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28900 .endd
28901 and their FAQ is at
28902 .display
28903 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28904 .endd
28905
28906 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28907 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28908 descriptions.
28909 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28910 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28911 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28912 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28913
28914
28915 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28916 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28917 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28918 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28919 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28920 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28921 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28922 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28923 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28924 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28925 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28926 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28927 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28928
28929 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28930 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28931 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28932 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28933
28934
28935
28936 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28937 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28938 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28939 with OpenSSL, like this:
28940 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28941 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28942 .code
28943 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28944 -days 9999 -nodes
28945 .endd
28946 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28947 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28948 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28949 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28950 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28951 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28952 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28953
28954 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28955 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28956 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28957 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28958 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28959 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28960 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28961 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28962 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28963 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28964 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28965 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28966 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28967 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28968 be a sensible resolution).
28969
28970 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28971 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28972 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28973
28974 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28975 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28976 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28977 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28978 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28979 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28980
28981 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28982 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28983 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28984 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28985 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28986 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28987
28988
28989
28990 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28991 .cindex DANE
28992 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28993 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28994 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28995 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28996 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28997 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28998
28999 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29000 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29001 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29002
29003 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29004 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29005
29006 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29007 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29008 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29009
29010 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29011 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29012 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29013 DNSSEC.
29014 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
29015 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29016
29017 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29018 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29019 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29020 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29021
29022 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29023 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29024 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29025 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29026
29027 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29028 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29029 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29030 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29031 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29032 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29033 well-known one.
29034 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29035 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29036 does require careful arrangement.
29037 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29038 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29039 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29040 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29041 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29042
29043 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29044 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29045 your certificate.
29046 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29047 "MTA-STS", described below.
29048
29049 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29050 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29051 connections to you.
29052 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29053 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29054 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29055 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29056 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29057 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29058
29059 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29060 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29061 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29062 random serial numbers.
29063 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29064 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29065 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29066 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29067
29068 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29069 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29070
29071 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29072
29073 .code
29074 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29075 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29076 | openssl sha512 \
29077 | awk '{print $2}'
29078 .endd
29079
29080 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29081
29082 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29083
29084 .code
29085 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29086 .endd
29087
29088 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29089 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29090
29091
29092 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29093
29094 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29095 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29096 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29097 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29098 libraries.
29099 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29100 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29101
29102 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29103 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29104 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29105
29106 .code
29107 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29108 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29109 {*}{}}
29110 .endd
29111
29112 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29113 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29114 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29115 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29116 control the OCSP request.
29117
29118 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29119 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29120
29121
29122 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29123 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29124 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29125 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29126 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29127
29128 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29129
29130 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29131 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29132 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29133 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29134
29135 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29136 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29137 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29138 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29139 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29140 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29141 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29142
29143 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29144 .code
29145 hosts_require_tls
29146 tls_verify_hosts
29147 tls_try_verify_hosts
29148 tls_verify_certificates
29149 tls_crl
29150 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29151 .endd
29152
29153 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29154 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29155
29156 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29157 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29158
29159 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29160
29161 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29162 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29163 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29164 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29165
29166 .cindex DANE reporting
29167 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29168 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29169 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29170 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29171 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29172 Section 4.3 of that document.
29173
29174 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29175
29176 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29177 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29178 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29179 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29180 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29181 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29182 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29183 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29184 information.
29185
29186 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29187 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29188 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29189
29190 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29191 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29192 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29193 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29194 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29195 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29196 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29197
29198
29199
29200 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29201 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29202
29203 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29204 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29205 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29206 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29207 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29208 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29209 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29210 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29211 one very small ACL:
29212 .code
29213 begin acl
29214 small_acl:
29215 accept hosts = one.host.only
29216 .endd
29217 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29218 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29219
29220 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29221 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29222 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29223 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29224 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29225 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29226 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29227 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29228
29229
29230 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29231 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29232 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29233
29234
29235 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29236 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29237 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29238 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29239 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29240 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29241 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29242 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29243 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29244 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29245 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29246 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29247 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29248 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29249 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29250 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29251 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29252 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29253 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29254 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29255
29256 .table2 140pt
29257 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29258 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29259 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29260 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29261 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29262 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29263 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29264 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29265 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29266 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29267 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29268 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29269 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29270 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29271 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29272 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29273 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29274 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29275 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29276 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29277 .endtable
29278
29279 For example, if you set
29280 .code
29281 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29282 .endd
29283 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29284 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29285 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29286 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29287 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29288 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29289 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29290
29291
29292 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29293 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29294 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29295 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29296 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29297 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29298 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29299 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29300 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29301 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29302 in any of these ACLs.
29303
29304 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29305 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29306 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29307 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29308 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29309 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29310 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29311 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29312 .code
29313 control = suppress_local_fixups
29314 .endd
29315 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29316 run, it is too late.
29317
29318 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29319 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29320
29321 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29322 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29323 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29324
29325
29326 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29327 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29328 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29329 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29330 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29331 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29332 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29333 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29334 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29335
29336
29337 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29338 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29339 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29340 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29341 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29342 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29343 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29344 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29345 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29346
29347 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29348 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29349 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29350
29351 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29352 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29353 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29354 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29355 an EHLO response.
29356
29357
29358 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29359 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29360 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29361 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29362 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29363 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29364 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29365 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29366 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29367 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29368
29369 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29370 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29371 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29372 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29373 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29374 associated with the DATA command.
29375
29376 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29377 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29378 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29379 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29380 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29381 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29382 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29383 the data specified is received.
29384
29385 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29386 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29387 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29388 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29389 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29390 your resources.
29391
29392 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29393 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29394 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29395 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29396
29397 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29398 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29399 enabled (which is the default).
29400
29401 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29402 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29403 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29404
29405 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29406
29407 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29408
29409
29410 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29411 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29412 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29413
29414 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29415
29416
29417 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29418 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29419 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29420 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29421 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29422 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29423 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29424 has been accepted.
29425
29426 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29427 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29428 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29429 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29430 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29431 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29432 for some or all recipients.
29433
29434 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29435 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29436 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29437 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29438 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29439 is &"yes"&.
29440 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29441 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29442 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29443
29444 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29445 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29446
29447 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29448 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29449 the feature was not requested by the client.
29450
29451 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29452 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29453 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29454 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29455 does not in fact control any access.
29456 For this reason, it may only accept
29457 or warn as its final result.
29458
29459 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29460 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29461 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29462 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29463
29464 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29465 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29466
29467 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29468 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29469 response to QUIT.
29470
29471 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29472 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29473 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29474 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29475 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29476
29477
29478 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29479 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29480 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29481 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29482 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29483 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29484 situation even worse.
29485
29486 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29487 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29488 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29489 and &%warn%&.
29490
29491 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29492 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29493 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29494 connection. The possible values are:
29495 .table2
29496 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29497 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29498 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29499 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29500 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29501 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29502 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29503 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29504 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29505 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29506 .endtable
29507 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29508 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29509 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29510 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29511 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29512 used.
29513
29514
29515 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29516 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29517 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29518 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29519 .code
29520 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29521 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29522 .endd
29523 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29524 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29525 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29526 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29527 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29528
29529 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29530 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29531 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29532
29533 .ilist
29534 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29535 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29536 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29537 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29538 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29539 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29540 .code
29541 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29542 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29543 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29544 .endd
29545 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29546 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29547 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29548 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29549 .next
29550 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29551 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29552 matches the string.
29553 .next
29554 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29555 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29556 want to have something like
29557 .code
29558 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29559 .endd
29560 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29561 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29562 .endlist
29563
29564
29565
29566
29567 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29568 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29569 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29570 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29571 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29572 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29573 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29574 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29575 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29576
29577 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29578 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29579 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29580
29581
29582 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29583 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29584 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29585 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29586
29587 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29588 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29589 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29590 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29591 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29592 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29593 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29594
29595 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29596 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29597
29598
29599 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29600 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29601 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29602
29603
29604
29605 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29606 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29607 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29608 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29609 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29610 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29611
29612 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29613 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29614 used to accept or reject anything.
29615
29616 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29617 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29618 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29619 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29620
29621 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29622 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29623 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29624 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29625 configuration file.
29626
29627
29628
29629
29630 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29631 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29632 .vindex &$domain$&
29633 .vindex &$local_part$&
29634 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29635 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29636 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29637 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29638 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29639 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29640 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29641 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29642 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29643
29644 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29645 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29646 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29647 how it is used.
29648
29649 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29650 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29651 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29652 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29653 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29654 received).
29655
29656 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29657 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29658 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29659 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29660 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29661 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29662 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29663 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29664
29665
29666
29667
29668
29669 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29670 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29671 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29672 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29673 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29674 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29675 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29676 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29677 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29678 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29679 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29680 unencrypted connections.
29681 .code
29682 acl_check_auth:
29683 accept encrypted = *
29684 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29685 {CRAM-MD5}}
29686 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29687 .endd
29688 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29689 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29690 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29691 option to do this.)
29692
29693
29694
29695 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29696 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29697 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29698 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29699 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29700 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29701 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29702
29703 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29704 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29705 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29706 example:
29707 .code
29708 deny dnslists = list1.example
29709 dnslists = list2.example
29710 .endd
29711 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29712 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29713 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29714 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29715 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29716
29717
29718 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29719 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29720
29721 .ilist
29722 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29723 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29724 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29725 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29726 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29727 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29728 check a RCPT command:
29729 .code
29730 accept domains = +local_domains
29731 endpass
29732 verify = recipient
29733 .endd
29734 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29735 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29736 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29737 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29738 &%endpass%&.
29739
29740 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29741 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29742 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29743 configuration.
29744
29745 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29746 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29747 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29748 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29749 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29750 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29751 .display
29752 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29753 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29754 .endd
29755 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29756 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29757 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29758
29759 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29760 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29761 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29762 of &%endpass%&.
29763
29764
29765 .next
29766 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29767 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29768 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29769 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29770 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29771 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29772 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29773
29774
29775 .next
29776 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29777 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29778 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29779 example,
29780 .code
29781 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29782 .endd
29783 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29784
29785
29786 .next
29787 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29788 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29789 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29790 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29791 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29792 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29793 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29794 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29795 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29796
29797 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29798 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29799 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29800
29801
29802 .next
29803 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29804 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29805 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29806 .code
29807 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29808 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29809 .endd
29810 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29811 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29812
29813 .next
29814 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29815 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29816 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29817 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29818 .code
29819 require message = Sender did not verify
29820 verify = sender
29821 .endd
29822 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29823 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29824 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29825 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29826
29827 .next
29828 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29829 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29830 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29831 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29832 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29833 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29834 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29835
29836 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29837 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29838 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29839 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29840 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29841
29842 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29843 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29844 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29845 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29846 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29847 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29848 onwards.
29849
29850
29851 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29852 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29853 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29854 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29855 .code
29856 warn !verify = sender
29857 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29858 .endd
29859 .endlist
29860
29861 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29862
29863 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29864 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29865 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29866 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29867 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29868
29869
29870
29871 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29872 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29873 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29874 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29875 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29876 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29877 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29878 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29879 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29880 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29881 .ilist
29882 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29883 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29884 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29885 on the same SMTP connection.
29886 .next
29887 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29888 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29889 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29890 .endlist
29891
29892 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29893 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29894 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29895 .code
29896 accept hosts = whatever
29897 set acl_m4 = some value
29898 accept authenticated = *
29899 set acl_c_auth = yes
29900 .endd
29901 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29902 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29903 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29904
29905 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29906 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29907 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29908 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29909 error is generated.
29910
29911 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29912 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29913
29914
29915 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29916 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29917 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29918 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29919 .code
29920 deny domains = *.dom.example
29921 !verify = recipient
29922 .endd
29923 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29924 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29925 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29926 two statements are equivalent:
29927 .code
29928 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29929 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29930 .endd
29931 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29932 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29933
29934 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29935 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29936 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29937 .code
29938 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29939 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29940 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29941 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29942 .endd
29943 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29944 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29945 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29946 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29947 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29948 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29949 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29950
29951 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29952 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29953 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29954 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29955 message is handled.
29956
29957 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29958 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29959 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29960 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29961 .code
29962 require message = Can't verify sender
29963 verify = sender
29964 message = Can't verify recipient
29965 verify = recipient
29966 message = This message cannot be used
29967 .endd
29968 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29969 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29970 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29971 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29972 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29973 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29974
29975 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29976 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29977 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29978 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29979 .code
29980 deny hosts = ...
29981 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29982 message = Invalid sender from client host
29983 .endd
29984 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29985 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29986
29987
29988
29989 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29990 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29991 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29992
29993 .vlist
29994 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29995 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29996 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29997 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29998
29999 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30000 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30001 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30002 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30003 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30004 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30005 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30006 write rather ugly lines like this:
30007 .display
30008 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30009 .endd
30010 Instead, all you need is
30011 .display
30012 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30013 .endd
30014
30015 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30016 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30017 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30018 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30019 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30020 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30021 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30022 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30023
30024 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30025 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30026 in several different ways. For example:
30027
30028 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30029 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30030 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30031 . ==== way.
30032
30033 .ilist
30034 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30035 .code
30036 accept ...some conditions
30037 control = queue_only
30038 .endd
30039 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30040 other words, when the conditions are all true.
30041
30042 .next
30043 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30044 .code
30045 accept ...some conditions...
30046 control = queue_only
30047 ...some more conditions...
30048 .endd
30049 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30050 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30051 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30052 to be relevant.
30053
30054 .next
30055 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30056 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30057 example:
30058 .code
30059 warn ...some conditions...
30060 control = freeze
30061 accept ...
30062 .endd
30063 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30064 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30065 log entry.
30066
30067 .next
30068 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30069 &%require%& verb. For example:
30070 .code
30071 require control = no_multiline_responses
30072 .endd
30073 .endlist
30074
30075 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30076 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30077 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
30078 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30079 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30080 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30081 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30082 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30083 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30084
30085 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30086 example:
30087 .code
30088 deny ...some conditions...
30089 delay = 30s
30090 .endd
30091 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30092 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
30093 .code
30094 deny delay = 30s
30095 ...some conditions...
30096 .endd
30097 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30098 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30099 .code
30100 warn ...some conditions...
30101 delay = 2m
30102 control = freeze
30103 accept ...
30104 .endd
30105
30106 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30107 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30108 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30109 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30110 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30111 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30112 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30113
30114
30115 .vitem &*endpass*&
30116 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30117 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30118 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30119 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30120 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30121 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30122 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30123
30124
30125 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30126 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30127 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30128 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30129 .code
30130 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30131 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30132 .endd
30133 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30134 example:
30135 .display
30136 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30137 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30138 .endd
30139 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30140 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30141 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30142 message.
30143
30144 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30145 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30146 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30147 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30148 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30149 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30150 ignored.
30151
30152 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30153 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30154 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30155 error message.
30156
30157 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30158 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30159 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30160 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30161 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30162 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30163
30164 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30165 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30166 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30167 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30168 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30169 logging rejections.
30170
30171
30172 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30173 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30174 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30175 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30176 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30177 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30178 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30179 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30180 .display
30181 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30182 &` log_reject_target =`&
30183 .endd
30184 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30185 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30186 current ACL.
30187
30188
30189 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30190 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30191 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30192 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30193 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30194 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30195 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30196 ACLs. For example:
30197 .display
30198 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30199 &` control = freeze`&
30200 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30201 .endd
30202 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30203 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30204 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30205 example:
30206 .code
30207 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30208 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30209 .endd
30210
30211
30212 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30213 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30214 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30215 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30216 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30217 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30218 &%accept%& for details.)
30219
30220 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30221 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30222 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30223 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30224 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30225 .code
30226 require message = Host not recognized
30227 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30228 .endd
30229 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30230 processed.)
30231
30232 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30233 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30234 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30235 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30236 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30237 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30238 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30239 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30240 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30241 EHLO options.
30242
30243 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30244 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30245 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30246 .code
30247 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30248 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30249 .endd
30250 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30251 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30252 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30253 2&'xx'&.
30254
30255 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30256 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30257
30258 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30259 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30260 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30261 response.
30262
30263 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30264 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30265 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30266
30267 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30268 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30269 However, the original message is available in the variable
30270 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30271 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30272 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30273 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30274
30275 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30276 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30277 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30278 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30279 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30280 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30281 effect.
30282
30283
30284 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30285 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30286 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30287 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30288 for the message.
30289 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30290 the DATA ACL).
30291 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30292 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30293 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30294 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30295
30296
30297 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30298 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30299 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30300 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30301
30302
30303 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30304 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30305 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30306 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30307
30308
30309 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30310 .cindex "UDP communications"
30311 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30312 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30313 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30314 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30315 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30316 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30317 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30318 when:
30319 .code
30320 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30321 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30322 .endd
30323 .endlist
30324
30325
30326
30327
30328 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30329 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30330 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30331
30332 .vlist
30333 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30334 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30335 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30336 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30337 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30338 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30339 not work without it. For example:
30340 .code
30341 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30342 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30343 .endd
30344 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30345 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30346 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30347 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30348 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30349
30350
30351 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30352 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30353 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30354 .cindex "case of local parts"
30355 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30356 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30357 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30358 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30359 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30360 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30361 is encountered.
30362
30363 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30364 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30365 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30366 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30367 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30368
30369 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30370 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30371 spam score:
30372 .code
30373 warn control = caseful_local_part
30374 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30375 $acl_m4 + \
30376 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30377 }
30378 control = caselower_local_part
30379 .endd
30380 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30381 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30382
30383
30384 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30385 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30386 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30387 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30388
30389 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30390 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30391 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30392 is used for all recipients of the message,
30393 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30394 and data is copied from one to the other.
30395
30396 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30397 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30398 If a recipient-verify callout
30399 (with use_sender)
30400 connection is subsequently
30401 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30402 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30403 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30404
30405 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30406 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30407 Note also that headers cannot be
30408 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30409 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30410 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30411 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30412 this will affect the timestamp.
30413
30414 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30415 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30416 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30417 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30418 message body.
30419
30420 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30421 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30422 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30423 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30424 or CHUNKING
30425 options in use.
30426
30427 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30428 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30429 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30430 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30431 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30432
30433 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30434 usual fashion.
30435 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30436 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30437 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30438 and does not queue the message.
30439 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30440
30441 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30442 (possibly faked)
30443 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30444
30445
30446 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30447 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30448 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30449 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30450 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30451 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30452 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30453 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30454 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30455 option.
30456 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30457 with the &'kill'& option.
30458 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30459 contexts):
30460 .code
30461 control = debug
30462 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30463 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30464 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30465 control = debug/kill
30466 .endd
30467
30468
30469 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30470 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30471 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30472 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30473 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30474
30475
30476 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30477 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30478 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30479 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30480 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30481
30482
30483 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30484 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30485 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30486 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30487 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30488 strings or to numeric value.
30489 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30490 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30491 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30492
30493 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30494 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30495 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30496 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30497 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30498
30499
30500 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30501 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30502 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30503 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30504 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30505 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30506 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30507 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30508
30509 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30510 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30511 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30512 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30513 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30514 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30515 work with.
30516
30517
30518 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30519 .cindex "fake defer"
30520 .cindex "defer, fake"
30521 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30522 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30523 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30524 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30525 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30526
30527 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30528 .cindex "fake rejection"
30529 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30530 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30531 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30532 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30533 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30534 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30535 the same SMTP connection.
30536
30537 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30538 message is supplied, the following is used:
30539 .code
30540 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30541 550-kept for evaluation.
30542 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30543 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30544 .endd
30545 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30546
30547 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30548 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30549 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30550 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30551 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30552 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30553 SMTP connection.
30554
30555 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30556 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30557 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30558 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30559
30560 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30561 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30562 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30563 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30564 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30565 disables such output flushing.
30566
30567 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30568 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30569 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30570 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30571 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30572 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30573
30574 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30575 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30576 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30577 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30578 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30579 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30580 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30581 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30582 to be useful in production.
30583
30584 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30585 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30586 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30587 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30588 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30589
30590 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30591 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30592 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30593 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30594 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30595 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30596
30597 .ilist
30598 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30599 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30600 verification failed"&) is sent.
30601 .next
30602 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30603 line is output.
30604 .endlist
30605
30606 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30607 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30608
30609 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30610 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30611 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30612 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30613 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30614 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30615 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30616
30617 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30618 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30619 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30620 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30621 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30622 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30623 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30624 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30625 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30626 same SMTP connection.
30627
30628 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30629 .cindex "message" "submission"
30630 .cindex "submission mode"
30631 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30632 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30633 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30634 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30635 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30636 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30637 late (the message has already been created).
30638
30639 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30640 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30641 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30642 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30643 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30644
30645 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30646 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30647 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30648 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30649 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30650
30651 .ilist
30652 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30653 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30654 .next
30655 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30656 .next
30657 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30658 .endlist ilist
30659
30660 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30661 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30662 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30663 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30664 data is read.
30665
30666 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30667 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30668
30669 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30670 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30671 to a-label form.
30672 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30673 .endlist vlist
30674
30675
30676 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30677 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30678
30679 .ilist
30680 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30681 .next
30682 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30683 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30684 .next
30685 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30686 .next
30687 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30688 .endlist
30689
30690
30691
30692 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30693 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30694 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30695 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30696 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30697 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30698 .code
30699 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30700 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30701 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30702 .endd
30703 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30704 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30705 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30706 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30707 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30708 RCPT ACL).
30709
30710 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30711 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30712
30713 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30714 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30715 contains one or more newlines that
30716 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30717 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30718 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30719
30720 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30721 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30722 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30723 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30724 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30725 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30726 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30727 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30728 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30729 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30730 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30731
30732 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30733 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30734 of message headers
30735 until they are added to the
30736 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30737 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30738 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30739 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30740 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30741 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30742 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30743
30744 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30745
30746 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30747 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30748 .display
30749 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30750 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30751
30752 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30753 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30754 .endd
30755 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30756 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30757 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30758 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30759 honoured.
30760
30761 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30762 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30763 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30764 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30765 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30766 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30767 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30768 specifications.
30769
30770 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30771 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30772 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30773 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30774 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30775
30776 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30777 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30778 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30779 to be a header name first.) For example:
30780 .code
30781 warn add_header = \
30782 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30783 .endd
30784 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30785 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30786 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30787 up in reverse order.
30788
30789 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30790 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30791 system filter or in a router or transport.
30792
30793
30794
30795 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30796 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30797 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30798 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30799 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30800 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30801 .code
30802 warn message = Remove internal headers
30803 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30804 .endd
30805 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30806 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30807 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30808 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30809 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30810 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30811
30812 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30813 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30814
30815 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30816 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30817 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30818 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30819 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30820 .code
30821 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30822 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30823 warn message = Remove internal headers
30824 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30825 .endd
30826 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30827 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30828 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30829 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30830 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30831 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30832 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30833 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30834 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30835 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30836 would have been removed.
30837
30838 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30839 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30840 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30841 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30842 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30843 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30844 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30845 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30846 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30847
30848 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30849 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30850 .display
30851 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30852 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30853
30854 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30855 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30856 .endd
30857 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30858 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30859 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30860 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30861 are honoured.
30862
30863 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30864 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30865 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30866
30867
30868
30869
30870 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30871 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30872 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30873 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30874 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30875 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30876
30877 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30878 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30879 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30880 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30881 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30882 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30883 The conditions are as follows:
30884
30885
30886 .vlist
30887 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30888 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30889 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30890 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30891 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30892 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30893 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30894 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30895 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30896 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30897 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30898 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30899
30900 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30901 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30902 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30903 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30904 The name and values are expanded separately.
30905 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30906 will act as argument separators.
30907
30908 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30909 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30910 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30911 conditions are tested.
30912
30913 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30914 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30915 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30916 for different local users or different local domains.
30917
30918 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30919 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30920 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30921 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30922 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30923 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30924 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30925 .code
30926 authenticated = *
30927 .endd
30928
30929 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30930 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30931 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30932 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30933 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30934 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30935 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30936 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30937 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30938 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30939 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30940 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30941 negative.
30942
30943 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30944 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30945 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30946 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30947 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30948 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30949 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30950 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30951
30952 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30953 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30954 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30955 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30956 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30957 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30958 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30959 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30960 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30961 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30962
30963 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30964 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30965 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30967 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30968 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30969 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30970 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30971 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30972 &%domains%& test.
30973
30974 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30975 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30976
30977
30978 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30979 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30980 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30981 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30982 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30983 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30984 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30985 .code
30986 encrypted = *
30987 .endd
30988
30989
30990 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30991 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30992 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30993 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30994 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30995 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30996 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30997 .code
30998 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30999 .endd
31000 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31001 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31002 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31003
31004 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31005 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31006 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31007 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31008 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31009 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31010
31011 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31012 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31013 .code
31014 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31015 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31016 .endd
31017 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31018 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31019 statement can then check the IP address.
31020
31021 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
31022 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31023 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31024 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31025 .code
31026 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31027 message = $host_data
31028 .endd
31029 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31030
31031 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31032 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31033 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31034 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31035 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31036 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31037 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31038 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31039 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31040 the next &%local_parts%& test.
31041
31042 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31043 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31044 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31045 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31046 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31047 content-scanning extension
31048 and only after a DATA command.
31049 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31050 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31051
31052 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31053 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31054 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31055 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31056 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31057 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31058 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31059 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31060
31061 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31062 .cindex "rate limiting"
31063 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31064 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31065
31066 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31067 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31068 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31069 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31070 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31071 recipient address against a list of recipients.
31072
31073 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31074 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31075 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31076 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31077 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31078 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31079 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31080
31081 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31082 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31083 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31084 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31085 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31086 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31087 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31088 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31089 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31090 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31091 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31092 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31093 influence the sender checking.
31094
31095 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31096 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31097
31098 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31099 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31100 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31101 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31102 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31103 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31104 .code
31105 senders = :
31106 .endd
31107 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31108 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31109
31110 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31111 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31112 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31113 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31114 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31115 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31116
31117 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31118 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31119 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31120 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31121 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31122 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31123 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31124 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31125 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31126 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31127
31128 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31129 .cindex "CSA verification"
31130 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31131 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31132 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31133
31134 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31135 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31136 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31137 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31138 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31139 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31140 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31141 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31142 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31143 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31144
31145 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31146 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31147 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31148
31149 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31150 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31151 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31152 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31153 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31154 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31155 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31156 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31157 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31158 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31159 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31160 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31161 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31162 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31163 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31164
31165 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31166 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31167 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31168 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31169 .code
31170 deny senders = :
31171 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31172 !verify = header_sender
31173 .endd
31174
31175 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31176 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31177 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31178 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31179 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31180 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31181 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31182 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31183 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31184 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31185 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31186 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31187 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31188 appropriate.
31189
31190 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31191 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31192 .code
31193 To: @
31194 .endd
31195 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31196 common as they used to be.
31197
31198 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31199 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31200 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31201 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31202 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31203 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31204 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31205 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31206 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31207 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31208 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31209 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31210 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31211
31212 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31213 option), this condition is always true.
31214
31215
31216 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31217 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31218 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31219 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31220 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31221 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31222 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31223 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31224 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31225
31226 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31227 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31228
31229 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31230 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31231
31232
31233 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31234 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31235 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31236 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31237 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31238 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31239 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31240 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31241 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31242 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31243 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31244 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31245 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31246 value for the child address.
31247
31248 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31249 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31250 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31251 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31252 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31253 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31254 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31255 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31256 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31257 original IP address.
31258
31259 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31260 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31261
31262 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31263 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31264
31265 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31266 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31267 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31268 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31269 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31270 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31271 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31272 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31273 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31274
31275 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31276 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31277 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31278 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31279 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31280 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31281 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31282
31283 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31284 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31285 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31286
31287 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31288 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31289 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31290 verified as a sender.
31291
31292 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31293 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31294 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31295 .code
31296 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31297 .endd
31298 .endlist
31299
31300
31301
31302 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31303 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31304 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31305 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31306 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31307 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31308 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31309 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31310 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31311 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31312 .code
31313 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31314 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31315 .endd
31316 the following records are looked up:
31317 .code
31318 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31319 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31320 .endd
31321 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31322 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31323 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31324 use two separate conditions:
31325 .code
31326 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31327 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31328 .endd
31329 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31330 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31331 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31332 processed.
31333
31334 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31335 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31336 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31337 following special items in the list:
31338 .display
31339 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31340 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31341 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31342 .endd
31343 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31344 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31345 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31346 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31347 .code
31348 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31349 .endd
31350 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31351 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31352 .code
31353 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31354 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31355 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31356 .endd
31357 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31358 .cindex DNS TTL
31359 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31360 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31361 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31362 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31363 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31364 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31365
31366 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31367 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31368 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31369
31370
31371
31372 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31373 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31374 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31375 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31376 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31377 .code
31378 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31379 .endd
31380 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31381 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31382 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31383 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31384
31385
31386
31387
31388 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31389 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31390 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31391 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31392 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31393 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31394 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31395 .code
31396 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31397 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31398 .endd
31399 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31400 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31401 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31402 up by this example is
31403 .code
31404 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31405 .endd
31406 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31407 addresses. For example:
31408 .code
31409 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31410 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31411 .endd
31412 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31413 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31414
31415
31416
31417
31418 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31419 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31420 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31421 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31422 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31423 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31424 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31425 either to double the separators like this:
31426 .code
31427 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31428 .endd
31429 or to change the separator character, like this:
31430 .code
31431 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31432 .endd
31433 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31434 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31435 occurs. Consider this condition:
31436 .code
31437 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31438 .endd
31439 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31440 .code
31441 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31442 a.domain.black.list.tld
31443 .endd
31444 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31445 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31446 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31447 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31448 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31449 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31450 error for a previous item.
31451
31452 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31453 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31454 .code
31455 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31456 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31457 .endd
31458 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31459 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31460 .code
31461 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31462 $sender_address_domain \
31463 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31464 see $dnslist_text.
31465 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31466 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31467 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31468 .endd
31469 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31470 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31471 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31472 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31473 .code
31474 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31475 .endd
31476 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31477 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31478
31479 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31480 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31481
31482
31483
31484
31485 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31486 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31487 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31488 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31489 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31490 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31491 .display
31492 127.1.0.1 RBL
31493 127.1.0.2 DUL
31494 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31495 127.1.0.4 RSS
31496 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31497 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31498 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31499 .endd
31500 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31501 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31502 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31503
31504
31505 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31506 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31507 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31508 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31509 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31510 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31511 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31512 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31513 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31514 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31515 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31516 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31517 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31518 cases, for example:
31519 .code
31520 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31521 .endd
31522 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31523 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31524 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31525 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31526 .code
31527 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31528 .endd
31529 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31530 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31531
31532 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31533 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31534 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31535 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31536 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31537 information.
31538
31539 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31540 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31541 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31542 .code
31543 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31544 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31545 at $dnslist_domain
31546 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31547 .endd
31548
31549
31550
31551 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31552 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31553 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31554 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31555 For example,
31556 .code
31557 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31558 .endd
31559 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31560 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31561 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31562 describes how multiple records are handled.
31563
31564 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31565 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31566 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31567 .code
31568 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31569 .endd
31570 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31571 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31572 first. For example:
31573 .code
31574 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31575 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31576 .endd
31577
31578 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31579 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31580 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31581 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31582 tested. For example:
31583 .code
31584 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31585 .endd
31586 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31587 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31588 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31589 .code
31590 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31591 .endd
31592 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31593 an odd number.
31594
31595
31596
31597 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31598 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31599 condition. Whereas
31600 .code
31601 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31602 .endd
31603 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31604 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31605 .code
31606 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31607 .endd
31608 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31609 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31610 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31611 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31612
31613 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31614 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31615
31616 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31617 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31618 .code
31619 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31620 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31621 .endd
31622 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31623 Consider this example:
31624 .code
31625 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31626 list.dsbl.org : \
31627 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31628 relays.ordb.org
31629 .endd
31630 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31631 .code
31632 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31633 list.dsbl.org
31634 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31635 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31636 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31637 .endd
31638 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31639
31640
31641
31642
31643 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31644 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31645 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31646 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31647 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31648 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31649 .code
31650 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31651 .endd
31652 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31653 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31654 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31655 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31656 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31657 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31658
31659 .ilist
31660 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31661 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31662 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31663 .next
31664 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31665 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31666 changed to:
31667 .code
31668 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31669 .endd
31670 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31671 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31672 .code
31673 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31674 .endd
31675 for the condition to be true.
31676 .endlist
31677
31678 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31679 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31680 .ilist
31681 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31682 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31683 .code
31684 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31685 .endd
31686 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31687 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31688 .next
31689 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31690 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31691 .code
31692 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31693 .endd
31694 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31695 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31696 .code
31697 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31698 .endd
31699 for the condition to be false.
31700 .endlist
31701 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31702 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31703
31704
31705
31706
31707 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31708 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31709 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31710 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31711 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31712 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31713 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31714 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31715 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31716 lists.
31717
31718 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31719 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31720 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31721 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31722 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31723 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31724 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31725 .code
31726 deny message = \
31727 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31728 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31729 dnslists = \
31730 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31731 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31732 .endd
31733 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31734 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31735 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31736 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31737 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31738 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31739
31740 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31741 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31742 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31743 .code
31744 deny dnslists = \
31745 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31746 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31747 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31748 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31749 .endd
31750 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31751 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31752 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31753
31754
31755
31756 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31757 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31758 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31759 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31760 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31761 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31762 .code
31763 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31764 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31765 .endd
31766 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31767 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31768 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31769 .code
31770 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31771 .endd
31772 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31773 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31774
31775 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31776 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31777 .code
31778 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31779 dnslists = some.list.example
31780 .endd
31781
31782 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31783 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31784 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31785 .code
31786 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31787 .endd
31788
31789 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31790 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31791 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31792 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31793 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31794 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31795 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31796 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31797 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31798 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31799 .display
31800 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31801 .endd
31802 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31803 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31804
31805 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31806 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31807 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31808 of &'p'&.
31809
31810 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31811 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31812 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31813 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31814 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31815 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31816 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31817 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31818 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31819
31820 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31821 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31822 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31823 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31824
31825 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31826 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31827 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31828 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31829 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31830 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31831 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31832 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31833 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31834 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31835
31836 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31837 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31838 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31839 ACL.
31840
31841 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31842 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31843 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31844 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31845 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31846 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31847
31848 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31849 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31850 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31851 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31852 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31853 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31854 the &%count=%& option.
31855
31856
31857 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31858 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31859 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31860 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31861 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31862
31863 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31864 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31865 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31866 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31867
31868 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31869 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31870 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31871 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31872 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31873 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31874 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31875
31876 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31877 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31878 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31879 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31880 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31881 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31882 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31883
31884 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31885 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31886 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31887 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31888 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31889
31890 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31891 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31892 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31893 multiple different commands.
31894
31895 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31896 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31897 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31898 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31899 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31900
31901 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31902
31903
31904 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31905 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31906 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31907 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31908 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31909
31910 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31911 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31912
31913 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31914 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31915 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31916 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31917 new rate.
31918 .code
31919 acl_check_connect:
31920 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31921 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31922 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31923 # ...
31924 acl_check_mail:
31925 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31926 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31927 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31928 .endd
31929
31930 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31931 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31932 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31933 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31934 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31935 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31936 checks.
31937
31938 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31939 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31940 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31941 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31942 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31943
31944
31945 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31946 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31947 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31948 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31949 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31950 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31951 rest of the ACL.
31952
31953 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31954 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31955 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31956 up to the given limit.
31957 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31958 consists of refusing the message, and
31959 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31960 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31961 likely not what is wanted.
31962
31963 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31964 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31965 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31966 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31967 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31968 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31969 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31970 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31971 .code
31972 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31973 .endd
31974
31975
31976 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31977 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31978 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31979 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31980 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31981 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31982 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31983 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31984 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31985
31986 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31987 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31988 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31989 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31990 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31991 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31992
31993 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31994 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31995 rate.
31996
31997 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31998 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31999 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32000 required increases with larger limits.
32001
32002 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32003 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32004 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32005 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32006 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32007 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32008 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32009 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32010 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32011 as intended.
32012
32013
32014 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32015 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32016 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32017 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32018 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32019 message. For example:
32020 .code
32021 # Log all senders' rates
32022 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32023 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32024
32025 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32026 # at the decimal point.
32027 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32028 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32029 $sender_rate_limit }s
32030
32031 # Keep authenticated users under control
32032 deny authenticated = *
32033 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32034
32035 # System-wide rate limit
32036 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32037 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32038
32039 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32040 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32041 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32042 messages per $sender_rate_period
32043 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32044 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32045 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32046 .endd
32047 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32048 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32049 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32050 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32051 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32052 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32053 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32054
32055
32056
32057 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32058 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32059 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32060 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32061 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32062 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32063 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32064 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32065 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32066 .code
32067 verify = sender/callout
32068 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32069 .endd
32070 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32071 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32072 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32073 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32074 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32075 The available options are as follows:
32076
32077 .ilist
32078 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32079 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32080 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32081 .next
32082 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32083 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32084 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32085 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32086 .next
32087 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32088 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32089 .next
32090 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32091 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32092 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32093 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32094 .endlist
32095
32096 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32097 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32098 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32099 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32100 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32101 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32102 coding like this:
32103 .code
32104 warn !verify = sender
32105 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32106 .endd
32107 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32108 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32109 verification failure.
32110
32111 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32112 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32113
32114 .ilist
32115 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32116 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32117 .next
32118 &%route%&: Routing failed.
32119 .next
32120 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32121 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32122 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32123 .next
32124 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32125 .next
32126 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32127 .endlist
32128
32129 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32130 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32131
32132 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32133 address verification to:
32134
32135 .ilist
32136 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32137 .endlist
32138
32139
32140
32141
32142 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32143 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32144 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32145 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32146 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32147 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32148 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32149 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32150 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32151 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32152 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32153 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32154 sender's domain.
32155
32156 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32157 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32158 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32159 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32160 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32161 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32162
32163 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32164 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32165 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32166 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32167 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32168
32169 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32170 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32171 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32172 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32173 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32174 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32175 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32176 supplies a host list.
32177 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32178
32179 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32180 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32181 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32182 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32183 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32184 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32185 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32186
32187 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32188 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32189 following SMTP commands are sent:
32190 .display
32191 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32192 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32193 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32194 &`QUIT`&
32195 .endd
32196 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32197 set to &"lmtp"&.
32198
32199 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32200 settings.
32201
32202 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32203 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32204 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32205 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32206 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32207 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32208
32209 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32210 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32211 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32212 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32213 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32214
32215 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32216 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32217 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32218 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32219 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32220
32221
32222
32223
32224 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32225 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32226 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32227 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32228 .code
32229 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32230 .endd
32231 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32232 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32233 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32234
32235
32236 .vlist
32237 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32238 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32239 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32240 For example:
32241 .code
32242 verify = sender/callout=5s
32243 .endd
32244 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32245 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32246 the &%connect%& parameter.
32247
32248
32249 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32250 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32251 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32252 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32253 .code
32254 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32255 .endd
32256 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32257
32258 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32259 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32260 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32261 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32262 updated in this circumstance.
32263
32264 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32265 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32266 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32267 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32268 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32269 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32270
32271
32272 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32273 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32274 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32275 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32276 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32277 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32278 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32279 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32280 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32281 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32282 .code
32283 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32284 .endd
32285 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32286
32287
32288 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32289 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32290 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32291 For example:
32292 .code
32293 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32294 .endd
32295 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32296 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32297 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32298 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32299 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32300
32301
32302 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32303 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32304 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32305 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32306
32307 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32308 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32309 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32310 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32311 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32312 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32313 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32314 made, until the cache record expires.
32315
32316 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32317 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32318 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32319 For example:
32320 .code
32321 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32322 .endd
32323 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32324 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32325 .code
32326 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32327 .endd
32328 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32329 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32330 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32331 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32332
32333
32334 .vitem &*random*&
32335 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32336 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32337 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32338 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32339 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32340 .code
32341 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32342 .endd
32343 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32344 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32345 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32346 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32347 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32348
32349 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32350 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32351 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32352 .code
32353 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32354 .endd
32355 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32356 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32357 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32358 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32359 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32360
32361 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32362 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32363 .code
32364 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32365 .endd
32366 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32367 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32368 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32369 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32370 usefulness of callout caching.
32371
32372 .vitem &*hold*&
32373 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32374 .code
32375 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32376 .endd
32377 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32378 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32379 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32380 when that is used for the connections.
32381 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32382 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32383 if the use_sender option is used,
32384 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32385 and if no other callouts intervene.
32386 .endlist
32387
32388 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32389 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32390 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32391 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32392 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32393 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32394 these circumstances.
32395
32396 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32397 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32398 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32399 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32400 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32401 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32402 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32403
32404 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32405 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32406 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32407 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32408
32409
32410
32411
32412 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32413 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32414 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32415 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32416 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32417 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32418 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32419 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32420 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32421 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32422
32423 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32424 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32425 is not available.
32426
32427 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32428 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32429 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32430
32431 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32432 commands up to and including
32433 .code
32434 MAIL FROM:<>
32435 .endd
32436 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32437 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32438 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32439 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32440 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32441 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32442 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32443
32444 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32445 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32446 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32447 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32448 will eventually be noticed.
32449
32450 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32451 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32452 behaviour will be the same.
32453
32454
32455
32456 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32457 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32458 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32459 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32460 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32461 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32462 you might see:
32463 .code
32464 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32465 250 OK
32466 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32467 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32468 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32469 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32470 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32471 550 Sender verification failed
32472 .endd
32473 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32474 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32475 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32476 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32477 example:
32478 .code
32479 verify = sender/no_details
32480 .endd
32481
32482 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32483 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32484 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32485 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32486 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32487 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32488 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32489
32490 .ilist
32491 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32492 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32493 verification also fails.
32494 .next
32495 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32496 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32497 .endlist
32498
32499 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32500 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32501 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32502 .code
32503 A.Wol: aw123
32504 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32505 .endd
32506 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32507 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32508 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32509 verification to succeed.
32510
32511 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32512 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32513 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32514 option. For example:
32515 .code
32516 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32517 .endd
32518 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32519 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32520
32521 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32522 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32523 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32524 address and a report is output for each of them.
32525
32526
32527
32528 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32529 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32530 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32531 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32532 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32533 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32534 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32535 .code
32536 verify = csa
32537 .endd
32538 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32539 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32540 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32541 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32542 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32543 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32544
32545 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32546 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32547 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32548 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32549
32550 .ilist
32551 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32552 .next
32553 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32554 .next
32555 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32556 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32557 .next
32558 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32559 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32560 .endlist
32561
32562 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32563 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32564 .code
32565 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32566 .endd
32567 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32568 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32569 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32570 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32571 meaningful to say:
32572 .code
32573 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32574 .endd
32575 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32576 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32577 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32578
32579 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32580 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32581 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32582 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32583 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32584 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32585 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32586 of legitimate HELO domains.
32587
32588 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32589 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32590 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32591 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32592 lookup such as:
32593 .code
32594 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32595 .endd
32596 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32597 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32598 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32599
32600
32601
32602
32603 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32604 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32605 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32606 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32607 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32608 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32609 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32610 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32611
32612 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32613 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32614 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32615 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32616 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32617 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32618 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32619 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32620
32621 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32622 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32623 like this:
32624 .code
32625 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32626 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32627 }{$value}}
32628 .endd
32629 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32630 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32631 use this:
32632 .code
32633 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32634 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32635 senders = :
32636 recipients = +batv_senders
32637
32638 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32639 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32640 senders = :
32641 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32642 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32643 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32644 .endd
32645 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32646 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32647 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32648 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32649 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32650
32651 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32652 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32653 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32654 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32655 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32656 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32657 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32658
32659 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32660 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32661 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32662 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32663 .code
32664 batv_redirect:
32665 driver = redirect
32666 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32667 .endd
32668 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32669 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32670 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32671 local addresses.
32672
32673 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32674 can be used:
32675 .code
32676 external_smtp_batv:
32677 driver = smtp
32678 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32679 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32680 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32681 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32682 {$value}fail}}}
32683 .endd
32684 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32685
32686
32687
32688 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32689 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32690 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32691 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32692 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32693 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32694 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32695 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32696 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32697 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32698
32699 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32700 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32701 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32702 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32703 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32704 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32705 . ///
32706 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32707 . ///
32708 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32709 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32710 system to arbitrary domains.
32711
32712
32713 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32714 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32715 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32716 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32717
32718 .ilist
32719 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32720 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32721 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32722 .next
32723 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32724 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32725 .next
32726 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32727 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32728 .endlist
32729
32730
32731 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32732 .code
32733 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32734 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32735 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32736 .endd
32737 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32738 command:
32739 .code
32740 acl_check_rcpt:
32741 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32742 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32743 .endd
32744 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32745 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32746 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32747 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32748 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32749 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32750 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32751
32752
32753
32754 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32755 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32756 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32757 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32758 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32759 .ecindex IIDacl
32760
32761
32762
32763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32765
32766 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32767 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32768 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32769 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32770 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32771 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32772 specification.
32773
32774 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32775 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32776 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32777 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32778 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32779
32780 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32781 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32782 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32783
32784 .ilist
32785 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32786 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32787 .next
32788 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32789 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32790 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32791 .next
32792 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32793 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32794 .next
32795 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32796 conditions.
32797 .next
32798 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32799 .endlist
32800
32801 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32802 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32803 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32804 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32805 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32806 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32807
32808 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32809 temporarily created in a file called:
32810 .display
32811 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32812 .endd
32813 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32814 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32815 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32816 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32817 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32818 .code
32819 control = no_mbox_unspool
32820 .endd
32821 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32822 same directory by default.
32823
32824
32825
32826 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32827 .cindex "virus scanning"
32828 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32829 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32830 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32831 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32832 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32833 in memory and thus are much faster.
32834
32835 Since message data needs to have arrived,
32836 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32837 &%acl_smtp_data%&,
32838 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32839 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32840 &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32841
32842 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32843 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32844
32845 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32846 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32847 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32848 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32849 .display
32850 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32851 .endd
32852 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32853 .code
32854 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32855 .endd
32856 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32857 before use.
32858 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32859 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32860 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32861
32862 .vlist
32863 .vitem &%avast%&
32864 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32865 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32866 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32867 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32868 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32869 This scanner type takes one option,
32870 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32871 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32872 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32873 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32874 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32875 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32876 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32877
32878 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32879 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32880 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32881 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32882 care.
32883
32884 For example:
32885 .code
32886 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32887 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32888 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32889 .endd
32890 If you omit the argument, the default path
32891 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32892 is used.
32893 If you use a remote host,
32894 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32895 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32896 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32897 .code
32898 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32899 FLAGS
32900 SENSITIVITY
32901 PACK
32902 .endd
32903
32904 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32905 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32906 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32907
32908 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32909 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32910 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32911 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32912 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32913 example:
32914 .code
32915 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32916 .endd
32917
32918
32919 .vitem &%clamd%&
32920 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32921 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32922 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32923 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32924 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32925
32926 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32927 a UNIX socket specification,
32928 a TCP socket specification,
32929 or a (global) option.
32930
32931 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32932 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32933 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32934 and the second a port number,
32935 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32936 These per-server options are supported:
32937 .code
32938 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32939 .endd
32940
32941 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32942 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32943
32944 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32945
32946 Examples:
32947 .code
32948 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32949 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32950 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32951 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32952 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32953 .endd
32954 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32955 &`local`&
32956 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32957 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32958 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32959 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32960
32961 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32962 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32963 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32964 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32965 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32966 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32967 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32968 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32969 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32970 .code
32971 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32972 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32973 (Connection refused)
32974 .endd
32975
32976 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32977 contributing the code for this scanner.
32978
32979 .vitem &%cmdline%&
32980 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32981 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32982 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32983 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32984
32985 .olist
32986 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32987 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32988
32989 .next
32990 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32991 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32992 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32993 the &"trigger"& expression.
32994
32995 .next
32996 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32997 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32998 &"name"& expression.
32999 .endlist olist
33000
33001 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33002 .code
33003 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33004 .endd
33005 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33006 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33007 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33008 configuration setting:
33009 .code
33010 av_scanner = cmdline:\
33011 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33012 found in file:'(.+)'
33013 .endd
33014 .vitem &%drweb%&
33015 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33016 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33017 takes one option,
33018 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33019 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33020 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33021 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33022 For example:
33023 .code
33024 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33025 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33026 .endd
33027 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33028 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33029
33030 .vitem &%f-protd%&
33031 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33032 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33033 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33034 (or port-range).
33035 For example:
33036 .code
33037 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33038 .endd
33039 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33040
33041 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33042 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33043 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33044 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33045 For example:
33046 .code
33047 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33048 .endd
33049 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33050
33051 .vitem &%fsecure%&
33052 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33053 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33054 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33055 .code
33056 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33057 .endd
33058 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33059 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33060
33061 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33062 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33063 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33064 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33065 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33066 For example:
33067 .code
33068 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33069 .endd
33070 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33071
33072 .vitem &%mksd%&
33073 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33074 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33075 though some documentation was available in English.
33076 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33077 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33078 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33079 to integrate.
33080 The only option for this scanner type is
33081 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33082 provided that mksd has
33083 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33084 .code
33085 av_scanner = mksd:2
33086 .endd
33087 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33088
33089 .vitem &%sock%&
33090 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33091 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33092 running on the local machine.
33093 There are four options:
33094 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33095 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33096 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33097 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33098 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33099 For example:
33100 .code
33101 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33102 .endd
33103 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33104 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33105 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33106 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33107 specify an empty element to get this.
33108
33109 .vitem &%sophie%&
33110 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33111 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33112 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33113 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33114 client communication. For example:
33115 .code
33116 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33117 .endd
33118 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33119 the option.
33120 .endlist
33121
33122 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33123 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33124 ACL.
33125
33126 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33127 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33128 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33129 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33130 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33131 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33132 message.
33133
33134 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33135 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33136 The first element can then be one of
33137
33138 .ilist
33139 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33140 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33141 recommended usage.
33142 .next
33143 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33144 the condition fails immediately.
33145 .next
33146 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33147 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33148 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33149 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33150 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33151 .endlist
33152
33153 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33154 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33155 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33156
33157 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33158 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33159 For example:
33160 .code
33161 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33162 .endd
33163 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33164
33165 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33166 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33167 is set to record the actual address used.
33168
33169 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33170 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33171 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33172 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33173 logging data.
33174
33175 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33176 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33177
33178 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33179 .code
33180 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33181 malware = *
33182 .endd
33183 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33184 .code
33185 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33186 malware = */defer_ok
33187 .endd
33188 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33189 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33190 .code
33191 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33192 .endd
33193 in the main Exim configuration.
33194 .code
33195 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33196 set acl_m0 = sophie
33197 malware = *
33198
33199 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33200 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33201 malware = *
33202 .endd
33203
33204
33205 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33206 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33207 .cindex "spam scanning"
33208 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33209 .cindex "Rspamd"
33210 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33211 score and a report for the message.
33212 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33213
33214 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33215 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33216 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33217
33218 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33219 .code
33220 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33221 .endd
33222 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33223 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33224 nicely, however.
33225
33226 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33227 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33228 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33229 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33230 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33231 configuration as follows (example):
33232 .code
33233 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33234 .endd
33235 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33236 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33237 iptables firewall, consider setting
33238 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33239 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33240 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33241 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33242 soon.
33243
33244
33245 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33246 on TCP port 11333)
33247 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33248 .code
33249 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33250 .endd
33251
33252 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33253 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33254 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33255 .code
33256 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33257 .endd
33258 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33259 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33260 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33261 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33262 .code
33263 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33264 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33265 192.168.2.12 783
33266 .endd
33267 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33268 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33269 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33270 condition defers.
33271
33272 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33273 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33274 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33275 take care to not double the separator.
33276
33277 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33278 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33279 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33280 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33281
33282 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33283 are options.
33284 The supported options are:
33285 .code
33286 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33287 weight=<value> Selection bias
33288 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33289 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33290 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33291 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33292 .endd
33293
33294 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33295 higher values being tried first.
33296 The default priority is 1.
33297
33298 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33299 Within a priority set
33300 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33301 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33302
33303 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33304 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33305 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33306 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33307
33308 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33309 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33310
33311 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33312 The default value is two minutes.
33313
33314 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33315 a failed connect is made.
33316 The default is to not retry.
33317
33318 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33319 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33320 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33321 expansion.
33322
33323 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33324 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33325 is set to record the actual address used.
33326
33327 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33328 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33329 .code
33330 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33331 spam = joe
33332 .endd
33333 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33334 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33335 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33336 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33337 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33338 right-hand side.
33339
33340 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33341 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33342 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33343 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33344 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33345 are not set.
33346 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33347 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33348 after the first),
33349 or the use of PRDR,
33350 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33351 are needed to use this feature.
33352
33353 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33354 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33355 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33356
33357
33358 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33359 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33360 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33361 example:
33362 .code
33363 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33364 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33365 spam = nobody
33366 .endd
33367
33368 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33369 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33370 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33371 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33372
33373 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33374 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33375 variables.
33376 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33377 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33378 available for use at delivery time.
33379
33380 .vlist
33381 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33382 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33383 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33384
33385 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33386 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33387 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33388 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33389 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33390
33391 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33392 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33393 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33394 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33395 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33396 spam bar is 50 characters.
33397
33398 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33399 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33400 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33401 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33402 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33403 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33404 unencoded in headers.
33405
33406 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33407 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33408 spam score versus threshold.
33409 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33410
33411 .endlist
33412
33413 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33414 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33415 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33416
33417 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33418 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33419 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33420 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33421 spam condition, like this:
33422 .code
33423 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33424 spam = joe/defer_ok
33425 .endd
33426 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33427
33428 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33429 condition:
33430 .code
33431 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33432 warn spam = nobody:true
33433 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33434 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33435
33436 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33437 # is over threshold
33438 warn spam = nobody
33439 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33440
33441 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33442 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33443 spam = nobody:true
33444 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33445 .endd
33446
33447
33448
33449 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33450 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33451 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33452 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33453 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33454 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33455 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33456 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33457 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33458 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33459 cases.
33460
33461 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33462 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33463 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33464 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33465 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33466 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33467 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33468
33469 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33470 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33471 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33472 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33473 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33474
33475 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33476 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33477 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33478 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33479 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33480 syntax is:
33481 .display
33482 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33483 .endd
33484 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33485 the value can be:
33486
33487 .olist
33488 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33489 .next
33490 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33491 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33492 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33493 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33494 .next
33495 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33496 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33497 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33498 the full path and filename.
33499 .next
33500 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33501 filename, and the default path is then used.
33502 .endlist
33503 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33504 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33505 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33506 .code
33507 decode = $mime_filename
33508 .endd
33509 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33510 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33511 automatically unlinked.
33512
33513 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33514 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33515 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33516 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33517 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33518
33519 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33520 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33521 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33522
33523 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33524 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33525 available in the MIME ACL:
33526
33527 .vlist
33528 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33529 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33530 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33531 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33532 contains the empty string.
33533
33534 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33535 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33536 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33537 .code
33538 us-ascii
33539 gb2312 (Chinese)
33540 iso-8859-1
33541 .endd
33542 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33543 case-insensitively.
33544
33545 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33546 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33547 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33548 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33549 only used for display purposes.
33550
33551 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33552 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33553 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33554
33555 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33556 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33557 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33558
33559 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33560 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33561 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33562 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33563 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33564
33565 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33566 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33567 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33568 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33569
33570 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33571 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33572 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33573 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33574 .code
33575 text/plain
33576 text/html
33577 application/octet-stream
33578 image/jpeg
33579 audio/midi
33580 .endd
33581 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33582 empty string.
33583
33584 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33585 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33586 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33587 containing the decoded data.
33588 .endlist
33589
33590 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33591 .vlist
33592 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33593 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33594 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33595 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33596 RFC2047
33597 or RFC2231
33598 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33599 If no filename was
33600 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33601
33602 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33603 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33604 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33605 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33606
33607 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33608 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33609 follows:
33610
33611 .olist
33612 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33613
33614 .next
33615 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33616 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33617
33618 .next
33619 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33620 and the rest are attachments.
33621
33622 .next
33623 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33624 .endlist olist
33625
33626 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33627 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33628 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33629 .code
33630 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33631 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33632 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33633 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33634 .endd
33635 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33636 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33637 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33638 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33639 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33640
33641 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33642 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33643 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33644 decoding is fully recursive.
33645
33646 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33647 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33648 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33649 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33650 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33651 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33652 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33653 .endlist
33654
33655
33656
33657 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33658 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33659 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33660 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33661 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33662
33663 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33664 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33665 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33666 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33667 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33668
33669 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33670 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33671 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33672 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33673 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33674 32K characters are checked.
33675
33676 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33677 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33678 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33679 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33680 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33681 .code
33682 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33683 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33684 .endd
33685 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33686 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33687 matching regular expression.
33688 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33689 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33690
33691 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33692 CPU-intensive.
33693
33694 .ecindex IIDcosca
33695
33696
33697
33698
33699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33701
33702 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33703 "Local scan function"
33704 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33705 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33706 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33707 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33708 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33709
33710 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33711 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33712 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33713 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33714 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33715
33716 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33717 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33718 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33719 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33720
33721 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33722 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33723 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33724 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33725
33726 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33727 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33728 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33729 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33730 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33731 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33732 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33733 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33734 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33735
33736
33737
33738 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33739 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33740 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33741 function is before building Exim, by setting
33742 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33743 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33744 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33745 directory, so you might set
33746 .code
33747 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33748 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33749 .endd
33750 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
33751 .new
33752 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
33753 and then #include "local_scan.h".
33754 .wen
33755 It is called by
33756 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33757 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33758 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33759 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33760 _src/local_scan.c_.
33761
33762 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33763 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33764 .code
33765 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33766 .endd
33767 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33768
33769
33770
33771
33772 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33773 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33774 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33775 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33776 .code
33777 #include "local_scan.h"
33778 .endd
33779 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33780 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33781 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33782 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33783 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33784 strings and pointers to character strings:
33785 .code
33786 #define CS (char *)
33787 #define CCS (const char *)
33788 #define CSS (char **)
33789 #define US (unsigned char *)
33790 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33791 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33792 .endd
33793 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33794 .code
33795 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33796 .endd
33797 The arguments are as follows:
33798
33799 .ilist
33800 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33801 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33802 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33803
33804 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33805 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33806 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33807 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33808 case this changes in some future version.
33809 .next
33810 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33811 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33812 .endlist
33813
33814 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33815
33816 .vlist
33817 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33818 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33819 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33820 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33821 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33822 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33823
33824 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33825 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33826 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33827
33828 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33829 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33830 queued without immediate delivery.
33831
33832 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33833 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33834 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33835 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33836 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33837 used.
33838
33839 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33840 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33841 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33842 problem"& is used.
33843
33844 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33845 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33846 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33847 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33848 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33849 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33850 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33851
33852 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33853 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33854 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33855 .endlist
33856
33857 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33858 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33859 &%-oe%& command line options.
33860
33861
33862
33863 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33864 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33865 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33866 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33867 want to do this, you must have the line
33868 .code
33869 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33870 .endd
33871 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33872 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33873 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33874 to define them.
33875
33876 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33877 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33878 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33879 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33880 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33881 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33882 .code
33883 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33884 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33885
33886 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33887 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33888 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33889 };
33890
33891 int local_scan_options_count =
33892 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33893 .endd
33894 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33895 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33896 .code
33897 begin local_scan
33898 my_integer = 99
33899 my_string = some string of text...
33900 .endd
33901 The available types of option data are as follows:
33902
33903 .vlist
33904 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33905 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33906 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33907 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33908 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33909 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33910 values.)
33911
33912 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33913 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33914 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33915 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33916
33917 .vitem &*opt_int*&
33918 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33919 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33920 Exim.
33921
33922 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33923 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33924 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33925 printed with the suffix K or M.
33926
33927 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33928 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33929 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33930 always output in octal.
33931
33932 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33933 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33934 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33935
33936 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33937 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33938 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33939 .endlist
33940
33941 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33942 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33943
33944
33945
33946 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33947 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33948 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33949 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33950 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33951 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33952 C variables are as follows:
33953
33954 .vlist
33955 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33956 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33957 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33958
33959 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33960 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33961 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33962
33963 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33964 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33965 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33966 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33967
33968 .ilist
33969 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33970 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33971 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33972
33973 .next
33974 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33975 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33976 of debugging bits.
33977 .endlist ilist
33978
33979 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33980 selected, you should use code like this:
33981 .code
33982 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33983 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33984 .endd
33985 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33986 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33987 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33988
33989 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33990 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33991 discussed below.
33992
33993 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33994 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33995
33996 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33997 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33998
33999 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34000 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34001 &%-bh%& command line option.
34002
34003 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34004 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34005 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34006
34007 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34008 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34009 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34010 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34011
34012 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34013 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34014 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34015
34016 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34017 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34018
34019 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34020 The number of accepted recipients.
34021
34022 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34023 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34024 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34025 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34026 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34027 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34028 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34029 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34030 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34031 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34032 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34033 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34034
34035 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34036 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34037
34038 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34039 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34040 locally-submitted messages.
34041
34042 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34043 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34044 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34045
34046 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34047 The name of the sending host, if known.
34048
34049 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34050 The port on the sending host.
34051
34052 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34053 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34054
34055 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34056 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34057
34058 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34059 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34060 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34061 .endlist
34062
34063
34064 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34065 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34066 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34067 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34068 their type to *.
34069
34070
34071 .vlist
34072 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34073 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34074
34075 .vitem &*int&~type*&
34076 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34077 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34078 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34079 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34080 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34081 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34082
34083 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
34084 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34085 internal newlines.
34086
34087 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34088 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34089 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34090 .endlist
34091
34092
34093
34094 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34095 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34096
34097 .vlist
34098 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34099 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34100
34101 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
34102 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34103 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34104 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34105
34106 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34107 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34108 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34109 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34110 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34111 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34112 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34113 is NULL for all recipients.
34114 .endlist
34115
34116
34117
34118 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34119 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34120 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34121 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34122 release:
34123
34124 .vlist
34125 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34126 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34127
34128 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34129 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34130 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34131 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34132
34133 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34134 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34135 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34136 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34137 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34138
34139 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34140
34141 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34142 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34143 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34144 return value is as follows:
34145
34146 .ilist
34147 >= 0
34148
34149 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34150 ending status.
34151
34152 .next
34153 < 0 and > &--256
34154
34155 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34156 signal number.
34157
34158 .next
34159 &--256
34160
34161 The process timed out.
34162 .next
34163 &--257
34164
34165 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34166 .endlist
34167
34168 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34169 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34170 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34171 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34172 forks a subprocess that is running
34173 .code
34174 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34175 .endd
34176 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34177 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34178 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34179 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34180
34181 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34182 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34183 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34184 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34185
34186
34187 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34188 *sender_authentication)*&
34189 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34190 that it runs is:
34191 .display
34192 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34193 .endd
34194 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34195
34196
34197 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34198 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34199 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34200 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34201 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34202 .code
34203 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34204 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34205 .endd
34206
34207 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34208 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34209 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34210 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34211 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34212 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34213 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34214 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34215
34216 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34217 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34218 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34219 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34220 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34221 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34222
34223 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34224 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34225 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34226 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34227
34228 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34229 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34230 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34231 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34232 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34233 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34234 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34235 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34236 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34237 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34238 .code
34239 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34240 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34241 .endd
34242 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34243 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34244
34245
34246 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34247 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34248 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34249 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34250 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34251
34252
34253 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34254 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34255 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34256 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34257 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34258 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34259 .code
34260 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34261 .endd
34262 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34263 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34264 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34265 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34266 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34267 zero-terminated.
34268
34269 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34270 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34271 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34272 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34273 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34274 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34275 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34276 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34277
34278 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34279 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34280 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34281 .display
34282 &`OK `& match succeeded
34283 &`FAIL `& match failed
34284 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34285 .endd
34286 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34287 inability to contact a database.
34288
34289 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34290 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34291 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34292 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34293 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34294
34295 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34296 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34297 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34298 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34299 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34300
34301 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34302 uschar&~*list)*&"
34303 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34304 expected to be
34305 .code
34306 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34307 .endd
34308 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34309 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34310 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34311 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34312 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34313 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34314 failed.
34315
34316 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34317 *format,&~...)*&"
34318 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34319 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34320 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34321 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34322 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34323 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34324
34325
34326 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34327 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34328 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34329 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34330
34331 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34332 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34333 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34334 value afterwards. For example:
34335 .code
34336 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34337 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34338 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34339 .endd
34340
34341 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34342 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34343 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34344 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34345 address.
34346 .endlist
34347
34348
34349 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34350 .vlist
34351 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34352 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34353 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34354 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34355 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34356 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34357 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34358 binary string is returned with an error message.
34359
34360 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34361 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34362 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34363
34364 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34365 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34366 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34367 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34368 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34369
34370 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34371 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34372 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34373
34374 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34375 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34376 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34377 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34378 with translation.
34379
34380
34381 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34382 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34383 below.
34384
34385 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34386 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34387 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34388 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34389 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34390 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34391 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34392 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34393 is involved.
34394
34395 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34396 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34397
34398 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34399 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34400 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34401 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34402
34403 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34404 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34405 ABI version number was incremented.
34406
34407 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34408 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34409 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34410 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34411 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34412 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34413 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34414 .code
34415 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34416 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34417 .endd
34418 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34419 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34420 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34421 multiple output lines.
34422
34423 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34424 does not
34425 guarantee a flush of
34426 pending output, and therefore does not test
34427 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34428 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34429 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34430 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34431 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34432 is an error.
34433
34434 .new
34435 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34436 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34437 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34438 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34439 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34440 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34441 Exim bombs out if it ever
34442 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34443 .wen
34444
34445 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34446 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34447 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34448
34449 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34450 See below.
34451
34452 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34453 See below.
34454
34455 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34456 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34457 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34458 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34459 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34460 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34461 more discussion.
34462 .endlist
34463
34464
34465
34466 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34467 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34468 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34469 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34470 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34471 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34472 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34473 terminates.
34474
34475 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34476 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34477 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34478 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34479
34480 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34481 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34482 .code
34483 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34484 .endd
34485 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34486 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34487 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34488 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34489
34490 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34491 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34492 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34493 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34494 &%store_pool%&.
34495 .ecindex IIDlosca
34496
34497
34498
34499
34500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34502
34503 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34504 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34505 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34506 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34507 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34508 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34509 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34510 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34511
34512 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34513 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34514 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34515 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34516 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34517
34518 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34519 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34520 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34521 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34522 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34523 prevent it happening on retries.
34524
34525 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34526 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34527 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34528 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34529 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34530 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34531 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34532 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34533
34534
34535 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34536 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34537 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34538 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34539 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34540 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34541 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34542 .code
34543 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34544 system_filter_user = exim
34545 .endd
34546 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34547 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34548 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34549 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34550 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34551 by the &%reply%& command.
34552
34553
34554 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34555 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34556 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34557 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34558
34559 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34560 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34561
34562
34563
34564 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34565 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34566 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34567 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34568 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34569 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34570 they cause errors.
34571
34572 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34573 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34574 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34575 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34576 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34577 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34578 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34579
34580 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34581 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34582 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34583 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34584 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34585
34586 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34587 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34588 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34589 to which users' filter files can refer.
34590
34591
34592
34593 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34594 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34595 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34596 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34597 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34598
34599
34600
34601 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34602 .cindex "freezing messages"
34603 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34604 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34605 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34606 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34607 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34608 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34609 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34610 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34611 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34612 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34613 .code
34614 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34615 .endd
34616 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34617
34618 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34619 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34620 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34621 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34622 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34623 run.
34624
34625 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34626 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34627 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34628 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34629
34630 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34631 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34632 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34633 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34634 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34635 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34636 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34637 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34638 message. For example:
34639 .code
34640 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34641 because it contains attachments that we are \
34642 not prepared to receive."
34643 .endd
34644
34645 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34646 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34647 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34648 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34649 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34650 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34651 use, for example
34652 .code
34653 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34654 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34655 .endd
34656 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34657 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34658 generated by the filter.
34659
34660 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34661 &%defer%&,
34662 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34663 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34664 as
34665 .code
34666 mail ...
34667 freeze
34668 .endd
34669 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34670 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34671 take place.
34672
34673
34674
34675 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34676 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34677 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34678 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34679 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34680 .code
34681 headers add <string>
34682 headers remove <string>
34683 .endd
34684 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34685 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34686 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34687 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34688 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34689
34690 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34691 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34692 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34693 example:
34694 .code
34695 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34696 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34697 X-header-2: ...."
34698 .endd
34699 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34700 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34701 space after input continuations is ignored.
34702
34703 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34704 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34705 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34706 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34707 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34708
34709 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34710 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34711 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34712 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34713 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34714 used for all recipients of the message.
34715
34716 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34717 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34718 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34719 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34720 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34721 until the message is actually being written (see section
34722 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34723
34724 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34725 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34726 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34727 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34728 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34729 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34730 modified more than once.
34731
34732 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34733 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34734 For example:
34735 .code
34736 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34737 headers remove "Subject"
34738 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34739 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34740 .endd
34741
34742
34743
34744 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34745 .cindex "envelope from"
34746 .cindex "envelope sender"
34747 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34748 .code
34749 errors_to <some address>
34750 .endd
34751 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34752 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34753 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34754 might use
34755 .code
34756 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34757 .endd
34758 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34759 address if its delivery failed.
34760
34761
34762
34763 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34764 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34765 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34766 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34767 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34768 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34769 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34770 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34771 which implements such a filter:
34772 .code
34773 central_filter:
34774 check_local_user
34775 driver = redirect
34776 domains = +local_domains
34777 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34778 no_verify
34779 allow_filter
34780 allow_freeze
34781 .endd
34782 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34783 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34784 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34785 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34786
34787 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34788 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34789 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34790 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34791 normal way.
34792 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34793 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34794 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34795
34796
34797
34798
34799
34800
34801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34803
34804 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34805 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34806 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34807 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34808 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34809 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34810 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34811 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34812
34813 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34814 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34815 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34816 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34817 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34818
34819 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34820 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34821 loopback interface specially in any way.
34822
34823 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34824 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34825
34826
34827
34828
34829 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34830 .cindex "message" "submission"
34831 .cindex "submission mode"
34832 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34833 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34834 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34835 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34836 .code
34837 control = submission
34838 .endd
34839 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34840 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34841 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34842 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34843 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34844 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34845 .code
34846 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34847 control = submission
34848 .endd
34849 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34850 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34851 is used to separate options. For example:
34852 .code
34853 control = submission/sender_retain
34854 .endd
34855 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34856 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34857 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34858 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34859 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34860 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34861 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34862
34863 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34864 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34865 example:
34866 .code
34867 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34868 .endd
34869 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34870 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34871 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34872 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34873 .code
34874 accept authenticated = *
34875 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34876 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34877 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34878 .endd
34879 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34880 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34881 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34882 .code
34883 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34884 .endd
34885 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34886 line would be:
34887 .code
34888 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34889 .endd
34890 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34891 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34892 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34893 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34894
34895 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34896 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34897 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34898 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34899 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34900 spoof another's address.
34901
34902 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34903 .cindex "line endings"
34904 .cindex "carriage return"
34905 .cindex "linefeed"
34906 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34907 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34908 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34909 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34910 use CRLF or just CR.
34911
34912 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34913 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34914 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34915 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34916 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34917 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34918 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34919 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34920 follows:
34921
34922 .ilist
34923 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34924 .next
34925 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34926 is ignored.
34927 .next
34928 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34929 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34930 terminator.
34931 .next
34932 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34933 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34934 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34935 people trying to play silly games.
34936 .next
34937 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34938 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34939 line.
34940 .endlist
34941
34942
34943
34944
34945
34946 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34947 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34948 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34949 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34950 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34951 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34952 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34953 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34954
34955 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34956 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34957 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34958 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34959 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34960
34961 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34962 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34963 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34964 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34965 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34966 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34967 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34968 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34969
34970
34971
34972
34973 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34974 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34975 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34976 .cindex "sender" "address"
34977 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34978 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34979 .cindex "envelope from"
34980 .cindex "envelope sender"
34981 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34982 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34983 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34984 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34985 .code
34986 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34987 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34988 .endd
34989 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34990 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34991 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34992 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34993 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34994 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34995 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34996 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34997 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34998
34999 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35000 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35001 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35002 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35003 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35004 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35005 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35006
35007 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35008 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35009 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35010
35011 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35012 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35013 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35014 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35015
35016
35017
35018 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35019 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35020 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35021 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35022 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35023 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35024 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35025 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35026
35027 .blockquote
35028 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35029 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35030 .endblockquote
35031
35032 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35033 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35034 follows:
35035
35036 .ilist
35037 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35038 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35039 .next
35040 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35041 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35042 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35043 .next
35044 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35045 also removed.
35046 .next
35047 For a locally-submitted message,
35048 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35049 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35050 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35051 included in log lines in this case.
35052 .next
35053 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35054 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35055 .endlist
35056
35057
35058
35059
35060 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35061 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35062 includes the header line:
35063 .code
35064 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35065 .endd
35066
35067 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35068 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35069 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35070 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35071 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35072 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35073
35074
35075 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35076 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35077 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35078 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35079 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35080 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35081
35082 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35083 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35084 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35085 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35086 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35087 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35088 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35089 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35090 messages.
35091
35092
35093 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35094 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35095 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35096 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35097 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35098 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35099 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35100 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35101 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35102 messages.
35103
35104
35105 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35106 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35107 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
35108 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35109 .cindex "message" "submission"
35110 .cindex "submission mode"
35111 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35112 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35113
35114 .ilist
35115 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35116 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35117 .next
35118 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35119 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35120 .olist
35121 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35122 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35123 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35124 .next
35125 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35126 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35127 .next
35128 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35129 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35130 .endlist
35131 .endlist
35132
35133 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35134
35135 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35136 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35137 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35138 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35139 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35140 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35141 &%qualify_domain%&.
35142
35143 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35144 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35145 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35146 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35147
35148
35149 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35150 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35151 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35152 .cindex "message" "submission"
35153 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35154 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35155 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35156 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35157 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35158 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35159 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35160 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35161 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35162 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35163
35164
35165 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35166 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35167 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35168 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35169 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35170 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35171
35172 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35173 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35174 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35175 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35176
35177 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35178 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35179 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35180
35181
35182 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35183 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35184 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35185 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35186 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35187 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35188 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35189 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35190 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35191 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35192 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35193 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35194
35195
35196
35197 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35198 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35199 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35200 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35201 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35202 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35203 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35204 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35205 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35206
35207
35208
35209 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35210 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35211 .cindex "message" "submission"
35212 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35213 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35214 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35215 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35216 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35217 control setting.
35218
35219 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35220 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35221 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35222 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35223 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35224 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35225 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35226 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35227 line is added to the message.
35228
35229 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35230 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35231 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35232 options true at the same time.
35233
35234 .cindex "submission mode"
35235 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35236 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35237 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35238 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35239
35240 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35241 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35242 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35243 created as follows:
35244
35245 .ilist
35246 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35247 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35248 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35249 .next
35250 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35251 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35252 .next
35253 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35254 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35255 .endlist
35256
35257 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35258 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35259 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35260 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35261
35262 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35263 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35264 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35265 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35266
35267
35268
35269 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35270 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35271 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35272 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35273 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35274 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35275 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35276 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35277 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35278
35279 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35280 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35281 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35282 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35283 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35284 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35285
35286 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35287 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35288 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35289
35290 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35291 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35292 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35293 .code
35294 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35295 X-added-second: another added header line
35296 .endd
35297 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35298
35299 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35300 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35301 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35302
35303 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35304 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35305 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35306 not part of the names. For example:
35307 .code
35308 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35309 .endd
35310
35311 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35312 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35313 Each item is separately expanded.
35314 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35315 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35316 will act as list separators.
35317
35318 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35319 items are expanded at routing time,
35320 and then associated with all addresses that are
35321 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35322 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35323 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35324
35325 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35326 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35327 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35328 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35329
35330 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35331 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35332 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35333 requirements.
35334
35335 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35336 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35337 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35338 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35339 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35340 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35341 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35342
35343 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35344 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35345 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35346 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35347
35348 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35349 the following consequences:
35350
35351 .ilist
35352 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35353 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35354 to it, at all times.
35355 .next
35356 Header lines that are added by a router's
35357 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35358 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35359 .next
35360 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35361 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35362 .next
35363 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35364 a later router or by a transport.
35365 .next
35366 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35367 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35368 .code
35369 headers_remove = subject
35370 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35371 .endd
35372 .endlist
35373
35374 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35375 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35376
35377
35378
35379
35380
35381 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35382 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35383 .cindex "constructed address"
35384 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35385 the form
35386 .display
35387 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35388 .endd
35389 For example:
35390 .code
35391 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35392 .endd
35393 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35394 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35395 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35396 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35397 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35398 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35399 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35400 there is no password file entry.
35401
35402 .cindex "RFC 2047"
35403 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35404 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35405 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35406 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35407 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35408 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35409 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35410 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35411
35412
35413
35414 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35415 .cindex "case of local parts"
35416 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35417 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35418 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35419 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35420 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35421 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35422 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35423 router option.
35424
35425 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35426 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35427 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35428 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35429 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35430 .code
35431 correct_case:
35432 driver = redirect
35433 domains = +local_domains
35434 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35435 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35436 @$domain
35437 .endd
35438 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35439 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35440 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35441 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35442 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35443
35444
35445
35446 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35447 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35448 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35449 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35450 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35451 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35452 empty components for compatibility.
35453
35454
35455
35456 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35457 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35458 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35459 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35460 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35461 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35462
35463 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35464 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35465 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35466 example, a header such as
35467 .code
35468 To: hare@teaparty
35469 .endd
35470 might get rewritten as
35471 .code
35472 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35473 .endd
35474 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35475 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35476 been routed.
35477
35478 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35479 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35480 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35481 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35482 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35483 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35484 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35485
35486
35487
35488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35490
35491 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35492 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35493 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35494 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35495 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35496 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35497 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35498
35499 .ilist
35500 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35501 .next
35502 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35503 .next
35504 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35505 .endlist
35506
35507 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35508
35509 .ilist
35510 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35511 .next
35512 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35513 &"lmtp"&);
35514 .next
35515 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35516 transport);
35517 .next
35518 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35519 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35520 .endlist
35521
35522 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35523 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35524 used to contain the envelope information.
35525
35526
35527
35528 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35529 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35530 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35531 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35532 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35533 .cindex "EHLO"
35534 .cindex "HELO"
35535 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35536 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35537 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35538 processing is the same in both cases.
35539
35540 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35541 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35542 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35543 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35544 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35545 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35546 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35547 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35548 suppressed.
35549
35550 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35551 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35552 required for the transaction.
35553
35554 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35555 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35556 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35557 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35558 is called for verification.
35559
35560 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35561 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35562 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35563
35564 .cindex "carriage return"
35565 .cindex "linefeed"
35566 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35567 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35568 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35569 line terminator.
35570
35571 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35572 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35573 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35574 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35575 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35576 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35577 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35578 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35579 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35580
35581 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35582 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35583 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35584 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35585
35586 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35587 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35588 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35589 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35590
35591 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35592 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35593 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35594 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35595 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35596 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35597 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35598 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35599 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35600 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35601
35602 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35603 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35604
35605 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35606 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35607 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35608 square bracket of the IP address.
35609
35610
35611
35612
35613 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35614 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35615 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35616 .cindex "host" "error"
35617 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35618 message errors, and recipient errors.
35619
35620 .vlist
35621 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35622 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35623 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35624
35625 .ilist
35626 Connection refused or timed out,
35627 .next
35628 Any error response code on connection,
35629 .next
35630 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35631 .next
35632 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35633 .next
35634 I/O errors at any time,
35635 .next
35636 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35637 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35638 .endlist ilist
35639
35640 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35641 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35642 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35643 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35644 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35645 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35646 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35647 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35648
35649 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35650 .cindex "message" "error"
35651 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35652 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35653 message errors are:
35654
35655 .ilist
35656 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35657 the data,
35658 .next
35659 Timeout after MAIL,
35660 .next
35661 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35662 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35663 connection at any other time.
35664 .endlist ilist
35665
35666 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35667 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35668 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35669 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35670 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35671 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35672 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35673 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35674 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35675 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35676
35677 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35678 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35679 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35680 response to MAIL.
35681
35682 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35683 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35684 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35685 recipient errors are:
35686
35687 .ilist
35688 Any error response to RCPT,
35689 .next
35690 Timeout after RCPT.
35691 .endlist
35692
35693 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35694 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35695 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35696 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35697 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35698 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35699 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35700 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35701 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35702 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35703 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35704 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35705 the retry clock is reset.
35706
35707 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35708 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35709 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35710 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35711 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35712 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35713 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35714 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35715 recipient's retry time.
35716 .endlist
35717
35718 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35719 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35720 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35721 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35722 until the next delivery attempt.
35723
35724 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35725 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35726 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35727 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35728 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35729 is created.
35730
35731 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35732 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35733 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35734 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35735 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35736 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35737 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35738
35739 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35740 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35741 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35742 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35743 then to be treated as a host error.
35744
35745 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35746 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35747 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35748 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35749 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35750
35751
35752
35753
35754 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35755 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35756 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35757 .cindex "inetd"
35758 .cindex "daemon"
35759 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35760 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35761 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35762 .code
35763 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35764 .endd
35765 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35766 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35767 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35768 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35769 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35770 stream and exits with an error code.
35771
35772 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35773 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35774 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35775 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35776
35777 .cindex "carriage return"
35778 .cindex "linefeed"
35779 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35780 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35781 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35782 line terminator.
35783 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35784 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35785 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35786
35787 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35788 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35789 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35790 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35791 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35792 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35793 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35794 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35795
35796 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35797 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35798 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35799 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35800 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35801 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35802 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35803 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35804 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35805
35806 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35807 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35808 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35809
35810 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35811 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35812 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35813 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35814 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35815
35816 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35817 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35818 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35819 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35820 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35821 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35822 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35823
35824 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35825 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35826 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35827 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35828 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35829
35830 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35831 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35832 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35833 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35834 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35835 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35836 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35837 a delivery process.
35838
35839 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35840 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35841 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35842 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35843 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35844
35845 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35846 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35847 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35848 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35849
35850 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35851 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35852 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35853
35854
35855
35856 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35857 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35858 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35859 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35860 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35861 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35862 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35863 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35864
35865
35866 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35867 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35868 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35869 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35870 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35871 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35872 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35873 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35874 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35875 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35876 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35877
35878
35879
35880 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35881 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35882 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35883 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35884 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35885 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35886 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35887 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35888
35889 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35890 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35891 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35892 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35893 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35894 counted.
35895
35896 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35897 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35898 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35899
35900 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35901 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35902 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35903 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35904 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35905
35906
35907
35908
35909 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35910 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35911 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35912 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35913
35914 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35915 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35916 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35917 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35918 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35919 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35920 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35921 SMTP response codes.
35922
35923 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35924 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35925 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35926 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35927 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35928 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35929 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35930 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35931 RCPT failures.
35932
35933
35934
35935 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35936 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35937 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35938 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35939 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35940 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35941 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35942
35943 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35944 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35945 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35946 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35947 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35948 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35949 argument. For example,
35950 .code
35951 ETRN #brigadoon
35952 .endd
35953 runs the command
35954 .code
35955 exim -R brigadoon
35956 .endd
35957 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35958 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35959 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35960 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35961 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35962
35963 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35964 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35965 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35966 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35967 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35968 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35969 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35970 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35971
35972 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35973 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35974 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35975 whatever the form of its argument. For
35976 example:
35977 .code
35978 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35979 $sender_host_address
35980 .endd
35981 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35982 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35983 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35984 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35985 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35986 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35987 for it to change them before running the command.
35988
35989
35990
35991 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35992 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35993 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35994 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35995 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35996 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35997 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35998 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35999 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36000 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36001 runs for RCPT commands:
36002 .code
36003 accept hosts = :
36004 .endd
36005 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36006
36007
36008
36009 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36010 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36011 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
36012 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36013 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36014 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36015 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36016 envelope along with the message.
36017
36018 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36019 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36020 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36021 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36022 can be used to specify it.
36023
36024 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36025 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36026 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36027 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36028 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36029
36030 .vindex "&$host$&"
36031 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36032 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36033 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36034 router:
36035 .code
36036 begin routers
36037 route_append:
36038 driver = manualroute
36039 transport = smtp_appendfile
36040 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36041
36042 begin transports
36043 smtp_appendfile:
36044 driver = appendfile
36045 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36046 batch_max = 1000
36047 use_bsmtp
36048 user = exim
36049 .endd
36050 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36051 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36052 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36053
36054
36055
36056 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36057 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36058 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
36059 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36060 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36061 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36062 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36063 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36064 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36065 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36066
36067 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36068 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36069
36070 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36071 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36072 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36073 make some use of automatically, for example:
36074 .code
36075 554 Unexpected end of file
36076 Transaction started in line 10
36077 Error detected in line 14
36078 .endd
36079 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36080 file, for example:
36081 .code
36082 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36083 The error message was:
36084
36085 501 '>' missing at end of address
36086
36087 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36088 The error was detected in line 12.
36089 The SMTP command at fault was:
36090
36091 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36092
36093 1 previous message was successfully processed.
36094 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36095 .endd
36096 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36097 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36098 accepted.
36099 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36100 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36101
36102
36103
36104 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36106
36107 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36108 "Customizing messages"
36109 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36110 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36111 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36112 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36113 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36114
36115 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36116 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36117 option. Exim also adds the line
36118 .code
36119 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36120 .endd
36121 to all warning and bounce messages,
36122
36123
36124 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36125 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36126 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36127 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36128 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36129 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36130 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36131
36132 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36133 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36134 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36135 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36136 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36137 item.
36138
36139 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36140 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36141 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36142 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36143 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36144 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36145 option, rounded to a whole number.
36146
36147 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36148
36149 .ilist
36150 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36151 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36152 .next
36153 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36154 failing addresses with their error messages.
36155 .next
36156 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36157 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36158 .next
36159 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36160 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36161 .endlist
36162
36163 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36164 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36165 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36166 .code
36167 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36168 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36169 {: returning message to sender}}
36170 ****
36171 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36172
36173 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36174 {that you sent }{sent by
36175
36176 <$sender_address>
36177
36178 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36179 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36180 ****
36181 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36182 ****
36183 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36184 ------
36185 ****
36186 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36187 only the first
36188 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36189 ****
36190 .endd
36191 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36192 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36193 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36194 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36195 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36196 text sections:
36197
36198 .ilist
36199 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36200 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36201 .next
36202 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36203 the delayed addresses.
36204 .next
36205 The third item then ends the message.
36206 .endlist
36207
36208 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36209 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36210 .code
36211 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36212 $warn_message_delay
36213 ****
36214 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36215
36216 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36217 {that you sent }{sent by
36218
36219 <$sender_address>
36220
36221 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36222 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36223
36224 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36225 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36226 The date of the message is: $h_date
36227
36228 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36229 ****
36230 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36231 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36232 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36233 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36234 the message will be returned to you.
36235 .endd
36236 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36237 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36238 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36239 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36240 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36241 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36242 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36243 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36244 handled them.
36245
36246
36247
36248
36249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36251
36252 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36253 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36254 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36255
36256
36257
36258 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36259 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36260 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36261 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36262 routing explicitly:
36263 .code
36264 send_to_smart_host:
36265 driver = manualroute
36266 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36267 transport = remote_smtp
36268 .endd
36269 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36270 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36271 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36272 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36273 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36274
36275
36276
36277
36278 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36279 .cindex "mailing lists"
36280 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36281 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36282 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36283
36284 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36285 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36286 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36287 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36288 .code
36289 lists:
36290 driver = redirect
36291 domains = lists.example
36292 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36293 forbid_pipe
36294 forbid_file
36295 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36296 no_more
36297 .endd
36298 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36299 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36300 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36301 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36302
36303 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36304 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36305 a mailing list.
36306
36307 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36308 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36309 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36310 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36311 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36312
36313 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36314 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36315 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36316 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36317 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36318 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36319 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36320 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36321 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36322
36323
36324
36325 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36326 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36327 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36328 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36329 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36330 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36331 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36332
36333 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36334 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36335 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36336 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36337 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36338
36339
36340
36341 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36342 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36343 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36344 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36345 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36346 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36347 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36348 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36349 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36350 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36351
36352 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36353 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36354 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36355 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36356 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36357 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36358 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36359 pre-existing messages.
36360
36361 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36362 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36363 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36364 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36365 one level of expansion anyway.
36366
36367
36368
36369 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36370 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36371 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36372 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36373 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36374 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36375
36376 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36377 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36378 .code
36379 lists_request:
36380 driver = redirect
36381 domains = lists.example
36382 local_part_suffix = -request
36383 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36384 no_more
36385
36386 lists_post:
36387 driver = redirect
36388 domains = lists.example
36389 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36390 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36391 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36392 forbid_pipe
36393 forbid_file
36394 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36395 no_more
36396
36397 lists_closed:
36398 driver = redirect
36399 domains = lists.example
36400 allow_fail
36401 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36402 .endd
36403 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36404 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36405 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36406 mailing list.
36407
36408 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36409 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36410 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36411 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36412 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36413 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36414 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36415 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36416 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36417
36418 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36419 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36420 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36421
36422
36423
36424
36425 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36426 .cindex "VERP"
36427 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36428 .cindex "envelope from"
36429 .cindex "envelope sender"
36430 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36431 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36432 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36433 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36434 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36435 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36436
36437 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36438 .oindex &%return_path%&
36439 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36440 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36441 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36442 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36443 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36444 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36445 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36446 .code
36447 verp_smtp:
36448 driver = smtp
36449 max_rcpt = 1
36450 return_path = \
36451 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36452 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36453 .endd
36454 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36455 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36456 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36457 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36458 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36459 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36460 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36461 rewritten as
36462 .code
36463 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36464 .endd
36465 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36466 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36467 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36468 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36469 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36470 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36471
36472 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36473 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36474 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36475 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36476 .code
36477 dnslookup:
36478 driver = dnslookup
36479 domains = ! +local_domains
36480 transport = \
36481 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36482 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36483 no_more
36484 .endd
36485 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36486 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36487 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36488 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36489 address.
36490
36491 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36492 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36493 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36494 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36495 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36496 .code
36497 verp_dnslookup:
36498 driver = dnslookup
36499 domains = ! +local_domains
36500 transport = remote_smtp
36501 errors_to = \
36502 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36503 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36504 no_more
36505 .endd
36506 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36507 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36508 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36509 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36510 them.
36511
36512 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36513 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36514 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36515 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36516 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36517 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36518 used).
36519
36520
36521
36522
36523
36524
36525 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36526 .cindex "virtual domains"
36527 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36528 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36529 meanings:
36530
36531 .ilist
36532 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36533 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36534 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36535 .next
36536 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36537 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36538 have login accounts on that host.
36539 .endlist
36540
36541 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36542 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36543 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36544 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36545 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36546 to a router of this form:
36547 .code
36548 virtual:
36549 driver = redirect
36550 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36551 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36552 no_more
36553 .endd
36554 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36555 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36556 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36557 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36558 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36559 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36560
36561 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36562 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36563 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36564 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36565
36566 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36567 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36568 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36569 .code
36570 my_domains:
36571 driver = accept
36572 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36573 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36574 transport = my_mailboxes
36575 .endd
36576 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36577 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36578 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36579 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36580 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36581 follows:
36582 .code
36583 my_mailboxes:
36584 driver = appendfile
36585 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36586 user = mail
36587 .endd
36588 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36589 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36590
36591 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36592 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36593 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36594 information about the domains.
36595
36596
36597
36598 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36599 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36600 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36601 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36602 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36603 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36604 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36605 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36606 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36607 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36608 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36609 example, consider this router:
36610 .code
36611 userforward:
36612 driver = redirect
36613 check_local_user
36614 file = $home/.forward
36615 local_part_suffix = -*
36616 local_part_suffix_optional
36617 allow_filter
36618 .endd
36619 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36620 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36621 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36622 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36623 .code
36624 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36625 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36626 endif
36627 .endd
36628 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36629 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36630 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36631 control over which suffixes are valid.
36632
36633 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36634 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36635 another MTA:
36636 .code
36637 userforward:
36638 driver = redirect
36639 check_local_user
36640 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36641 local_part_suffix = -*
36642 local_part_suffix_optional
36643 allow_filter
36644 .endd
36645 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36646 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36647 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36648 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36649 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36650
36651
36652
36653 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36654 .cindex "vacation processing"
36655 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36656 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36657 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36658 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36659 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36660
36661 .ilist
36662 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36663 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36664 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36665 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36666 .code
36667 spqr, vacation-spqr
36668 .endd
36669 .next
36670 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36671 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36672 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36673 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36674 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36675 message.
36676 .endlist
36677
36678 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36679 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36680
36681
36682
36683 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36684 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36685 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36686 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36687 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36688 each day's messages.
36689
36690 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36691 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36692 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36693 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36694
36695
36696
36697 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36698 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36699 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36700 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36701 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36702 permanently connected.
36703
36704 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36705 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36706 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36707
36708
36709 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36710 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36711 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36712 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36713 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36714 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36715 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36716 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36717
36718 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36719 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36720 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36721 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36722 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36723 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36724 if required.
36725
36726 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36727 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36728 intermittent host. For example:
36729 .code
36730 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36731 .endd
36732 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36733 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36734 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36735 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36736 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36737 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36738 immediately.
36739
36740 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36741 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36742 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36743 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36744 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36745 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36746 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36747
36748
36749
36750 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36751 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36752 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36753 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36754 delivered immediately.
36755
36756 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36757 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36758 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36759 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36760 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36761 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36762 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36763 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36764 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36765 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36766 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36767 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36768 single SMTP connection.
36769
36770
36771
36772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36774
36775 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36776 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36777 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36778 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36779 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36780 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36781 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36782 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36783 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36784 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36785 messages this way.
36786
36787 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36788 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36789 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36790 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36791 email is not desirable.
36792
36793 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36794 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36795 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36796 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36797 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36798 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36799 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36800
36801 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36802 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36803 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36804 before sending a message to the smart host.
36805
36806 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36807 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36808 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36809
36810 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36811 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36812 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36813 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36814 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36815 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36816 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36817
36818 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36819 following ways:
36820
36821 .ilist
36822 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36823 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36824 .next
36825 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36826 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36827 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36828 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36829 successful, a zero return code is given.
36830 .next
36831 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36832 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36833 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36834 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36835 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36836 are.
36837 .next
36838 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36839 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36840 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36841 .next
36842 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36843 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36844 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36845 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36846 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36847 .next
36848 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36849 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36850 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36851 .next
36852 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36853 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36854 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36855 are ever generated.
36856 .next
36857 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36858 .next
36859 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36860 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36861 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36862 .endlist
36863
36864 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36865 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36866 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36867 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36868 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36869 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36870
36871
36872
36873
36874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36876
36877 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36878 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36879 .cindex "log" "types of"
36880 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36881 and the panic log:
36882
36883 .ilist
36884 .cindex "main log"
36885 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36886 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36887 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36888 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36889 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36890 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36891 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36892 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36893 .next
36894 .cindex "reject log"
36895 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36896 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36897 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36898 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36899 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36900 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36901 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36902 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36903 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36904 false.
36905 .next
36906 .cindex "panic log"
36907 .cindex "system log"
36908 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36909 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36910 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36911 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36912 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36913 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36914 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36915 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36916 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36917 .endlist
36918
36919 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36920 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36921 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36922 .code
36923 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36924 by QUIT
36925 .endd
36926 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36927 ways of changing this:
36928
36929 .ilist
36930 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36931 you set
36932 .code
36933 timezone = UTC
36934 .endd
36935 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36936 .next
36937 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36938 example:
36939 .code
36940 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36941 .endd
36942 .endlist
36943
36944 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36945 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36946 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36947 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36948 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36949 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36950
36951
36952
36953
36954 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36955 .cindex "log" "destination"
36956 .cindex "log" "to file"
36957 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36958 .cindex "syslog"
36959 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36960 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36961 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36962 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36963 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36964 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36965 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36966
36967 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36968 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36969 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36970 references to the host name:
36971 .code
36972 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36973 .endd
36974 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36975 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36976 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36977 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36978 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36979 log at all.
36980
36981 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36982 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36983 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36984 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36985 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36986 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36987 implying the use of a default path.
36988
36989 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36990 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36991 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36992 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36993 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36994 equivalent to the setting:
36995 .code
36996 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36997 .endd
36998 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36999 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37000 that is where the logs are written.
37001
37002 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37003 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37004
37005 Here are some examples of possible settings:
37006 .display
37007 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37008 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37009 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37010 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37011 .endd
37012 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37013 error is logged.
37014
37015
37016
37017 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37018 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37019 .cindex "cycling logs"
37020 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37021 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37022 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37023 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37024 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37025 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37026 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37027
37028 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37029 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37030 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37031 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37032 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37033 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37034 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37035 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37036 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37037 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37038 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37039 renamed.
37040
37041
37042
37043 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37044 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37045 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37046 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37047 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37048 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37049 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37050 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37051 .code
37052 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37053 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37054 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37055 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37056 .endd
37057 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37058 examples of names generated by the above examples:
37059 .code
37060 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37061 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37062 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37063 /var/log/exim/main.200212
37064 .endd
37065 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37066 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37067 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37068 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37069
37070 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37071 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37072 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37073 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37074 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37075 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37076 log names:
37077 .code
37078 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37079 /var/log/exim-panic.log
37080 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37081 /var/log/exim/panic
37082 .endd
37083
37084
37085 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37086 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37087 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37088 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37089 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37090 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37091 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37092 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37093 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37094 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37095 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37096 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37097 the time and host name to each line.
37098 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37099
37100 .ilist
37101 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37102 .next
37103 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37104 .next
37105 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37106 .endlist
37107
37108 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37109 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37110 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37111 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37112
37113 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37114 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37115 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37116 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37117 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37118 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37119 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37120 RFC 3164, you should set
37121 .code
37122 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37123 .endd
37124 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37125 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37126
37127 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37128 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37129 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37130 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37131 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37132 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37133 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37134 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37135 name, and pid as added by syslog:
37136 .code
37137 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37138 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37139 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37140 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37141 [5/5] mple>)
37142 .endd
37143 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37144 (LOG_NOTICE):
37145 .code
37146 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37147 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37148 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37149 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37150 [5\18] .example>)
37151 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37152 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37153 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37154 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37155 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37156 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37157 [12\18] F From: <>
37158 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37159 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37160 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37161 [16\18] le>
37162 [17\18] B Bcc:
37163 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37164 .endd
37165 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37166 without modification.
37167
37168 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37169 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37170 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37171 where it is.
37172
37173
37174
37175 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37176 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37177 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37178 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37179 timestamp. The flags are:
37180 .display
37181 &`<=`& message arrival
37182 &`(=`& message fakereject
37183 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37184 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37185 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37186 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37187 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37188 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37189 .endd
37190
37191
37192 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37193 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37194 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37195 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37196 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37197 .code
37198 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37199 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37200 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37201 .endd
37202 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37203 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37204 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37205 .code
37206 R=<message id>
37207 .endd
37208 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37209
37210 .cindex "HELO"
37211 .cindex "EHLO"
37212 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37213 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37214 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37215 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37216 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37217 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37218 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37219 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37220 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37221 name in parentheses.
37222
37223 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37224 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37225 the log containing text like these examples:
37226 .code
37227 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37228 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37229 .endd
37230 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37231 on.
37232
37233 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37234 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37235 of Exim.
37236
37237 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37238 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37239 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37240 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37241 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37242 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37243 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37244 suite that was used.
37245
37246 .cindex log protocol
37247 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37248 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37249 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37250 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37251 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37252 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37253 authenticator name.
37254
37255 .cindex "size" "of message"
37256 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37257 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37258 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37259 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37260 other).
37261
37262 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37263 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37264
37265
37266
37267 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37268 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37269 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37270 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37271 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37272 to fit it on the page:
37273 .code
37274 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37275 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37276 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37277 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37278 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37279 .endd
37280 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37281 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37282 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37283 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37284 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37285
37286 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37287 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37288 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37289 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37290
37291 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37292 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37293 .display
37294 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37295 .endd
37296 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37297 parentheses afterwards.
37298
37299 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37300 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37301 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37302 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37303 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37304 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37305 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37306 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37307 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37308 TLS cipher information is still available.
37309
37310 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37311 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37312 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37313 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37314 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37315
37316 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37317 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37318
37319 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37320 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37321
37322
37323 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37324 .cindex "discarded messages"
37325 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37326 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37327 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37328 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37329 .code
37330 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37331 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37332 .endd
37333 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37334 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37335 .code
37336 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37337 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37338 .endd
37339
37340
37341 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37342 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37343 .code
37344 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37345 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37346 .endd
37347 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37348 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37349 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37350 .code
37351 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37352 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37353 .endd
37354 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37355 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37356 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37357
37358
37359
37360 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37361 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37362 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37363 following form is logged:
37364 .code
37365 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37366 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37367 .endd
37368 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37369 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37370 .code
37371 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37372 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37373 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37374 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37375 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37376 .endd
37377 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37378 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37379 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37380 flagged with &`**`&.
37381
37382
37383
37384 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37385 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37386 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37387 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37388 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37389
37390
37391
37392 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37393 A line of the form
37394 .code
37395 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37396 .endd
37397 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37398 at the end of its processing.
37399
37400
37401
37402
37403 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37404 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37405 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37406 the following table:
37407 .display
37408 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37409 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37410 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37411 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37412 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37413 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37414 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37415 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37416 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37417 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37418 &`H `& host name and IP address
37419 &`I `& local interface used
37420 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37421 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37422 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37423 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37424 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37425 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37426 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37427 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37428 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37429 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37430 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37431 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37432 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37433 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37434 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37435 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37436 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37437 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37438 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37439 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37440 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37441 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37442 .endd
37443
37444
37445 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37446 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37447 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37448
37449 .ilist
37450 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37451 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37452 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37453 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37454 during the first delivery attempt.
37455 .next
37456 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37457 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37458 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37459 .next
37460 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37461 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37462 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37463 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37464 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37465 doing.
37466 .next
37467 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37468 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37469 message:
37470 .olist
37471 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37472 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37473 .next
37474 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37475 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37476 .next
37477 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37478 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37479 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37480 .code
37481 errors_to = <>
37482 .endd
37483 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37484 .endlist olist
37485 .next
37486 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37487 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37488 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37489 .endlist ilist
37490
37491
37492
37493
37494
37495 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37496 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37497 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37498 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37499 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37500 example:
37501 .code
37502 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37503 .endd
37504 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37505 selection marked by asterisks:
37506 .display
37507 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37508 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37509 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37510 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37511 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37512 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37513 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37514 &` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37515 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37516 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37517 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37518 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37519 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37520 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37521 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37522 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37523 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37524 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37525 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37526 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37527 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37528 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37529 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37530 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37531 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37532 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37533 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37534 &` pid `& Exim process id
37535 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37536 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37537 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37538 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37539 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37540 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37541 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37542 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37543 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37544 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37545 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37546 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37547 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37548 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37549 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37550 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37551 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37552 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37553 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37554 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37555 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37556 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37557 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37558 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37559 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37560
37561 &` all `& all of the above
37562 .endd
37563 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37564 section &<<SECID99>>&
37565
37566 More details on each of these items follows:
37567
37568 .ilist
37569 .cindex "8BITMIME"
37570 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37571 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37572 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37573 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37574 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37575 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37576 .next
37577 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37578 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37579 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37580 this log selector is set.
37581 .next
37582 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37583 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37584 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37585 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37586 such users cannot access the log).
37587 .next
37588 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37589 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37590 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37591 parentheses between them.
37592 .next
37593 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37594 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37595 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37596 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37597 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37598 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37599 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37600 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37601 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37602 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37603 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37604 between the caller and Exim.
37605 .next
37606 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37607 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37608 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37609 .next
37610 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37611 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37612 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37613 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37614 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37615 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37616 .next
37617 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37618 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37619 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37620 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37621 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37622 .next
37623 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37624 .cindex "size" "of message"
37625 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37626 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37627 .next
37628 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37629 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37630 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37631 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37632 .next
37633 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37634 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37635 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37636 .next
37637 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37638 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37639 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37640 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37641 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37642 .next
37643 .cindex log dnssec
37644 .cindex dnssec logging
37645 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37646 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37647 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37648 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37649 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37650 .next
37651 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37652 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37653 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37654 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37655 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37656 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37657 .next
37658 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37659 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37660 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37661 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37662 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37663 .next
37664 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37665 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37666 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37667 client's ident port times out.
37668 .next
37669 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37670 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37671 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37672 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37673 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37674 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37675 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37676 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37677 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37678 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37679 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37680 .next
37681 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37682 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37683 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37684 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37685 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37686 on a proxied connection
37687 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37688 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37689 .next
37690 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37691 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37692 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37693 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37694 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37695 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37696 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37697 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37698 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37699 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37700 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37701 .next
37702 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37703 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37704 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37705 .next
37706 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37707 .cindex millisecond logging
37708 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37709 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37710 appended to the seconds value.
37711 .next
37712 .cindex "log" "message id"
37713 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37714 .next
37715 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37716 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37717 (submission mode) without one.
37718 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37719 .next
37720 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37721 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37722 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37723 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37724 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37725 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37726 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37727 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37728 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37729 .next
37730 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37731 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37732 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37733 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37734 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37735 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37736 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37737 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37738 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37739 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37740 .next
37741 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37742 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37743 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37744 immediately after the time and date.
37745 .next
37746 .cindex log pipelining
37747 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37748 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37749 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37750 The field is a single "L".
37751
37752 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37753 the field has a minus appended.
37754
37755 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37756 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37757 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37758 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37759 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37760
37761 .next
37762 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37763 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37764 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37765 .next
37766 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37767 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37768 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37769 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37770 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37771 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37772 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37773 message has been successfully received.
37774 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37775 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37776 .next
37777 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37778 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37779 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37780 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37781 .next
37782 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37783 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37784 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37785 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37786 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37787 .next
37788 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37789 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37790 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37791 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37792 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37793 has taken place.
37794 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37795 in the list.
37796 .next
37797 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37798 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37799 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37800 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37801 .next
37802 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37803 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37804 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37805 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37806 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37807 .next
37808 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37809 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37810 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37811 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37812 attempt.
37813 .next
37814 .cindex "log" "return path"
37815 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37816 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37817 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37818 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37819 .next
37820 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37821 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37822 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37823 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37824 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37825 .next
37826 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37827 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37828 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37829 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37830 detail is lost.
37831 .next
37832 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37833 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37834 it is too big.
37835 .next
37836 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37837 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37838 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37839 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37840 it.
37841 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37842 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37843 .next
37844 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37845 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37846 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37847 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37848 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37849 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37850 response.
37851 .next
37852 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37853 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37854 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37855 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37856 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37857 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37858 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37859 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37860 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37861 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37862
37863 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37864 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37865 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37866 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37867 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37868 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37869 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37870 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37871 .next
37872 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37873 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37874 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37875 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37876 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37877 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37878 .next
37879 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37880 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37881 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37882 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37883 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37884 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37885 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37886 already have their own log lines.
37887
37888 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37889 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37890 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37891 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37892 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37893 the same logging options.
37894
37895 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37896 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37897 .code
37898 C=EHLO,QUIT
37899 .endd
37900 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37901 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37902 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37903 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37904 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37905 .next
37906 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37907 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37908 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37909 was accepted or used.
37910 .next
37911 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37912 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37913 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37914 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37915 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37916 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37917 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37918 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37919 .next
37920 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37921 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37922 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37923 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37924 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37925 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37926 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37927 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37928 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37929 .next
37930 .cindex "log" "subject"
37931 .cindex "subject, logging"
37932 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37933 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37934 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37935 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37936 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37937 .next
37938 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37939 .cindex log DANE
37940 .cindex DANE logging
37941 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37942 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37943 verified
37944 using a CA trust anchor,
37945 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37946 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37947 .next
37948 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37949 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37950 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37951 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37952 .next
37953 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37954 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37955 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37956 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37957 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37958 .next
37959 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37960 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37961 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37962 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37963 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37964 .next
37965 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37966 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37967 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37968 .endlist
37969
37970
37971 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37972 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37973 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37974 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37975 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37976 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37977 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37978 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37979 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37980 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37981 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37982 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37983 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37984
37985 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37986 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37987 &%message_logs%& option false.
37988 .ecindex IIDloggen
37989
37990
37991
37992
37993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37995
37996 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37997 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37998 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37999 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38000 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38001
38002 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38003 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38004 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38005 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38006 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38007 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38008 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38009 various criteria"
38010 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38011 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38012 "extract statistics from the log"
38013 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38014 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38015 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38016 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38017 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38018 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38019 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38020 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38021 .endtable
38022
38023 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38024 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38025 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38026
38027
38028
38029
38030 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38031 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38032 .cindex "process, querying"
38033 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
38034 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38035 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38036 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38037 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38038 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38039 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38040 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38041 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38042
38043 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38044 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38045 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38046
38047
38048 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38049 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38050 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38051 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38052 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38053 options:
38054 .display
38055 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38056 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38057 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38058 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38059 .endd
38060 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38061 .code
38062 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
38063 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
38064 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38065 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
38066 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
38067 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38068 .endd
38069 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38070 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38071
38072
38073
38074 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38075 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38076 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
38077 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38078 .code
38079 exim -bpu
38080 .endd
38081 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38082 .code
38083 exim -bp
38084 .endd
38085 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38086 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38087
38088 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38089 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38090
38091 .vlist
38092 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38093 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38094 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38095 .code
38096 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38097 .endd
38098 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38099 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38100 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38101
38102 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38103 Match against the size field.
38104
38105 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38106 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38107
38108 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38109 Match messages that are older than the given time.
38110
38111 .vitem &*-z*&
38112 Match only frozen messages.
38113
38114 .vitem &*-x*&
38115 Match only non-frozen messages.
38116
38117 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38118 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38119 .endlist
38120
38121 The following options control the format of the output:
38122
38123 .vlist
38124 .vitem &*-c*&
38125 Display only the count of matching messages.
38126
38127 .vitem &*-l*&
38128 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38129 the default.
38130
38131 .vitem &*-i*&
38132 Display message ids only.
38133
38134 .vitem &*-b*&
38135 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38136
38137 .vitem &*-R*&
38138 Display messages in reverse order.
38139
38140 .vitem &*-a*&
38141 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38142 .endlist
38143
38144 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38145
38146
38147
38148 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38149 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38150 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38151 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38152 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38153 running a command such as
38154 .code
38155 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38156 .endd
38157 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38158 it, as in the following example:
38159 .code
38160 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38161 .endd
38162 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38163 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38164 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38165 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38166
38167 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38168 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38169 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38170 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38171 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38172 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38173 sender.
38174
38175 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38176 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38177 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38178 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38179 level"& addresses).
38180
38181
38182
38183
38184 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38185 "SECTextspeinf"
38186 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38187 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38188 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38189 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38190 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38191 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38192 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38193 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38194 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38195 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38196 .display
38197 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38198 .endd
38199 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38200
38201 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38202 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38203 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38204
38205 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38206 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38207 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38208 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38209 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38210
38211 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38212 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38213 regular expression.
38214
38215 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38216 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38217
38218 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38219 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38220 normally.
38221
38222 Example of &%-M%&:
38223 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38224 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38225 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38226 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38227 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38228 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38229 search term.
38230
38231 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38232 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38233 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38234 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38235 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38236
38237
38238 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38239 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38240 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38241 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38242 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38243 the &%--help%& option.
38244
38245
38246 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38247 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38248 .cindex "cycling logs"
38249 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38250 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38251 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38252 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38253 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38254 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38255 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38256 .ilist
38257 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38258 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38259 .next
38260 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38261 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38262 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38263 configuration.
38264 .endlist
38265
38266 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38267 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38268 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38269 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38270 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38271 logs are handled similarly.
38272
38273 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38274 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38275 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38276 any existing log files.
38277
38278 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38279 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38280 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38281 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38282 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38283 .code
38284 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38285 .endd
38286 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38287 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38288
38289
38290
38291 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38292 .cindex "statistics"
38293 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38294 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38295 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38296 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38297 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38298
38299 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38300 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38301 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38302 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38303 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38304 .code
38305 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38306 .endd
38307 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38308 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38309 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38310 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38311 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38312 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38313 also produced per user.
38314
38315 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38316 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38317 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38318 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38319 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38320
38321 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38322 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38323 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38324 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38325 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38326 an entirely separate message.
38327
38328 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38329 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38330 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38331 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38332 least one address that failed.
38333
38334 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38335 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38336 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38337 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38338 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38339 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38340 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38341
38342 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38343 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38344 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38345
38346 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38347 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38348 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38349 .code
38350 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38351 .endd
38352
38353 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38354 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38355 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38356 .cindex "checking access"
38357 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38358 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38359 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38360 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38361 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38362 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38363
38364 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38365 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38366 .code
38367 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38368 .endd
38369 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38370 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38371 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38372 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38373 .code
38374 Rejected:
38375 550 Relay not permitted
38376 .endd
38377 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38378 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38379 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38380 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38381 you can use:
38382 .code
38383 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38384 -f himself@there.example
38385 .endd
38386 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38387 mandatory arguments.
38388
38389 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38390 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38391 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38392
38393
38394
38395 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38396 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38397 .cindex "building DBM files"
38398 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38399 .cindex "lower casing"
38400 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38401 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38402 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38403 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38404 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38405 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38406
38407 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38408 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38409 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38410 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38411 files.
38412
38413 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38414 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38415 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38416 well.
38417
38418 .cindex "USE_DB"
38419 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38420 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38421 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38422 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38423 .code
38424 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38425 .endd
38426 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38427 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38428
38429 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38430 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38431 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38432 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38433 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38434 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38435
38436 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38437 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38438 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38439 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38440 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38441 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38442 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38443 return code is 2.
38444
38445
38446
38447
38448 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38449 .cindex "retry" "times"
38450 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38451 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38452 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38453 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38454 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38455 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38456 output. For example:
38457 .code
38458 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38459 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38460 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38461 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38462 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38463 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38464 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38465 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38466 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38467 past final cutoff time
38468 .endd
38469 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38470 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38471 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38472 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38473 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38474 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38475 run very often.
38476
38477 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38478 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38479 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38480 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38481 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38482 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38483
38484
38485
38486 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38487 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38488 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38489 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38490 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38491 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38492 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38493
38494 .ilist
38495 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38496 .next
38497 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38498 for remote hosts
38499 .next
38500 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38501 .next
38502 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38503 .next
38504 &'misc'&: other hints data
38505 .endlist
38506
38507 The &'misc'& database is used for
38508
38509 .ilist
38510 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38511 .next
38512 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38513 &(smtp)& transport)
38514 .next
38515 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38516 in a transport)
38517 .endlist
38518
38519
38520
38521 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38522 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38523 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38524 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38525 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38526 .code
38527 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38528 .endd
38529 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38530 .code
38531 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38532 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38533 .endd
38534 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38535 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38536 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38537 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38538 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38539 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38540 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38541 and a textual description of the error.
38542
38543 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38544 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38545 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38546 exceeded.
38547
38548 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38549 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38550 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38551 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38552 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38553 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38554 cross-references.
38555
38556
38557
38558 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38559 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38560 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38561 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38562 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38563 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38564 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38565 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38566 updated sufficiently often.
38567
38568 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38569 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38570 the retry database:
38571 .code
38572 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38573 .endd
38574 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38575 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38576 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38577 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38578 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38579 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38580 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38581 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38582 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38583 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38584 whenever it removes information from the database.
38585
38586 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38587 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38588 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38589 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38590 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38591
38592 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38593 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38594 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38595 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38596 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38597 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38598 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38599 tidied.
38600
38601 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38602 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38603
38604
38605
38606
38607 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38608 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38609 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38610 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38611 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38612 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38613 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38614 displayed.
38615
38616 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38617 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38618 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38619 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38620 by new data, for example:
38621 .code
38622 > 4 951102:1000
38623 .endd
38624 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38625 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38626 used as optional separators.
38627
38628
38629
38630
38631 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38632 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38633 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38634 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38635 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38636 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38637 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38638 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38639 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38640 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38641 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38642 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38643 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38644
38645 .vlist
38646 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
38647 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38648
38649 .vitem &%-flock%&
38650 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38651 supports it.
38652
38653 .vitem &%-interval%&
38654 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38655 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38656
38657 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38658 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38659
38660 .vitem &%-mbx%&
38661 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38662
38663 .vitem &%-q%&
38664 Suppress verification output.
38665
38666 .vitem &%-retries%&
38667 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38668 the lock (default 10).
38669
38670 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38671 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38672 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38673 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38674 subsequently sees.
38675
38676 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38677 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38678 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38679 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38680
38681 .vitem &%-v%&
38682 Generate verbose output.
38683 .endlist
38684
38685 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38686 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38687 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38688 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38689 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38690 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38691 more than 30 minutes old.
38692
38693 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38694 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38695 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38696 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38697 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38698 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38699
38700 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38701 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38702 suppresses all output except error messages.
38703
38704 A command such as
38705 .code
38706 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38707 .endd
38708 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38709 .display
38710 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38711 <&'some commands'&>
38712 &`End`&
38713 .endd
38714 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38715 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38716 such as
38717 .code
38718 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38719 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38720 .endd
38721 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38722 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38723 .ecindex IIDutils
38724
38725
38726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38728
38729 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38730 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38731 .cindex "X-windows"
38732 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38733 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38734 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38735 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38736 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38737 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38738 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38739 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38740
38741
38742
38743 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38744 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38745 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38746 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38747 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38748 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38749 parameters are for.
38750
38751 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38752 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38753 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38754 .code
38755 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38756 .endd
38757 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38758 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38759 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38760 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38761 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38762
38763 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38764 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38765 .code
38766 Eximon*background: gray94
38767 .endd
38768 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38769 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38770 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38771 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38772 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38773 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38774 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38775 .code
38776 xrdb -merge <<End
38777 Eximon*highlight: gray
38778 End
38779 .endd
38780 .cindex "admin user"
38781 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38782 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38783
38784 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38785 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38786 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38787 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38788 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38789
38790 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38791 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38792 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38793 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38794 different parts of the display.
38795
38796
38797
38798
38799 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38800 .cindex "stripchart"
38801 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38802 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38803 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38804 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38805 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38806 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38807 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38808 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38809 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38810
38811 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38812 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38813 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38814 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38815
38816 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38817 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38818 to a single partition.
38819
38820 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38821 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38822 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38823 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38824 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38825 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38826 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38827
38828
38829
38830
38831 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38832 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38833 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38834 .cindex "window size"
38835 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38836 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38837 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38838 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38839 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38840 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38841
38842 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38843 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38844 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38845 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38846
38847 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38848 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38849 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38850 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38851 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38852 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38853
38854 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38855 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38856 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38857
38858
38859
38860 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38861 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38862 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38863 the main log is maintained.
38864 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38865 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38866 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38867 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38868 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38869
38870 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38871 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38872 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38873 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38874 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38875 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38876 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38877 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38878 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38879 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38880 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38881
38882 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38883 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38884 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38885 It cannot go further back up the log.
38886
38887 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38888 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38889 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38890 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38891 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38892 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38893
38894 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38895 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38896 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38897 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38898 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38899 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38900
38901 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38902 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38903 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38904 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38905 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38906 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38907 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38908 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38909 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38910 window.
38911
38912
38913
38914 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38915 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38916 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38917 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38918 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38919 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38920 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38921 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38922 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38923 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38924
38925 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38926 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38927 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38928 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38929 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38930 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38931 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38932
38933 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38934 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38935 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38936 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38937 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38938 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38939 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38940
38941 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38942 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38943 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38944 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38945
38946 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38947 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38948 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38949 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38950 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38951 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38952 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38953 not shown.
38954
38955 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38956 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38957
38958 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38959 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38960 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38961 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38962 display is updated.
38963
38964
38965
38966 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38967 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38968 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38969 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38970 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38971 any selected text.
38972
38973 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38974 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38975 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38976 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38977 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38978 .code
38979 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38980 .endd
38981 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38982 follows:
38983
38984 .ilist
38985 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38986 in a new text window.
38987 .next
38988 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38989 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38990 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38991 .next
38992 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38993 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38994 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38995 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38996 .next
38997 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38998 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38999 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39000 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39001 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39002 .next
39003 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39004 that the message be frozen.
39005 .next
39006 .cindex "thawing messages"
39007 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
39008 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39009 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39010 that the message be thawed.
39011 .next
39012 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39013 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39014 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39015 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39016 .next
39017 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39018 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39019 message.
39020 .next
39021 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39022 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39023 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39024 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39025 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39026 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39027 which case no action is taken.
39028 .next
39029 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39030 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39031 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39032 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39033 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39034 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39035 case no action is taken.
39036 .next
39037 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39038 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39039 .next
39040 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39041 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39042 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39043 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39044 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39045 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39046 the address is qualified with that domain.
39047 .endlist
39048
39049 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39050 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39051 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39052 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39053 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39054 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39055 if no output is generated.
39056
39057 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39058 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39059 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39060 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39061
39062 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39063 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39064 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39065 .ecindex IIDeximon
39066
39067
39068
39069
39070
39071 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39072 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39073
39074 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39075 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39076 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39077 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39078
39079 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39080 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39081 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39082 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39083 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39084 its security as compared with other MTAs.
39085
39086 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39087 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39088 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39089 as soon as possible.
39090
39091
39092 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39093 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
39094 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39095 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39096 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39097 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39098
39099 .ilist
39100 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39101 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39102 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39103 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39104 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39105 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39106
39107 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39108 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39109 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39110 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39111 .next
39112
39113 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39114 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39115 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39116 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39117 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39118 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39119 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39120 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39121 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39122 separate commands.
39123
39124 .next
39125 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39126 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39127 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39128 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39129 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39130 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39131 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39132 .next
39133 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39134 is disabled.
39135 .next
39136 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39137 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39138 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39139 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39140 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39141 .endlist
39142
39143
39144
39145 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39146 .cindex "setuid"
39147 .cindex "root privilege"
39148 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39149 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39150 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39151 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39152 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39153 is required for two things:
39154
39155 .ilist
39156 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39157 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39158 not required.
39159 .next
39160 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39161 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39162 configuration.
39163 .endlist
39164
39165 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39166 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39167 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39168 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39169 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39170 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39171 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39172 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39173
39174 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39175 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39176 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39177
39178 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39179 uid and gid in the following cases:
39180
39181 .ilist
39182 .oindex "&%-C%&"
39183 .oindex "&%-D%&"
39184 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39185 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39186 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39187 the calling process.
39188 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39189 option may not be used at all.
39190 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39191 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39192 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39193 .next
39194 .oindex "&%-be%&"
39195 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
39196 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
39197 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39198 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39199 calling process.
39200 .next
39201 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39202 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39203 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39204 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39205 testing address verification
39206 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
39207 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
39208 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39209 option).
39210 .next
39211 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39212 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39213 .endlist
39214
39215 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39216
39217 .ilist
39218 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39219 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39220 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39221 will be used during message reception.
39222 .next
39223 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39224 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39225 .next
39226 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39227 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39228 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39229 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39230 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39231 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39232 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39233 generating bounce and warning messages.
39234
39235 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39236 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39237 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39238 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39239 .next
39240 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39241 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39242 .endlist
39243
39244
39245
39246
39247 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39248 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39249 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39250 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39251 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39252 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39253 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39254 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39255 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39256 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39257 to any other uid.
39258
39259 .cindex SIGHUP
39260 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39261 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39262 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39263 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39264
39265 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39266 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39267 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39268 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39269 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39270
39271 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39272 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39273 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39274 effect.
39275
39276 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39277 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39278 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39279
39280 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39281 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39282 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39283 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39284 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39285 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39286 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39287 address this problem at this time.
39288
39289 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39290 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39291 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39292 be used in the most straightforward way.
39293
39294 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39295 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39296
39297 .ilist
39298 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39299 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39300 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39301 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39302 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39303 .next
39304 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39305 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39306 .next
39307 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39308 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39309 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39310 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39311 .next
39312 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39313 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39314
39315 .olist
39316 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39317 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39318 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39319 .next
39320 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39321 owned by the Exim user.
39322 .next
39323 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39324 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39325 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39326 .endlist olist
39327 .endlist ilist
39328
39329
39330 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39331 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39332 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39333 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39334
39335 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39336 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39337
39338
39339
39340
39341 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39342 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39343 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39344
39345
39346
39347 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39348 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39349 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39350 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39351 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39352 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39353 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39354
39355 .ilist
39356 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39357 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39358 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39359 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39360 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39361 .next
39362 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39363 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39364 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39365 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39366 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39367 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39368 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39369 .next
39370 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39371 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39372 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39373 .next
39374 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39375 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39376 .next
39377 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39378 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39379 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39380 .next
39381 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39382 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39383 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39384 of opaque strings.
39385 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39386 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39387 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39388 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39389 .endlist
39390
39391
39392
39393
39394 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39395 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39396 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39397 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39398 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39399 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39400 are some issues to be aware of:
39401
39402 .ilist
39403 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39404 .next
39405 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39406 .next
39407 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39408 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39409 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39410 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39411 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39412 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39413 data.
39414 .next
39415 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39416 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39417 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39418 .next
39419 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39420 expected to yield one result.
39421 .endlist
39422
39423
39424
39425
39426 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39427 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39428 .cindex "IP source routing"
39429 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39430 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39431 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39432 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39433
39434
39435
39436 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39437 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39438 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39439
39440
39441
39442
39443 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39444 .cindex "trusted users"
39445 .cindex "admin user"
39446 .cindex "privileged user"
39447 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39448 .cindex "user" "admin"
39449 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39450 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39451 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39452 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39453 permit a remote host to be specified.
39454
39455 .oindex "&%-f%&"
39456 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39457 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39458 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39459 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39460 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39461 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39462
39463 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39464 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39465 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39466 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39467 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39468
39469 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39470 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39471 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39472 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39473 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39474
39475 .oindex "&%-M%&"
39476 .oindex "&%-q%&"
39477 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39478 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39479 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39480 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39481 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39482 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39483
39484 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39485 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39486 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39487 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39488 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39489 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39490 files.
39491
39492 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39493 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39494 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39495 This affects most of the checking options,
39496 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39497
39498
39499 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39500 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39501 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39502 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39503 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39504 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39505
39506
39507
39508 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39509 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39510 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39511 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39512 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39513 this.
39514
39515
39516
39517 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39518 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39519 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39520 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39521 converted output.
39522
39523
39524
39525 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39526 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39527 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39528 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39529 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39530
39531
39532
39533 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39534 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39535 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39536 loading it.
39537
39538
39539 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39540 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39541 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39542 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39543 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39544 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39545 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39546
39547 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39548 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39549 string.
39550
39551
39552
39553 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39554 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39555 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39556 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39557
39558
39559
39560 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39561 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39562 enough to hold the result.
39563 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39564
39565
39566
39567
39568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39570
39571 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39572 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39573 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39574 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39575 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39576 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39577 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39578 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39579 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39580 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39581 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39582 themselves are recoverable.
39583
39584 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39585 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39586 and should not be used as such.
39587
39588 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39589 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39590 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39591
39592 .ilist
39593 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39594 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39595 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39596 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39597 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39598 .next
39599 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39600 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39601 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39602 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39603 .next
39604 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39605 .next
39606 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39607 signature.
39608 .endlist
39609 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39610
39611 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39612 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39613 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39614 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39615 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39616 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39617 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39618 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39619 attempt.
39620
39621 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39622 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39623 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39624 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39625
39626 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39627 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39628 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39629 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39630 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39631 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39632 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39633 normally the Exim user.
39634
39635 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39636 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39637 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39638 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39639 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39640 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39641 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39642 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39643
39644 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39645 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39646 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39647 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39648
39649 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39650 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39651
39652 .vlist
39653 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39654 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39655 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39656 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39657 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39658 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39659 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39660 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39661 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39662 newlines.
39663
39664 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39665 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39666 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39667 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39668 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39669 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39670
39671 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39672 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39673 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39674 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39675 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39676 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39677
39678 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39679 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39680 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39681
39682 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39683 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39684 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39685 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39686 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39687
39688 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39689 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39690 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39691 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39692 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39693
39694 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39695 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39696 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39697
39698 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39699 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39700 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39701
39702 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39703 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39704 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39705
39706 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39707 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39708 present if the number is greater than zero.
39709
39710 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39711 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39712 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39713
39714 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39715 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39716 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39717
39718 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39719 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39720 command.
39721
39722 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39723 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39724 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39725 messages.
39726
39727 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39728 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39729 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39730 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39731
39732 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39733 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39734 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39735
39736 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39737 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39738 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39739 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39740 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39741 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39742
39743 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39744 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39745 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39746 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39747 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39748
39749 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39750 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39751 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39752 generated messages.
39753
39754 .vitem &%-local%&
39755 The message is from a local sender.
39756
39757 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39758 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39759
39760 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39761 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39762 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39763 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39764
39765 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39766 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39767 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39768
39769 .vitem &%-N%&
39770 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39771 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39772 &%-N%& is assumed.
39773
39774 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39775 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39776 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39777
39778 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39779 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39780 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39781
39782 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39783 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39784 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39785
39786 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39787 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39788 rather than Unix-format.
39789 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39790 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39791
39792 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39793 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39794 certificate was verified by the server.
39795
39796 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39797 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39798 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39799
39800 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39801 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39802 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39803 certificate.
39804 .endlist
39805
39806 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39807 corresponding data is untrusted.
39808
39809 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39810 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39811 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39812 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39813 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39814 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39815 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39816 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39817 addresses are complete.
39818
39819 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39820 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39821 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39822 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39823 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39824 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39825 .code
39826 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39827 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39828 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39829 .endd
39830 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39831 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39832 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39833 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39834 example:
39835 .code
39836 4
39837 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39838 darcy@austen.fict.example
39839 rdo@foundation
39840 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39841 .endd
39842 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39843 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39844 line is of the following form:
39845 .display
39846 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39847 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39848 .endd
39849 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39850 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39851 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39852 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39853 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39854 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39855 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39856 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39857
39858
39859 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39860 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39861 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39862 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39863 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39864 following:
39865
39866 .table2 50pt
39867 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39868 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39869 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39870 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39871 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39872 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39873 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39874 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39875 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39876 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39877 .endtable
39878
39879 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39880 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39881 typical set of headers:
39882 .code
39883 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39884 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39885 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39886 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39887 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39888 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39889 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39890 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39891 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39892 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39893 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39894 .endd
39895 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39896 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39897 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39898 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39899 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39900 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39901
39902 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39903 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39904 an ASCII newline character.
39905 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39906 can have an alternate format.
39907 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39908 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39909 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39910 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39911 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39912 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39913
39914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39916
39917 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39918 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39919
39920 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39921 .cindex "DKIM"
39922
39923 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39924 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39925 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39926 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39927
39928 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39929 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39930 any original DKIM signature.
39931
39932 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39933 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39934
39935 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39936 .olist
39937 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39938 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39939 (including transport filters)
39940 except cutthrough delivery.
39941 .next
39942 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39943 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39944 different signature contexts.
39945 .endlist
39946
39947 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39948 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39949 Exim's standard controls.
39950
39951 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39952 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39953
39954 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39955 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39956 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39957 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39958 .code
39959 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39960 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39961 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39962 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39963 .endd
39964
39965 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39966 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39967 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39968 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39969 senders).
39970
39971
39972 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39973 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39974
39975 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39976 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39977 .code
39978 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39979
39980 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39981 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39982 .endd
39983
39984 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39985 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39986 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39987 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39988 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39989
39990 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39991 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39992
39993 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39994 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39995 After expansion, this can be a list.
39996 Each element in turn,
39997 lowercased,
39998 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39999 while expanding the remaining signing options.
40000 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40001 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40002
40003 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40004 This sets the key selector string.
40005 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40006 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40007 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40008 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40009 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40010 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40011
40012 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40013 This sets the private key to use.
40014 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40015 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40016 The result can either
40017 .ilist
40018 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40019 .next
40020 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40021 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40022 .next
40023 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40024 the private key
40025 .next
40026 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40027 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40028 is set.
40029 .endlist
40030
40031 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40032 .code
40033 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40034 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40035 .endd
40036 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40037 for the DNS TXT record.
40038 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40039
40040 Under GnuTLS:
40041 .code
40042 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40043 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40044 .endd
40045
40046 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40047 .code
40048 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40049 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40050 .endd
40051
40052 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40053 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40054 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40055 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40056 for some transition period.
40057 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40058 for EC keys.
40059
40060 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40061 .code
40062 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40063 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40064 .endd
40065
40066 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40067 .code
40068 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40069 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40070 .endd
40071
40072 Exim also supports an alternate format
40073 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40074 of the standard, but not adopted.
40075 A future release will probably drop that support.
40076
40077 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40078 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40079 .ilist
40080 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40081 .next
40082 &`sha256`& &-- the default
40083 .next
40084 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40085 .endlist
40086
40087 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40088 .code
40089 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40090 .endd
40091
40092 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40093 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40094 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40095 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40096 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40097 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40098
40099 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40100 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40101 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40102 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40103 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40104
40105 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40106 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40107 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40108 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40109 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40110 variables here.
40111
40112 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40113 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40114 list of header names.
40115 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40116 in the message signature.
40117 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40118 whether or not each header is present in the message.
40119 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40120 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40121
40122 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40123 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40124 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40125
40126 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40127 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40128 will be signed.
40129 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40130 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40131 name will be appended.
40132
40133 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40134 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40135 If not set, no such information will be included.
40136 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40137 for the expiry tag
40138 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40139 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40140
40141 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40142
40143
40144 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40145 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40146
40147 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40148 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40149 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40150 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40151 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40152 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40153 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40154
40155 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40156 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40157 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40158
40159 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40160 of this section can be ignored.
40161
40162 The results of verification are made available to the
40163 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40164 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40165 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40166 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40167 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40168 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40169 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40170
40171 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40172 a large number of expansion variables
40173 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40174 runtime of the ACL.
40175
40176 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40177 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40178 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40179 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40180
40181 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40182 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40183 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40184 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40185 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40186 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40187 it defaults as:
40188 .code
40189 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40190 .endd
40191 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40192 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40193 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40194 .code
40195 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40196 .endd
40197 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40198 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40199 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40200 .code
40201 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40202 .endd
40203
40204 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40205 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40206
40207 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40208 (such as the From: header)
40209 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40210 and for the domain part if identities.
40211 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40212
40213 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40214 for each matching signature.
40215
40216
40217 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40218 available (from most to least important):
40219
40220
40221 .vlist
40222 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40223 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40224 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40225 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40226
40227 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40228 Within the DKIM ACL,
40229 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40230 .ilist
40231 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40232 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40233 .next
40234 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40235 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40236 .next
40237 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40238 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40239 .next
40240 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40241 .endlist
40242
40243 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40244 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40245 hash-method or key-size:
40246 .code
40247 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40248 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40249 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40250 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40251 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40252 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40253 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40254 .endd
40255
40256 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40257 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40258 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40259 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40260
40261 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40262 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40263 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40264 .ilist
40265 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40266 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40267 .next
40268 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40269 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40270 .next
40271 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40272 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40273 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40274 .next
40275 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40276 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40277 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40278 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40279 .endlist
40280
40281 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40282
40283 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40284 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40285 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40286 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40287
40288 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40289 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40290 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40291 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40292
40293 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40294 The key record selector string.
40295
40296 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40297 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40298 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40299 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40300 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40301 for EC keys.
40302
40303 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40304 .code
40305 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40306
40307 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40308 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40309 .endd
40310
40311 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40312 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40313 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40314 processing of such signatures.
40315
40316 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40317 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40318
40319 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40320 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40321
40322 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40323 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40324 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40325 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40326 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40327 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40328
40329 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40330 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40331 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40332 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40333 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40334 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40335 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40336 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40337
40338 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40339 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40340 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40341
40342 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40343 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40344 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40345 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40346 integer size comparisons against this value.
40347 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40348
40349 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40350 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40351
40352 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40353 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40354
40355 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40356 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40357
40358 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40359 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40360 in the key record.
40361
40362 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40363 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40364 in the key record.
40365
40366 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40367 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40368
40369 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40370 Number of bits in the key.
40371
40372 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40373 .code
40374 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40375 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40376 .endd
40377
40378 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40379 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40380 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40381
40382 .endlist
40383
40384 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40385
40386 .vlist
40387 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40388 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40389 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40390 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40391 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40392
40393 .code
40394 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40395 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40396 sender_domains = gmail.com
40397 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40398 dkim_status = none
40399 .endd
40400
40401 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40402 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40403
40404 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40405 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40406 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40407 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40408
40409 .code
40410 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40411 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40412 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40413 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40414 .endd
40415
40416 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40417 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40418 for more information of what they mean.
40419 .endlist
40420
40421
40422
40423
40424 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40425 .cindex SPF verification
40426
40427 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40428 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40429 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40430 the &url(http://openspf.org).
40431 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40432 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40433 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40434 . --- discussion.
40435
40436 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40437 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40438
40439 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40440 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40441 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40442 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40443 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40444
40445 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40446 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40447 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40448 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40449
40450
40451 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40452 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40453 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40454 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40455 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40456 Valid strings are:
40457 .vlist
40458 .vitem &%pass%&
40459 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40460
40461 .vitem &%fail%&
40462 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40463 domain in the envelope-from address.
40464
40465 .vitem &%softfail%&
40466 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40467 is a forgery.
40468
40469 .vitem &%none%&
40470 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40471
40472 .vitem &%neutral%&
40473 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40474 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40475 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40476
40477 .vitem &%permerror%&
40478 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40479 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40480
40481 .vitem &%temperror%&
40482 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40483 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40484 .endlist
40485
40486 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40487 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40488 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40489 short-circuit fashion.
40490
40491 Example:
40492 .code
40493 deny spf = fail
40494 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40495 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40496 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40497 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40498 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40499 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40500 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40501 ip=$sender_host_address
40502 .endd
40503
40504 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40505 variables:
40506
40507 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40508 .vlist
40509 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40510 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40511 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40512 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40513 it for logging purposes.
40514
40515 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40516 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40517 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40518 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40519 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40520 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40521
40522 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40523 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40524
40525 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40526 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40527 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40528 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40529 temperror.
40530
40531 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40532 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40533 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40534 and required in order to obtain a result.
40535
40536 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40537 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40538 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40539 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40540 .endlist
40541
40542
40543 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40544 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40545 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40546 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40547 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40548 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40549 capability.
40550 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40551 for a description of what it means.
40552 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40553
40554 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40555 of the spf one. For example:
40556
40557 .code
40558 deny spf_guess = fail
40559 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40560 .endd
40561
40562 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40563 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40564 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40565 reject message.
40566
40567 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40568 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40569
40570 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40571 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40572 &%spf_guess%& option.
40573 For example, the following:
40574
40575 .code
40576 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40577 .endd
40578
40579 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40580
40581
40582 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40583 .cindex lookup spf
40584 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40585 address as the key and an IP address
40586 (v4 or v6)
40587 as the database:
40588
40589 .code
40590 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40591 .endd
40592
40593 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40594 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40595
40596
40597
40598
40599
40600 .section DMARC SECDMARC
40601 .cindex DMARC verification
40602
40603 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40604 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40605 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40606 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40607 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40608
40609 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40610 the libopendmarc library is used.
40611
40612 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40613 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40614 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40615 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40616 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40617 This description assumes
40618 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40619 are in /usr/local/lib.
40620
40621 . subsection
40622
40623 There are three main-configuration options:
40624 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40625
40626 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40627 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40628 defines the location of a text file of valid
40629 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40630 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40631 the most current version can be downloaded
40632 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40633 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40634 .new
40635 The default for the option is unset.
40636 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40637 .wen
40638
40639
40640 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40641 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40642 defines the location of a file to log results
40643 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40644 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40645 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40646 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40647 directory of this file is writable by the user
40648 exim runs as.
40649 The default is unset.
40650
40651 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40652 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40653 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40654 forensic report detailing alignment failures
40655 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40656 and you have configured Exim to send them.
40657 If set, this is expanded and used for the
40658 From: header line; the address is extracted
40659 from it and used for the envelope from.
40660 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40661 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40662 envelope from.
40663
40664 . I wish we had subsections...
40665
40666 .cindex DMARC controls
40667 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40668 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40669 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40670 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40671 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40672 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40673 .code
40674 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40675 .endd
40676 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40677 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40678 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40679 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40680 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40681 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40682 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40683 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40684 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40685 construction might be inadequate.
40686 .code
40687 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40688 .endd
40689 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40690 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40691 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40692 send them.)
40693
40694 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40695 the DATA acl.
40696
40697 . subsection
40698
40699 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40700 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40701 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40702 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40703 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40704 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40705 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40706
40707 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40708 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40709 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40710 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40711 .display
40712 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40713 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40714 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40715 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40716 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40717 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40718 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40719 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40720 .endd
40721 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40722 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40723 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40724 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40725 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40726 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40727 fails.
40728
40729 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40730 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40731 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40732
40733 Performing the check sets up information used by the
40734 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40735
40736 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40737 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40738 expansion variables are available:
40739
40740 .vlist
40741 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
40742 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40743 .cindex DMARC result
40744 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40745 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40746 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40747 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40748 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40749
40750 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
40751 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40752 Slightly longer, human readable status.
40753
40754 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40755 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40756 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40757
40758 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40759 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40760 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40761 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40762 is any error, including no DMARC record.
40763 .endlist
40764
40765 . subsection
40766
40767 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40768 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40769 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40770 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40771 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40772 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40773 processing or failure delivery issues).
40774
40775 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40776 tools, you need to:
40777 .ilist
40778 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
40779 .next
40780 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40781 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40782 .endlist
40783
40784 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40785 .ilist
40786 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40787 .next
40788 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40789 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40790 .endlist
40791
40792 . subsection
40793
40794 Example usage:
40795 .code
40796 (RCPT ACL)
40797 warn domains = +local_domains
40798 hosts = +local_hosts
40799 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40800
40801 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40802 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40803
40804 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40805 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40806
40807 (DATA ACL)
40808 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40809 !authenticated = *
40810 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40811
40812 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40813 !authenticated = *
40814 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40815
40816 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40817 !authenticated = *
40818 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40819 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40820
40821 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40822 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40823 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40824
40825 deny dmarc_status = reject
40826 !authenticated = *
40827 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40828
40829 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40830 .endd
40831
40832
40833
40834
40835
40836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40838
40839 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40840 "Proxy support"
40841 .cindex "proxy support"
40842 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40843
40844 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40845 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40846
40847
40848 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40849 .cindex proxy inbound
40850 .cindex proxy "server side"
40851 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40852 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40853
40854 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40855 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40856 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40857 in Local/Makefile.
40858
40859 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40860 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40861
40862 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40863 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40864 to distribute load.
40865 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40866 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40867 There is no logging if a host passes or
40868 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40869 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40870
40871 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40872 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40873 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40874 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40875 automatically determines which version is in use.
40876
40877 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40878 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40879 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40880 Exim and the proxy server.
40881
40882 The following expansion variables are usable
40883 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40884 of the proxy):
40885 .display
40886 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40887 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40888 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40889 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40890 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40891 .endd
40892 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40893 there was a protocol error.
40894 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40895 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40896
40897 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40898 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40899 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40900 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40901 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40902 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40903 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40904 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40905 A possible solution is:
40906 .display
40907 # Set max number of connections per host
40908 LIMIT = 5
40909 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40910 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40911
40912 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40913 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40914 .endd
40915
40916
40917
40918 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40919 .cindex proxy outbound
40920 .cindex proxy "client side"
40921 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40922 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40923 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40924 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40925 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40926 Local/Makefile.
40927
40928 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40929 on an smtp transport.
40930 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40931 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40932 Each proxy specifier is a list
40933 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40934 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40935
40936 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40937 The list of options is in the following table:
40938 .display
40939 &'auth '& authentication method
40940 &'name '& authentication username
40941 &'pass '& authentication password
40942 &'port '& tcp port
40943 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40944 &'pri '& priority
40945 &'weight '& selection bias
40946 .endd
40947
40948 More details on each of these options follows:
40949
40950 .ilist
40951 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40952 .cindex proxy authentication
40953 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40954 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40955 for access to the proxy.
40956 Default is &"none"&.
40957 .next
40958 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40959 Default is empty.
40960 .next
40961 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40962 Default is empty.
40963 .next
40964 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40965 Default is 1080.
40966 .next
40967 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40968 Default is 5.
40969 .next
40970 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40971 higher values being tried first.
40972 The default priority is 1.
40973 .next
40974 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40975 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40976 weighted by this value.
40977 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40978 .endlist
40979
40980 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40981 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40982 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40983
40984 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40985 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40986 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40987 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40988
40989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40991
40992 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40993 "Internationalisation""
40994 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40995 .cindex EAI
40996 .cindex i18n
40997 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40998
40999 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41000 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41001 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41002
41003 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41004 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41005 requirement, upon libidn2.
41006
41007 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41008 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41009 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41010 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41011 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41012 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41013
41014 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41015 international handling for the message is enabled and
41016 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41017
41018 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41019 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41020 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41021 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41022
41023 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41024 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41025 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41026 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41027
41028 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41029 components expanded to a-label form,
41030 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41031 form of the name.
41032
41033 .cindex log protocol
41034 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41035 .cindex i18n logging
41036 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41037 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41038
41039 The following expansion operators can be used:
41040 .code
41041 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41042 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41043 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41044 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41045 .endd
41046
41047 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41048 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41049 The RCPT ACL
41050 may use the following modifier:
41051 .display
41052 control = utf8_downconvert
41053 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41054 .endd
41055 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41056 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41057 Message Submission Agent context.
41058 If a value is appended it may be:
41059 .display
41060 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41061 &`0 `& no downconversion
41062 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41063 .endd
41064
41065 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41066 is initially set to -1.
41067
41068 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41069 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41070 and it overrides any previously set value.
41071
41072
41073 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41074 Configurations supporting these should inspect
41075 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41076
41077 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41078 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41079 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41080
41081 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41082 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41083
41084
41085
41086 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41087 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41088 the following expansion operator can be used:
41089 .code
41090 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41091 .endd
41092
41093 The string is converted from the charset specified by
41094 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41095 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41096 to the
41097 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41098 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41099 (which has to be a single character)
41100 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41101 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41102
41103 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41104 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41105
41106 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41107 by many other IMAP servers.
41108
41109 Examples:
41110 .display
41111 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41112 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41113 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41114 .endd
41115
41116 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41117 must be representable in UTF-16.
41118
41119
41120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41122
41123 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41124 "Events"
41125 .cindex events
41126
41127 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41128 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41129 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41130 processing actions.
41131
41132 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41133 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41134 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41135
41136 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41137 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41138 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41139
41140 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41141 An example might look like:
41142 .cindex logging custom
41143 .code
41144 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41145 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41146 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41147 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41148 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41149 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41150 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41151 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41152 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41153 } {}}
41154 .endd
41155
41156 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41157 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41158 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41159
41160 .new
41161 The current list of events is:
41162 .wen
41163 .display
41164 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41165 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41166 &`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41167 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41168 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41169 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41170 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41171 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41172 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41173 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41174 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41175 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41176 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41177 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41178 .endd
41179 New event types may be added in future.
41180
41181 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41182 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41183 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41184
41185 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41186 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41187 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41188
41189 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41190 should define the event action.
41191
41192 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41193 with the event type:
41194 .display
41195 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41196 &`msg:defer `& error string
41197 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41198 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41199 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41200 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41201 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41202 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41203 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41204 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41205 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41206 .endd
41207
41208 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41209
41210 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41211 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41212 the course of its processing:
41213 .ilist
41214 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41215 transport call
41216 .next
41217 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41218 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41219 .endlist
41220 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41221 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41222
41223 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41224 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41225 following will be forced:
41226 .display
41227 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41228 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41229 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41230 .endd
41231 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41232 no other use is made of it.
41233
41234 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41235 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41236 the target system.
41237
41238 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41239 chain element received on the connection.
41240 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41241 loaded locally.
41242
41243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41245
41246 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41247 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41248 .cindex "adding drivers"
41249 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41250 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41251 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41252 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41253
41254 .olist
41255 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41256 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41257 .next
41258 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41259 .display
41260 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41261 .endd
41262 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41263 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41264 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41265 .next
41266 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41267 .code
41268 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41269 .endd
41270 .next
41271 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41272 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41273 .next
41274 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41275 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41276 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41277 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41278 simple form that most lookups have.
41279 .next
41280 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41281 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41282 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41283 .next
41284 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41285 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41286 .next
41287 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41288 &_src_&.
41289 .next
41290 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41291 as for other drivers and lookups.
41292 .endlist
41293
41294 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41295 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41296 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41297 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41298 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41299
41300 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41301 the interface that is expected.
41302
41303
41304
41305
41306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41307 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41308
41309 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41310 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41311 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41312 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41313 . processors.
41314 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41315
41316 .literal xml
41317 <?sdop
41318 format="newpage"
41319 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41320 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41321 ?>
41322 .literal off
41323
41324 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41325 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41326 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41327
41328
41329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41330 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////